| 	
		 Contents   
					Safety Information and Introduction ............2   
					AV RECEIVER   
					Table of Contents...........................................6   
					Connections .................................................12   
					Turning On & Basic Operations..................21   
					Playback........................................................29   
					Advanced Operations ..................................52   
					Controlling Other Components...................76   
					Appendix.......................................................82   
					TX-NR727   
					Instruction Manual   
					Internet Radio Guide   
					Remote Control Codes   
					En   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					interference in a residential installation. This   
					extended period, remove the power cord from the   
					AC outlet.   
					5. Preventing Hearing Loss   
					Precautions   
					equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio   
					frequency energy and, if not installed and used in   
					accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful   
					interference to radio communications. However, there   
					is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a   
					particular installation. If this equipment does cause   
					harmful interference to radio or television reception,   
					which can be determined by turning the equipment off   
					and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the   
					interference by one or more of the following   
					measures:   
					–Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.   
					–Increase the separation between the equipment   
					and receiver.   
					–Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit   
					different from that to which the receiver is   
					connected.   
					1. Recording Copyright—Unless it’s for personal   
					use only, recording copyrighted material is illegal   
					without the permission of the copyright holder.   
					2. AC Fuse—The AC fuse inside the unit is not user-   
					serviceable. If you cannot turn on the unit, contact   
					your Onkyo dealer.   
					Caution   
					Excessive sound pressure from earphones and   
					headphones can cause hearing loss.   
					6. Batteries and Heat Exposure   
					Warning   
					Batteries (battery pack or batteries installed) shall   
					not be exposed to excessive heat as sunshine,   
					fire or the like.   
					3. Care—Occasionally you should dust the unit all   
					over with a soft cloth. For stubborn stains, use a   
					soft cloth dampened with a weak solution of mild   
					detergent and water. Dry the unit immediately   
					afterwards with a clean cloth. Don’t use abrasive   
					cloths, thinners, alcohol, or other chemical   
					solvents, because they may damage the finish or   
					remove the panel lettering.   
					7. Never Touch this Unit with Wet Hands—Never   
					handle this unit or its power cord while your hands   
					are wet or damp. If water or any other liquid gets   
					inside this unit, have it checked by your Onkyo   
					dealer.   
					8. Handling Notes   
					4. Power   
					• If you need to transport this unit, use the original   
					packaging to pack it how it was when you   
					originally bought it.   
					• Do not leave rubber or plastic items on this unit   
					for a long time, because they may leave marks   
					on the case.   
					• This unit’s top and rear panels may get warm   
					after prolonged use. This is normal.   
					• If you do not use this unit for a long time, it may   
					not work properly the next time you turn it on, so   
					be sure to use it occasionally.   
					WARNING   
					–Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV   
					technician for help.   
					BEFORE PLUGGING IN THE UNIT FOR THE   
					FIRST TIME, READ THE FOLLOWING SECTION   
					CAREFULLY.   
					AC outlet voltages vary from country to country.   
					Make sure that the voltage in your area meets the   
					voltage requirements printed on the unit’s rear   
					panel (e.g., AC 230 V, 50 Hz or AC 120 V, 60 Hz).   
					This device complies with Industry Canada licence-   
					exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the   
					following two conditions: (1) this device may not   
					cause interference, and (2) this device must accept   
					any interference, including interference that may   
					cause undesired operation of the device.   
					Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d’Industrie   
					Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de   
					licence. L’exploitation est autorisée aux deux   
					conditions suivantes : (1) l’appareil ne doit pas   
					produire de brouillage, et (2) l’utilisateur de l’appareil   
					doit accepter tout brouillage radioélectrique subi,   
					même si le brouillage est susceptible d’en   
					The power cord plug is used to disconnect this   
					unit from the AC power source. Make sure that   
					the plug is readily operable (easily accessible) at   
					all times.   
					For U.S. and Canadian models   
					FCC CAUTION   
					Changes or modifications not expressly approved by   
					the party responsible for compliance could void the   
					user’s authority to operate the equipment.   
					For models with [POWER] button, or with both   
					[POWER] and [ON/STANDBY] buttons:   
					Pressing the [POWER] button to select OFF   
					mode does not fully disconnect from the mains. If   
					you do not intend to use the unit for an extended   
					period, remove the power cord from the AC outlet.   
					compromettre le fonctionnement.   
					Note:   
					This transmitter must not be co-located or operated in   
					conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.   
					This equipment has been tested and found to comply   
					with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to   
					part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed   
					to provide reasonable protection against harmful   
					For models with [ON/STANDBY] button only:   
					Pressing the [ON/STANDBY] button to select   
					Standby mode does not fully disconnect from the   
					mains. If you do not intend to use the unit for an   
					En-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					RF Exposure Compliance   
					This equipment complies with FCC/IC radiation   
					exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled   
					Modèle pour les Canadien   
					REMARQUE: CET APPAREIL NUMÉRIQUE DE   
					LA CLASSE B EST CONFORME À LA NORME   
					NMB-003 DU CANADA.   
					IMPORTANT   
					The plug is fitted with an appropriate fuse. If the fuse   
					needs to be replaced, the replacement fuse must   
					approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362 and have the   
					same ampere rating as that indicated on the plug.   
					Check for the ASTA mark or the BSI mark on the   
					body of the fuse.   
					If the power cord’s plug is not suitable for your socket   
					outlets, cut it off and fit a suitable plug. Fit a suitable   
					fuse in the plug.   
					environment and meets the FCC radio frequency   
					(RF) Exposure Guidelines in Supplement C to OET65   
					and RSS-102 of the IC radio frequency (RF)   
					Exposure rules. This equipment has very low levels of   
					RF energy that it deemed to comply without   
					maximum permissive exposure evaluation (MPE).   
					But it is desirable that it should be installed and   
					operated keeping the radiator at least 20 cm or more   
					away from person’s body (excluding extremities:   
					hands, wrists, feet and ankles).   
					Sur les modèles dont la fiche est polarisée:   
					ATTENTION: POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS   
					ÉLECTRIQUES, INTRODUIRE LA LAME LA PLUS   
					LARGE DE LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE   
					CORRESPONDANTE DE LA PRISE ET POUSSER   
					JUSQU’AU FOND.   
					For British models   
					Replacement and mounting of an AC plug on the   
					power supply cord of this unit should be performed   
					only by qualified service personnel.   
					For European Models   
					Declaration of Conformity   
					We declare, under our sole   
					responsibility, that this product   
					complies with the standards:   
					Cet équipement est conforme aux limites d’exposition   
					aux rayonnements énoncées pour un environnement   
					non contrôlé et respecte les régles les   
					radioélectriques (RF) de la FCC lignes directrices   
					d’exposition dans le Supplément C à OET65 et   
					d’exposition aux fréquences radioélectriques (RF)   
					CNR-102 de l’IC. Cet équipement émet une énergie   
					RF trés faible qui est considérée conforme sans   
					évaluation de l’exposition maximale autorisée.   
					Cependant, cet équipement doit être installé et utilisé   
					en gardant une distance de 20 cm ou plus entre le   
					dispositif rayonnant et le corps (à l’exception des   
					extrémités : mains, poignets, pieds et chevilles).   
					IMPORTANT   
					The wires in the mains lead are coloured in   
					accordance with the following code:   
					Blue: Neutral   
					–Safety   
					–Limits and methods of   
					measurement of radio disturbance characteristics   
					–Limits for harmonic current emissions   
					–Limitation of voltage changes, voltage fluctuations   
					and flicker   
					–RoHS Directive, 2011/65/EU   
					–Hereby, Onkyo Corporation, declares that this   
					TX-NR727 is in compliance with the essential   
					requirements and other relevant provisions of   
					Directive 1999/5/EC.   
					Brown: Live   
					As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this   
					apparatus may not correspond with the coloured   
					markings identifying the terminals in your plug,   
					proceed as follows:   
					The wire which is coloured blue must be connected to   
					the terminal which is marked with the letter N or   
					coloured black.   
					The wire which is coloured brown must be connected   
					to the terminal which is marked with the letter L or   
					coloured red.   
					For Canadian Models   
					–С настоящето, Onkyo Corporation, декларира, че   
					TX-NR727 е в съответствие със съществените   
					изисквания и другитеприложими разпоредби на   
					Директива 1999/5/EC.   
					NOTE: THIS CLASS B DIGITAL APPARATUS   
					COMPLIES WITH CANADIAN ICES-003.   
					For models having a power cord with a polarized   
					plug:   
					–Onkyo Corporation tímto prohlašuje, že TX-NR727   
					splňuje základní požadavky a všechna příslušná   
					ustanoveni Směrnice 1999/5/ES.   
					CAUTION: TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK,   
					MATCH WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT,   
					FULLY INSERT.   
					–Undertegnede Onkyo Corporation erklærer herved,   
					at følgende udstyr TX-NR727 overholder de   
					væsentlige krav og øvrige relevante krav i direktiv   
					1999/5/EF.   
					En-4   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					–Hiermit erklärt Onkyo Corporation, dass sich das   
					Gerät TX-NR727 in Übereinstimmung mit den   
					grundlegenden Anforderungen und den übrigen   
					einschlägigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie   
					1999/5/EG befindet.   
					essentiële eisen en de andere relevante bepalin-   
					gen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.   
					23764/SDPPI/2012   
					2371   
					Complies with   
					IDA Standards   
					DA106032   
					–Niniejszym Onkyo Corporation deklaruje że   
					TX-NR727 jest zgodny z zasadniczymi   
					wymaganiami i innymi właściwymi   
					TA-20120424004   
					TRA   
					–Käesolevaga kinnitab Onkyo Corporation seadme   
					TX-NR727 vastavust direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ   
					põhinõuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele   
					teistele asjakohastele sätetele.   
					postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.   
					REGISTERED No   
					ER0086260/12   
					–Eu, Onkyo Corporation, declaro que o TX-NR727   
					cumpre os requisitos essenciais e outras provisões   
					relevantes da Directiva 1999/5/EC.   
					
					527090   
					No   
					–ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ Ο ΚΑΤΑΣΚΕΥΑΣΤΗΣ Onkyo   
					Corporation ∆ΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ TX-NR727   
					ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ ΟΥΣΙΩ∆ΕΙΣ   
					ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ   
					∆ΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ ΤΗΣ Ο∆ΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ   
					–Prin prezenta, Onkyo Corporation, declară că   
					aparatul TX-NR727 este în conformitate cu   
					cerinţele esenţiale şi cu alte prevederi pertinente   
					ale Directivei 1999/5/CE.   
					Thank you for purchasing an Onkyo AV   
					Receiver. Please read this manual thoroughly   
					before making connections and plugging in the   
					
					Following the instructions in this manual will   
					enable you to obtain optimum performance and   
					listening enjoyment from your new AV Receiver.   
					Please retain this manual for future reference.   
					–Onkyo Corporation týmto vyhlasuje, že TX-NR727   
					a spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky príslušné   
					ustanovenia Smernice 1999/5/ES.   
					–Por la presente, Onkyo Corporation, declara que   
					este TX-NR727 cumple con los requisitos   
					esenciales y otras exigencias relevantes de la   
					Directiva 1999/5/EC.   
					–Onkyo Corporation izjavlja, da je ta TX-NR727 v   
					skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in drugimi   
					relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES.   
					–Par la présente, Onkyo Corporation déclare que   
					l’appareil TX-NR727 est conforme aux exigences   
					essentielles et aux autres dispositions pertinentes   
					de la directive 1999/5/CE.   
					–Onkyo Corporation vakuuttaa täten että TX-NR727   
					tyyppinen laite on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten   
					vaatimusten ja sitä koskevien direktiivin muiden   
					ehtojen mukainen.   
					Supplied Accessories   
					–Con la presente Onkyo Corporation dichiara che   
					questo TX-NR727 è conforme ai requisiti essenziali   
					ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla   
					direttiva 1999/5/CE.   
					Make sure you have the following accessories:   
					–Härmed förklarar Onkyo Corporation att denna   
					TX-NR727 följer de väsentliga kraven och andra   
					relevanta stadgar i Direktiv 1999/5/EC.   
					Indoor FM antenna (➔ page 19)   
					AM loop antenna (➔ page 19)   
					Power cord (European and Taiwanese models)   
					(➔ page 21)   
					–Ar šo Onkyo Corporation deklarē, ka TX-NR727   
					atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām prasībām   
					un citiem ar to saistītajiem noteikumiem.   
					–Hér með lýsir Onkyo Corporation því yfir að varan   
					TX-NR727 er í samræmi við grunnkröfur og aðrar   
					kröfur sem gerðar eru í tilskipun 1999/5/EC.   
					Speaker cable labels (➔ page 12)   
					Speaker setup microphone (➔ page 25)   
					Remote controller (RC-868M) and two batteries (AA/R6)   
					Quick Start Guide   
					–Šiuo Onkyo Corporation deklaruoja, kad šis   
					TX-NR727 atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas   
					1999/5/EB Direktyvos nuostatas.   
					–Onkyo Corporation erklærer herved at denne   
					TX-NR727 er i overensstemmelse med vesentlige   
					krav og andre relevante bestemmelser i direktiv   
					1999/5/EC.   
					* 
					–A Onkyo Corporation ezzennel kijelenti, hogy a   
					TX-NR727 típusú beren-dezés teljesíti az alapvető   
					követelményeket és más 1999/5/EK irányelvben   
					meghatározott vonatkozó rendelkezéseket.   
					In catalogs and on packaging, the letter at the end of the   
					product name indicates the color. Specifications and   
					operations are the same regardless of color.   
					–Hierbij verklaart Onkyo Corporation dat het toestel   
					l TX-NR727 in overeenstemming is met de   
					En-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					Initial Setup .................................................................22   
					Selecting the Language   
					Table of Contents   
					Advanced Operations   
					for the On-screen Setup Menus.............................22   
					Audyssey MultEQ: Auto Setup .................................22   
					Source Connection ...................................................23   
					Remote Mode Setup.................................................23   
					Network Connection .................................................23   
					Terminating the Initial Setup.....................................23   
					Using the Automatic Speaker Setup.........................24   
					Performing Wireless LAN Setup...............................27   
					On-screen Setup......................................................... 52   
					Using the Quick Setup.............................................. 52   
					Using the Audio Settings of Quick Setup.................. 53   
					Using the Setup Menu (HOME)................................ 56   
					Setup Menu Items .................................................... 56   
					1. Input/Output Assign.............................................. 57   
					2. Speaker Setup...................................................... 59   
					3. Audio Adjust ......................................................... 62   
					4. Source Setup........................................................ 64   
					5. Listening Mode Preset.......................................... 68   
					6. Miscellaneous....................................................... 69   
					7. Hardware Setup.................................................... 69   
					8. Remote Controller Setup...................................... 73   
					9. Lock Setup............................................................ 73   
					Multi Zone ................................................................... 74   
					Making Multi Zone Connections ............................... 74   
					Controlling Multi Zone Components ......................... 75   
					Safety Information and Introduction   
					Important Safety Instructions......................................2   
					Precautions ...................................................................3   
					Supplied Accessories...................................................5   
					Table of Contents..........................................................6   
					Features.........................................................................7   
					Front & Rear Panels......................................................8   
					Front Panel..................................................................8   
					
					Rear Panel ................................................................10   
					Remote Controller.......................................................11   
					Controlling the AV Receiver......................................11   
					Playback   
					
					Controlling Contents of USB or Network Devices.....30   
					Understanding Icons on the Display.........................31   
					Playing an Audio from Bluetooth-enabled Device ....31   
					Playing a USB Device...............................................32   
					Listening to TuneIn ...................................................32   
					Registering Other Internet Radio..............................34   
					Changing the Icon Layout   
					on the Network Service Screen..............................34   
					Playing Music Files on a Server (DLNA) ..................34   
					Playing Music Files on a Shared Folder ...................36   
					Remote Playback......................................................37   
					Listening to AM/FM Radio ........................................38   
					Playing Audio and Video from Separate Sources.....40   
					Using the Listening Modes .......................................41   
					Displaying Source Information..................................49   
					Using the Sleep Timer ..............................................49   
					Setting the Display Brightness..................................49   
					Changing the Input Display.......................................50   
					Muting the AV Receiver............................................50   
					Using the Whole House Mode..................................50   
					Using the Home Menu..............................................51   
					Connections   
					Connecting the AV Receiver......................................12   
					Connecting Your Speakers .......................................12   
					Connecting the TV/AV components..........................15   
					About RIHD-compatible components........................16   
					Operations that can be performed   
					with RIHD connection.............................................17   
					Confirm the settings ..................................................17   
					Connection Tips ........................................................17   
					Connecting the Antennas..........................................19   
					Connecting Onkyo RI Components...........................20   
					Using Headphones....................................................20   
					Controlling Other Components   
					Controlling Other Components................................. 76   
					Preprogrammed Remote Control Codes.................. 76   
					Looking up for Remote Control Codes ..................... 76   
					Entering Remote Control Codes............................... 76   
					Remapping Colored Buttons .................................... 77   
					Remote Control Codes for Onkyo Components   
					Connected via RI ................................................... 77   
					Resetting the REMOTE MODE Buttons................... 77   
					Resetting the Remote Controller .............................. 77   
					Controlling Other Components................................. 78   
					Using the Onkyo Dock.............................................. 80   
					Controlling Your iPod/iPhone ................................... 81   
					Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Turning On/Off the AV Receiver................................21   
					Connecting the Power Cord......................................21   
					Turning On ................................................................21   
					Turning Off ................................................................21   
					
					About the HYBRID STANDBY indicator....................22   
					Appendix   
					Troubleshooting......................................................... 82   
					Firmware Update ........................................................ 90   
					About HDMI................................................................. 93   
					Network/USB Features............................................... 94   
					License and Trademark Information ........................ 96   
					Specifications............................................................. 97   
					To reset the AV receiver, see page 82.   
					En-6   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					Connections   
					Features   
					• 8 HDMI Inputs (1 on front panel) and 2 Outputs   
					Amplifier   
					* 
					• 4K (up-scaling and Passthrough )-compatible HDMI   
					Inputs   
					• 110 Watts/Channel @ 8 ohms (FTC)   
					• 170 Watts/Channel @ 6 ohms (IEC)   
					• 185 Watts/Channel @ 6 ohms (JEITA)   
					• WRAT–Wide Range Amplifier Technology   
					(5 Hz to 100 kHz bandwidth)   
					• Optimum Gain Volume Circuitry   
					• H.C.P.S. (High Current Power Supply) Massive   
					High Power Transformer   
					* Compatible with HDMI IN 1 to HDMI IN 4 only   
					• Onkyo pfor System Control   
					• 3 Digital Inputs (1 Optical/2 Coaxial)   
					• Component Video Switching (1 Input/1 Output)   
					• Banana Plug-Compatible Speaker Posts   
					* 
					In Europe, using banana plugs to connect speakers to an   
					audio amplifier is prohibited.   
					• Powered Zone 2   
					• Bi-Amping Capability for FL/FR with SBL/SBR   
					• Internet Radio Connectivity   
					• Network Capability for Streaming Audio Files   
					• Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN) Connectivity   
					• Wireless Music Playback via Bluetooth   
					• Front-Panel USB Input for Memory Devices   
					• MHL-Enabled AUX Front Input   
					• 3 Stage Inverted Darlington Amplifier Design   
					Processing   
					• THX Select2 Plus Certified   
					• Incorporates Qdeo™ technology for HDMI Video   
					Upscaling (to 4K Compatible)   
					• HDMI (Audio Return Channel, 3D, DeepColor,   
					x.v.Color, Lip Sync, 4K (up-scaling and   
					Passthrough), DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS-HD High   
					Resolution Audio, Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus,   
					DSD and Multi-CH PCM)   
					Miscellaneous   
					• 40 FM/AM Presets   
					® 
					• Audyssey MultEQ to correct room acoustic   
					• Dolby TrueHD and DTS-HD Master Audio   
					problems   
					® 
					• Dolby Pro Logic IIz and Audyssey DSX   
					® 
					• Audyssey Dynamic EQ for loudness correction   
					• Non-Scaling Configuration   
					• A-Form Listening Mode Memory   
					• Direct Mode   
					• Pure Audio Mode (European, Australian and Asian   
					models)   
					• Music Optimizer for Compressed Digital Music files   
					• Phase Matching Bass System   
					• 192 kHz/24-bit D/A Converters   
					• Powerful and Highly Accurate 32-bit Processing   
					DSP   
					® 
					• Audyssey Dynamic Volume to maintain optimal   
					listening level and dynamic range   
					• Crossover Adjustment   
					(40/50/60/70/80/90/100/120/150/200 Hz)   
					• A/V Sync Control Function (up to 800 ms)   
					• Auto Standby Function   
					• On-Screen Display via HDMI   
					• Preprogrammed u-Compatible Remote   
					• Jitter Cleaning Circuit Technology   
					En-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					Front & Rear Panels   
					Front Panel   
					(North American and Taiwanese models)   
					(European, Australian and Asian models)   
					a 
					bcde f g   
					h i j k l m   
					n 
					o 
					x 
					o p q r   
					s 
					w 
					t u v   
					y 
					For detailed information, see the pages in   
					parentheses.   
					i MEMORY button (38)   
					s Input selector buttons (29)   
					t DISPLAY button (49)   
					u USB port (32)   
					j TUNING MODE button (38)   
					a 8ON/STANDBY button (21)   
					k HOME button (51)   
					b MUSIC OPTIMIZER button (North American   
					
					v SETUP MIC jack (25)   
					w HYBRID STANDBY indicator (22)   
					and Taiwanese models) (54)   
					and ENTER buttons   
					c ZONE 2 and ZONE 3 buttons (50, 75)   
					d Wi-Fi indicator (27)   
					m RETURN button   
					x RT/PTY/TP button (European, Australian and   
					
					Asian models) (39)   
					e Remote control sensor (11)   
					f Display (9)   
					49)   
					y PURE AUDIO button and indicator (European,   
					o BLUETOOTH button and indicator (31, 73)   
					p PHONES jack (20)   
					Australian and Asian models) (41)   
					g LISTENING MODE buttons (41)   
					h DIMMER button (North American and   
					q AUX INPUT HDMI/MHL jack (16)   
					r TONE and Tone Level buttons (53)   
					Taiwanese models) (49)   
					En-8   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					Display   
					s 
					abcde   
					f 
					g h   
					i 
					j 
					k l m n k e   
					o 
					p q r   
					For detailed information, see the pages in   
					parentheses.   
					i Tuning indicators   
					p SLEEP indicator (49)   
					q Channel/Unit indicators   
					ch indicator   
					RDS indicator (excluding North American and   
					Taiwanese models) (39)   
					a Z2 (Zone 2) indicator (75)   
					AUTO indicator (38)   
					TUNED indicator (38)   
					b Z3 (Zone 3) indicator (75)   
					Hz indicator   
					c 3D indicator   
					m/ft indicator   
					
					
					k Input indicators (18)   
					HDMI indicator (70)   
					This lights when a 3D input signal is detected.   
					dB indicator   
					d Headphone indicator (20)   
					r ASb (Auto Standby) indicator (71)   
					e 1, 3and cursor indicators (32)   
					f Listening mode and format indicators (41, 68)   
					g Audyssey indicator (24, 64)   
					Audyssey DSX indicator (45)   
					DIGITAL indicator   
					
					
					Dynamic EQ indicator (64)   
					
					o Message area   
					Dynamic Vol indicator (64)   
					h M.Opt (Music Optimizer) indicator (54)   
					En-9   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					Rear Panel   
					(North American, Australian and Asian models)   
					(European and Taiwanese models)   
					f 
					a 
					b c   
					d 
					e 
					g 
					n 
					hi   
					j 
					k 
					l m   
					See “Connecting Your Speakers” for connection   
					(➔ pages 12 to 20).   
					g Power cord (North American, Australian and   
					Asian models)   
					a u REMOTE CONTROL jack   
					b COMPONENT VIDEO IN and OUT jacks   
					c ETHERNET port   
					h DIGITAL IN COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks   
					i GND screw   
					j Composite video and analog audio jacks   
					d FM ANTENNA jack and AM ANTENNA terminal   
					(BD/DVD IN, CBL/SAT IN, STB/DVR IN, GAME   
					IN, PC IN, TV/CD IN, PHONO IN)   
					e HDMI IN and HDMI output (HDMI OUT MAIN and   
					HDMI OUT SUB) jacks   
					k MONITOR OUT V jack   
					f SPEAKERS terminals   
					
					m ZONE 2/ZONE 3 LINE OUT jacks   
					n AC INLET (European and Taiwanese models)   
					(CENTER, FRONT, SURROUND, SURROUND   
					BACK or FRONT HIGH, ZONE 2)   
					En-10   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Safety Information and Introduction   
					■ Aiming the remote controller   
					To use the remote controller, point it at the AV   
					receiver’s remote control sensor, as shown below.   
					For detailed information, see the pages in   
					parentheses.   
					Remote Controller   
					a 8RECEIVER button (21)   
					Controlling the AV Receiver   
					b REMOTE MODE/INPUT SELECTOR buttons   
					Remote control sensor   
					AV receiver   
					(29)   
					To control the AV receiver, press RECEIVER to   
					select Receiver mode.   
					c q/w/e/rand ENTER buttons   
					d Q SETUP button (52)   
					e Listening Mode buttons (41)   
					f DIMMER button (49)   
					g DISPLAY button (49)   
					h MUTING button (50)   
					
					j RETURN button   
					a*1   
					gc   
					b*1   
					Approx. 16 ft. (5 m)   
					RECEIVER   
					h*1   
					■ Installing the batteries   
					i*1   
					k HOME button (51)   
					l SLEEP button (49)   
					d 
					Tip   
					ac   
					• You can also use the remote controller to control Onkyo   
					Blu-ray Disc/DVD player, CD player, and other   
					components.   
					See “Entering Remote Control Codes” for more details   
					(➔ page 76).   
					j 
					k 
					d 
					Batteries (AA/R6)   
					Note   
					• If the remote controller doesn’t work reliably, try replacing   
					the batteries.   
					• Don’t mix new and old batteries or different types of   
					batteries.   
					• If you intend not to use the remote controller for a long time,   
					remove the batteries to prevent damage from leakage or   
					corrosion.   
					• Remove expired batteries as soon as possible to prevent   
					damage from leakage or corrosion.   
					■ Controlling the tuner   
					To control the AV receiver’s tuner, press TUNER (or   
					RECEIVER).   
					You can select AM or FM by pressing TUNER   
					repeatedly.   
					e 
					e 
					a q/wbuttons (38)   
					b D.TUN button (38)   
					c DISPLAY button   
					d CH +/– button (39)   
					e Number buttons (38)   
					bf   
					l 
					*1   
					These buttons can also be used when a REMOTE   
					MODE other than Receiver mode is selected.   
					En-11   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					
				Connections   
					To find the best position for your subwoofer, while   
					Speaker Configuration   
					playing a movie or some music with good bass,   
					experiment by placing your subwoofer at various   
					positions within the room, and choose the one that   
					provides the most satisfying results.   
					You can connect the powered subwoofer with two   
					SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jacks respectively.   
					The same signal is output from each jack.   
					The following table indicates the channels you should   
					use depending on the number of speakers that you   
					have.   
					No matter how many speakers you use, a powered   
					subwoofer is recommended for a really powerful and   
					solid bass.   
					To get the best from your surround sound system,   
					you need to set the speaker settings automatically   
					(➔ page 24) or manually (➔ page 59).   
					Connections   
					Tip   
					• If your subwoofer is unpowered and you’re using an   
					external amplifier, connect the subwoofer pre out jack to an   
					input on the amplifier.   
					Number of speakers   
					Front speakers   
					2 3 4 5 6 7 7   
					✔ ✔ ✔ ✔ ✔ ✔ ✔   
					Connecting the AV   
					Receiver   
					Center speaker   
					✔ 
					✔ ✔ ✔ ✔   
					Attaching the Speaker Cable Labels   
					Surround speakers   
					Surround back speaker*1   
					Surround back speakers*1   
					Front high speakers*1   
					✔ ✔ ✔ ✔ ✔   
					The speaker terminals are color-coded for   
					identification purpose.   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					Connecting Your Speakers   
					Speaker   
					Color   
					White   
					Red   
					Front left, Front high left, Zone 2 left   
					Speaker Configuration   
					Front right, Front high right, Zone 2   
					right   
					a b   
					cI J   
					f 
					5.1-channel:   
					7.1-channel:   
					7.1-channel:   
					a bcdef   
					a bcdef   
					a bcdef   
					Center   
					Green   
					Blue   
					+ 
					+ 
					G H   
					I J   
					Surround left   
					Surround right   
					Surround back left   
					Surround back right   
					Gray   
					Brown   
					Tan   
					*1   
					Front high and surround back speakers cannot be used   
					at the same time.   
					Using Powered Subwoofers   
					The supplied speaker cable labels are also color-   
					coded and you should attach them to the positive (+)   
					side of each speaker cable in accordance with the   
					table above. Then all you need to do is to match the   
					color of each label to the corresponding speaker   
					terminal.   
					d e G H   
					Front speakers   
					Center speaker   
					a b   
					c 
					Corner   
					position   
					Surround speakers   
					Subwoofer(s)   
					Surround back speakers   
					Front high speakers   
					de   
					f 
					1/3 of wall   
					position   
					G H   
					I J   
					En-12   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					Before connecting the power cord, connect all of   
					Connecting the Speaker Cables/Powered Subwoofers   
					your speakers and AV components. A setup wizard   
					is launched upon first-time use to let you perform   
					the settings.   
					Please connect a, b, c, d, eand ffor 5.1-channel surround.   
					If you’re using only one surround back   
					b 
					a 
					Front   
					speaker L   
					Front   
					speaker, connect it to the SURROUND   
					speaker R   
					BACK or FRONT HIGH L terminals.   
					• Read the instructions supplied with your speakers.   
					• By default, speakers for 7.1-channel surround are   
					configured to use: front right/front left/center/   
					surround right/surround left/surround back right/   
					surround back left/subwoofer.   
					c 
					Center speaker   
					■ Screw-type speaker terminals   
					Strip 1/2" to 5/8" (12 to 15 mm) of insulation from the   
					ends of the speaker cables, and twist the bare wires   
					tightly, as shown.   
					Red   
					Green   
					White   
					1/2" to 5/8" (12 to 15 mm)   
					■ Banana Plugs (North American models)   
					• If you are using banana plugs, tighten the speaker   
					terminal before inserting the banana plug.   
					• Do not insert the speaker code directly into the   
					center hole of the speaker terminal.   
					Gray   
					Tan   
					Brown   
					Blue   
					Powered   
					subwoofer   
					f 
					Powered   
					subwoofer   
					f 
					Surround   
					speaker R   
					e 
					Surround back or   
					Front high speaker R   
					H J   
					Surround back or   
					Front high speaker L   
					G I   
					Surround   
					speaker L   
					d 
					• Pay close attention to speaker wiring polarity. In other words, connect positive (+) terminals only to positive (+)   
					terminals, and negative (–) terminals only to negative (–) terminals. If you get them the wrong way around, the   
					sound will be out of phase and will sound unnatural.   
					En-13   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Connections   
					■ Speaker Connection Precautions   
					Bi-amping the Front Speakers   
					Important:   
					• When making the bi-amping connections, be sure to   
					remove the jumper bars that link the speakers’ tweeter   
					(high) and woofer (low) terminals.   
					Using Dipole Speakers   
					• You can connect speakers with an impedance of   
					between 4 and 16 ohms. If the impedance of any of   
					the connected speakers is 4 ohms or more, but less   
					than 6 ohms, be sure to set the minimum speaker   
					impedance to “4ohms” (➔ page 59). If you use   
					speakers with a lower impedance, and use the   
					amplifier at high volume levels for a long period of   
					time, the built-in protection circuit may be activated.   
					• Unnecessarily long, or very thin speaker cables may   
					affect the sound quality and should be avoided.   
					• Be careful not to short the positive and negative   
					wires. Doing so may damage the AV receiver.   
					• Make sure the metal core of the wire does not have   
					contact with the AV receiver’s rear panel. Doing so   
					may damage the AV receiver.   
					TV/screen   
					• Bi-amping can be used only with speakers that support   
					bi-amping. Refer to your speaker manual.   
					Bi-amping provides improved bass and treble   
					performance.   
					a 
					a 
					When bi-amping is used, the AV receiver is able to   
					drive up to a 5.1 speaker system in the main room.   
					Perform bi-amping connections by using FRONT   
					terminals and SURROUND BACK or FRONT HIGH   
					terminals as shown below.   
					Once you’ve completed the bi-amping connections   
					and turned on the AV receiver, you must set the   
					speaker setting to enable bi-amping (➔ page 59).   
					b 
					b 
					You can use dipole speakers for the surround and   
					surround back speakers. Dipole speakers output the   
					same sound in two directions.   
					Dipole speakers typically have an arrow printed on   
					them to indicate how they should be positioned. The   
					surround dipole speakers (a) should be positioned so   
					that their arrows point toward the TV/screen, while   
					the surround back dipole speakers (b) should be   
					positioned so that their arrows point toward each   
					other, as shown.   
					• Don’t connect more than one cable to each speaker   
					terminal. Doing so may damage the AV receiver.   
					• Don’t connect one speaker to several terminals.   
					Tweeter (high)   
					Woofer (low)   
					Front right   
					Front left   
					En-14   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					Use this jack to connect to the set top box/digital   
					video recorder, etc.   
					D 
					E 
					G 
					Connecting the TV/AV components   
					Use this jack to connect to the game consoles,   
					etc.   
					Before connecting the power cord, connect all of your speakers and AV components. To display the setup   
					menu on the TV screen, connecting the TV to HDMI OUT MAIN is required.   
					Use this port to connect to a LAN port on a router   
					so the AV receiver can be connected to your   
					home network.   
					F 
					J 
					G 
					H 
					I 
					E 
					D 
					C 
					B 
					A 
					Use jack and terminal here to connect the   
					supplied FM antenna and AM loop antenna.   
					H 
					I 
					Use this jack to make connections using an   
					analog audio cable.   
					With this connection, you can also enjoy analog   
					audio from external components while you are in   
					Zone 2/3.   
					Use this jack to make connections using a   
					component video cable.   
					J 
					K 
					Use this jack to connect to the camcorder/MHL-   
					enabled mobile device, etc.   
					Tip   
					If you select the input selector button, the signal from   
					the component connected to the assigned jack is   
					played.   
					Connections   
					• To listen to the audio of a component connected via HDMI   
					through your TV’s speakers, enable “HDMI Through”   
					(➔ page 70) and set the AV receiver to standby mode.   
					• In the case of Blu-ray Disc/DVD players, if no sound is   
					output despite following the above-mentioned procedure,   
					set your Blu-ray Disc/DVD player’s HDMI audio settings to   
					PCM.   
					• Connect a turntable (MM) that has a built-in phono preamp   
					to TV/CD IN, or connect it to PHONO IN with the phono   
					preamp turned off. If your turntable (MM) doesn’t have a   
					phono preamp, connect it to PHONO IN. If your turntable   
					has a moving coil (MC) type cartridge, you’ll need a   
					commercially available MC head amp or MC transformer to   
					connect to PHONO IN. See your turntable’s manual for   
					details.   
					Use this jack to connect to the HDMI input of the   
					TV. If your TV doesn’t support Audio Return   
					A 
					*1   
					Channel (ARC) , you need to connect an optical   
					digital cable together with the HDMI cable to jack   
					F.   
					Another TV can be connected to the HDMI OUT   
					SUB jack.   
					Input selector   
					buttons   
					B C D E   
					K 
					*1   
					ARC is the function that carries the audio signal   
					• Before making any AV connections, read the   
					manuals supplied with your AV components.   
					• Push plugs in all the way to make good connections   
					(loose connections can cause noise or   
					malfunctions).   
					from the TV to jack A. With ARC, a single HDMI   
					cable can connect the TV and the AV receiver.   
					Use this jack to connect to your Blu-ray Disc/DVD   
					player, etc.   
					B 
					C 
					If your turntable has a ground wire, connect it to the AV   
					receiver’s GND screw. With some turntables, connecting   
					the ground wire may produce an audible hum. If this   
					happens, disconnect it.   
					Use this jack to connect to the Satellite/cable set-   
					top box, etc.   
					• To prevent interference, keep audio and video   
					cables away from power cords and speaker cables.   
					En-15   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					■ MHL (Mobile High-Definition Link)   
					p 
					Internet radio   
					Modem   
					With its support for MHL (Mobile High-Definition Link),   
					the AUX (Front) input allows you to deliver high-   
					definition video from a connected mobile device.   
					The AV receiver allows interoperability of the CEC   
					(Consumer Electronics Control) specified in the HDMI   
					standard, which is known as RIHD. Various linked   
					operations can be performed by connecting the AV   
					receiver to an RIHD-compatible TV, player, or   
					recorder.   
					Router   
					WAN   
					LAN   
					K 
					Default setting is set to off, so it is required to change   
					the setting to on.   
					MHL-enabled   
					mobile device, etc.   
					Perform this setting after the initial setup.   
					Computer or media server   
					Do not connect the AV receiver’s USB port to a USB   
					port on your computer. Music on your computer   
					cannot be played through the AV receiver in this way.   
					Connecting to the Network (Optional)   
					About RIHD-compatible components   
					The following diagram shows how you can connect   
					the AV receiver to your home network. In this   
					example, it’s connected to a LAN port on a router,   
					which has a 4-port 100Base-TX switch built-in.   
					Network connection by wireless LAN is possible. See   
					“Performing Wireless LAN Setup” for connections   
					(➔ page 27).   
					The following components are p-compatible   
					(As of January 2013).   
					■ TV   
					• Sharp TV   
					■ Players/Recorders   
					• Onkyo and Integra p-compatible players   
					• Toshiba players and recorders   
					• Sharp players and recorders (only when used   
					together with Sharp TV)   
					The default of the assignment for the input selector buttons and jacks are as shown below. These settings can   
					be changed. (The assignment for the composite video jacks, analog audio jacks, and HDMI Front jack cannot be   
					changed.)   
					* 
					Models other than those mentioned above may have some   
					interoperability if compatible with CEC, which is part of the   
					HDMI Standard, but operation cannot be guaranteed.   
					Input selector buttons HDMI jacks   
					COMPONENT VIDEO DIGITAL IN COAXIAL Composite video and   
					Note   
					jacks   
					and OPTICAL jacks   
					analog audio jacks   
					• For proper linked operations, do not connect more   
					p-compatible components than the quantities   
					specified below, to the HDMI input terminal.   
					–Blu-ray Disc/DVD players: up to three.   
					–Blu-ray Disc/DVD recorders/Digital Video Recorders: up   
					to three.   
					–Cable/Satellite Set-top boxes: up to four.   
					• Do not connect the AV receiver to another AV receiver/AV   
					amplifier via HDMI.   
					• Proper linked operations are not guaranteed when more   
					p-compatible components than the above-   
					mentioned quantities are connected.   
					BD/DVD   
					CBL/SAT   
					STB/DVR   
					GAME   
					HDMI IN 1   
					HDMI IN 2   
					HDMI IN 3   
					HDMI IN 4   
					DIGITAL IN   
					COAXIAL 1   
					VIDEO/AUDIO IN   
					BD/DVD   
					COMPONENT VIDEO DIGITAL IN   
					IN COAXIAL 2   
					VIDEO/AUDIO IN   
					CBL/SAT   
					VIDEO/AUDIO IN   
					STB/DVR   
					VIDEO/AUDIO IN   
					GAME   
					PC   
					HDMI IN 5   
					AUDIO IN PC   
					AUX   
					HDMI Front   
					TV/CD   
					PHONO   
					DIGITAL IN OPTICAL AUDIO IN TV/CD   
					AUDIO IN PHONO   
					En-16   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					• On the TV, when you select anything other than the HDMI   
					jack to which the AV receiver is connected, the input on the   
					AV receiver will be switched to “TV/CD”.   
					• The AV receiver will automatically power on in conjunction   
					when it determines it to be necessary. Even if the AV   
					receiver is connected to an pcompatible TV or   
					player/recorder, it will not power on if it is not necessary. It   
					may not power on in conjunction when the TV is set to   
					
					Operations that can be performed with   
					RIHD connection   
					Confirm the settings   
					1. Turn on the power for all connected components.   
					2. Turn off the power of the TV, and confirm that the   
					power of the connected components is turned off   
					automatically with the link operation.   
					3. Turn on the power of the Blu-ray Disc/DVD   
					player/recorder.   
					■ For p-compatible TV   
					The following linked operations are enabled by   
					connecting the AV receiver to an p-compatible   
					TV.   
					• The AV receiver will enter standby mode when the   
					TV is set to standby.   
					• Linked functions with the AV receiver may not work   
					depending on the component model connected. In such   
					cases, operate the AV receiver directly.   
					4. Start playback on the Blu-ray Disc/DVD   
					player/recorder, and verify the following:   
					• The AV receiver automatically turns on, and   
					selects the input to which the Blu-ray Disc/DVD   
					player/recorder is connected.   
					• The TV automatically turns on, and selects the   
					input to which the AV receiver is connected.   
					5. Following the operating instructions of the TV,   
					select “Use the TV speakers” from the menu   
					screen of the TV, and confirm that the audio is   
					output from the speakers of the TV, and not from   
					the speakers connected to the AV receiver.   
					6. Select “Use the speakers connected from the AV   
					receiver” from the menu screen of the TV, and   
					confirm that the audio is output from the speakers   
					connected to the AV receiver, and not from the TV   
					speakers.   
					• You can set on the menu screen of the TV to either   
					output the audio from the speakers connected to the   
					AV receiver, or from the speakers of the TV.   
					• It is possible to output the audio coming from the   
					tuner or auxiliary input of your TV to the speakers of   
					the AV receiver. (A connection such as an optical   
					digital cable or similar is required in addition to the   
					HDMI cable.)   
					• Input to the AV receiver can be selected with the   
					remote controller of the TV.   
					• Operations such as volume adjustment or similar for   
					the AV receiver can be performed from the remote   
					controller of the TV.   
					Connection Tips   
					The video and audio signal flow   
					Connect the AV receiver between the AV   
					components and the TV. The signal from the AV   
					components is carried through the AV receiver. You   
					can enjoy the audio of the TV through the AV   
					receiver.   
					Blu-ray Disc/DVD player, etc.   
					■ For p-compatible players/recorders   
					The following linked operations are enabled by   
					connecting the AV receiver to an p-compatible   
					player/recorder.   
					Video, audio   
					AV receiver   
					Note   
					• Audio from DVD-Audio or Super Audio CD may not output   
					from the TV speakers. You will be able to output the audio   
					from the TV speakers by setting the audio output of the   
					DVD player to 2ch PCM. (It may not be possible depending   
					on the player models.)   
					• Even if you set to output audio on the TV speakers, audio   
					will be output from the speakers connected to the AV   
					receiver when you adjust the volume or switch the input on   
					the AV receiver. To output audio from the TV speakers, re-   
					do the corresponding operations on the TV.   
					• In case of an pconnection with uand uaudio   
					control compatible components, do not connect the u   
					cable at the same time.   
					Audio   
					Video, audio   
					• When playback is started on the player/recorder, AV   
					receiver will switch to the HDMI input of the   
					player/recorder that is playing back.   
					TV, projector, etc.   
					• Operation of the player/recorder is possible using   
					the remote controller supplied with the AV receiver.   
					Video components can be connected by using any   
					one of the following video connection formats:   
					composite video, component video, or HDMI, the   
					latter offering the best picture quality.   
					Video input signals flow through the AV receiver as   
					shown, with composite video and component video   
					sources all being upconverted for the HDMI output(s).   
					* 
					Depending on the model used, not all operations may be   
					available.   
					Note   
					• Do not assign an HDMI IN to the TV/CD selector at this   
					time, otherwise appropriate CEC (Consumer Electronics   
					Control) operation will not be guaranteed.   
					En-17   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					*2   
					This is possible when “Audio Return Channel” is set to   
					“Auto” (➔ page 71), the TV/CD input selector is   
					selected, and your TV is ARC capable.   
					Signal Selection Example   
					Blu-ray Disc/DVD player, etc.   
					Video Signal Flow Chart   
					Blu-ray Disc/DVD player, etc.   
					Tip   
					Composite   
					Component   
					HDMI   
					Composite   
					Component   
					HDMI   
					• When a signal is input via HDMI and the corresponding   
					input selector is selected, the HDMI indicator lights. In the   
					case of an optical or coaxial connection, the DIGITAL   
					indicator lights. In the case of an analog connection, neither   
					
					IN   
					IN   
					AV receiver   
					AV receiver   
					MONITOR OUT   
					Component   
					MONITOR OUT   
					Component   
					Composite   
					HDMI   
					Composite   
					HDMI   
					
					AV Cables and Jacks   
					TV, projector, etc.   
					• For optimal video performance, THX recommends   
					that video signals pass through the system without   
					upconversion (e.g., component video input passing   
					
					• To by-pass the upconversion, set the “Picture   
					Mode” setting to “Bypass” (➔ page 66).   
					■ HDMI   
					The composite video and component video outputs   
					pass through their respective input signals as they are.   
					HDMI connections can carry digital video and audio.   
					Note   
					• In order for the AV receiver to upconvert component input   
					to HDMI output, the source output must be set to 480i/576i.   
					When signal is input at resolution of 480p/576p and more,   
					error message will be displayed.   
					■ Component video   
					Audio components can be connected by using any of   
					the following audio connection formats: analog,   
					optical, coaxial, or HDMI.   
					When choosing a connection format, bear in mind   
					that the AV receiver does not convert digital input   
					signals for analog line outputs and vice versa.   
					Component video separates the luminance (Y) and   
					color difference signals (PB, PR), providing the best   
					picture quality (some TV manufacturers label their   
					component video sockets slightly differently).   
					■ Signal Selection   
					If signals are present at more than one input, the   
					inputs will be selected automatically in the following   
					order of priority: HDMI, component video, composite   
					video.   
					However, for component video only, regardless of   
					whether a component video signal is actually present,   
					if a component video input is assigned to the input   
					selector, that component video input will be selected.   
					And if no component video input is assigned to the   
					input selector, this will be interpreted as no   
					component video signal being present.   
					In the Signal Selection Example shown below, video   
					signals are present at both the HDMI and composite   
					video inputs. However, the HDMI signal is   
					automatically selected as the source and the video is   
					output by the HDMI outputs.   
					Green   
					Blue   
					Y 
					C 
					B/PB   
					If signals are present at more than one input, the   
					inputs will be selected automatically in the following   
					order of priority: HDMI, digital, analog.   
					C 
					R/PR   
					Red   
					Audio Signal Flow Chart   
					■ Composite video   
					Composite video is commonly used on TVs, DVDs,   
					and other video equipment.   
					Blu-ray Disc/DVD player, etc.   
					Analog   
					Optical   
					Coaxial   
					*1   
					HDMI   
					IN   
					Yellow   
					*1   
					*1   
					AV receiver   
					■ Optical digital audio   
					Optical digital connections allow you to enjoy digital   
					sound such as PCM , Dolby Digital or DTS. The   
					audio quality is the same as coaxial.   
					OUT   
					HDMI   
					*1   
					*2   
					*1   
					TV, projector, etc.   
					*1   
					Depends on the “Audio TV Out (Main)” or “Audio TV   
					Out (Sub)” setting (➔ pages 70, 71).   
					En-18   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					■ Coaxial digital audio   
					Connecting the Antennas   
					Coaxial digital connections allow you to enjoy digital   
					*1   
					sound such as PCM , Dolby Digital or DTS. The   
					This section explains how to connect the supplied indoor FM antenna and AM loop antenna.   
					audio quality is the same as optical.   
					The AV receiver won’t pick up any radio signals without any antenna connected, so you must connect the   
					antenna to use the tuner.   
					Orange   
					■ Analog audio (RCA)   
					Analog audio connections (RCA) carry analog audio.   
					
					Taiwanese models)   
					(European,Australian   
					and Asian models)   
					White   
					Red   
					Insert the plug fully   
					into the jack.   
					Insert the plug fully   
					into the jack.   
					Push.   
					Insert wire.   
					Release.   
					*1   
					For PCM signals, the supported sampling rates are   
					32/44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz. With HDMI connections, 176.4   
					and 192 kHz are also supported.   
					Assembling the AM loop antenna   
					Caution   
					Note   
					• Be careful not to injure   
					yourself when using   
					thumbtacks.   
					• The AV receiver does not support SCART plugs.   
					• The AV receiver’s optical digital jacks have shutter-type   
					covers that open when an optical plug is inserted and close   
					when it’s removed. Push plugs in all the way.   
					Thumbtacks, etc.   
					Caution   
					• To prevent shutter damage, hold the optical plug   
					straight when inserting and removing.   
					AM loop antenna (supplied)   
					Indoor FM antenna (supplied)   
					Note   
					• Once your AV receiver is ready for use, you’ll need to tune into a radio station and position the antenna to achieve the best   
					possible reception.   
					• Keep the AM loop antenna as far away as possible from your AV receiver, TV, speaker cables, and power cords.   
					Tip   
					• If you cannot achieve good reception with the supplied indoor FM antenna, try a commercially available outdoor FM antenna   
					instead.   
					• If you cannot achieve good reception with the supplied indoor AM loop antenna, try using it with a commercially available   
					outdoor AM antenna.   
					En-19   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Connections   
					Connecting Onkyo RI Components   
					Using Headphones   
					Make sure that each Onkyo component is   
					Connect a pair of stereo headphones with a   
					standard plug (1/4 inch or ø 6.3 mm) to the   
					PHONES jack.   
					1 
					1 
					connected with an analog audio cable   
					(connection I in the hookup examples)   
					(➔ page 15).   
					While the headphones plug is inserted in the   
					PHONES jack, =indicator lights.   
					Make the uconnection (see the illustration).   
					2 
					3 
					Note   
					If you’re using an RI Dock, or cassette tape   
					deck, change the Input Display (➔ page 50).   
					• Always turn down the volume before connecting your   
					headphones.   
					• While the headphones plug is inserted in the PHONES   
					jack, the speakers are turned off. (The Zone 2/3   
					speakers are not turned off.)   
					• When you connect a pair of headphones, the listening   
					mode is set to Stereo, unless it’s already set to Stereo,   
					Mono, Direct, or Pure Audio (European, Australian   
					and Asian models).   
					With u(Remote Interactive), you can use the   
					R 
					L 
					following special functions:   
					ANALOG   
					AUDIO OUT   
					e.g., cassette tape deck   
					■ System On/Auto Power On   
					When you start playback on a component connected   
					via u, while the AV receiver is on standby, the AV   
					receiver will automatically turn on and select that   
					component as the input source.   
					R 
					L 
					ANALOG   
					AUDIO OUT   
					RI Dock   
					■ Direct Change   
					When playback is started on a component connected   
					via u, the AV receiver automatically selects that   
					component as the input source.   
					
					control your other u-capable Onkyo components,   
					pointing the remote controller at the AV receiver’s   
					remote control sensor instead of the component. You   
					must enter the appropriate remote control code first   
					(➔ page 77).   
					Note   
					• Use only ucables for uconnections. ucables are   
					supplied with Onkyo components.   
					■ Remote Control   
					• Some components have two ujacks. You can connect   
					either one to the AV receiver. The other jack is for   
					connecting additional u-capable components.   
					• Connect only Onkyo components to ujacks. Connecting   
					other manufacturer’s components may cause a   
					malfunction.   
					• Some components may not support all ufunctions. Refer   
					to the manuals supplied with your Onkyo components.   
					• While Zone 2/3 is on, the System On/Auto Power On and   
					Direct Change ufunctions do not work.   
					En-20   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					the same circuit. If this is a problem, plug the AV receiver   
					into a different branch circuit.   
					Turning Off   
					• Do not use a power cord other than the one supplied with   
					the AV receiver. The supplied power cord is designed   
					exclusively for use with the AV receiver and should not be   
					used with any other equipment.   
					• Never disconnect the power cord from the AV receiver   
					while the other end is still plugged into a wall outlet. Doing   
					so may cause an electric shock. Always disconnect the   
					power cord from the wall outlet first, and then the AV   
					receiver.   
					Press 8ON/STANDBY on the front panel.   
					1 
					or   
					Turning On & Basic   
					Operations   
					Press RECEIVER followed by 8RECEIVER on   
					the remote controller.   
					The AV receiver will enter standby mode. To   
					prevent any loud surprises when you turn on the   
					AV receiver, always turn down the volume before   
					you turn it off.   
					Turning On   
					Tip   
					Turning On/Off the AV   
					Receiver   
					Press 8ON/STANDBY on the front panel.   
					1 
					• The HYBRID STANDBY indicator may light depending on   
					
					• For details on power management settings, see “Auto   
					Standby” (➔ page 71).   
					• If the HDMI Through setting is not set in standby mode, an   
					MHL-enabled mobile device cannot be charged even if it is   
					connected.   
					or   
					Press RECEIVER followed by 8RECEIVER on   
					the remote controller.   
					Connecting the Power Cord   
					
					(European and Taiwanese models)   
					1 
					■ Smooth Operation in a Few Easy Steps   
					(Initial Setup)   
					Connect the supplied power cord to the AV   
					receiver’s AC INLET.   
					To ensure smooth operation, here’s a few easy steps   
					to help you configure the AV receiver before you use   
					it for the very first time. These settings only need to   
					be made once. See “Initial Setup” for details   
					(➔ page 22).   
					To AC wall outlet   
					Plug the power cord into an AC wall outlet.   
					2 
					Note   
					• Before connecting the power cord, connect all of your   
					speakers and AV components.   
					• Turning on the AV receiver may cause a momentary power   
					surge that might interfere with other electrical equipment on   
					En-21   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Use q/won the AV receiver or remote   
					Firmware Update Notification   
					Initial Setup   
					1 
					controller to select one of the following   
					options, and then press ENTER.   
					`Yes:   
					When a new version of the firmware is available, the   
					notification window “Firmware Update Available”   
					pops up. This notification only appears when the AV   
					receiver is connected to the Internet (➔ pages 16,   
					27). To perform the firmware update, follow the   
					instructions on screen.   
					This section explains the settings that we recommend   
					you to make before using the AV receiver for the very   
					first time. A setup wizard is launched upon first-time   
					use to let you perform those settings.   
					Continues to “Audyssey MultEQ: Auto   
					Setup”.   
					`No:   
					Tip   
					Skips the settings and terminates the initial   
					setup. The setup wizard goes to   
					“Terminating the Initial Setup” (➔ page 23).   
					You can always restart the initial setup by   
					selecting “Initial Setup” in the “Hardware   
					Setup” menu (➔ page 73).   
					• The on-screen menus appear only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI OUT MAIN.   
					Use q/wand ENTER on the AV receiver or remote   
					controller to select one of the options.   
					`Update Now:   
					Selecting the Language for the On-   
					screen Setup Menus   
					Starts the firmware update.   
					Refer to “Firmware Update” (➔ page 90).   
					`Remind me Later:   
					This step determines the language used for the on-   
					screen setup menus. See “Language” in “OSD   
					
					The update notification will pop up again the   
					next time you turn the AV receiver on.   
					`Never Remind me:   
					Audyssey MultEQ: Auto Setup   
					Tip   
					Disables the automatic update notification.   
					This step performs the automatic speaker setup.   
					• Pressing HOME will close the setup wizard. To restart the   
					initial setup, select “Initial Setup” in the “Hardware Setup”   
					menu (➔ page 73).   
					Tip   
					Use q/wto select one of the following options,   
					• The update notification window can be enabled or disabled   
					in “Update Notice” (➔ page 73).   
					1 
					and then press ENTER.   
					`Do it Now:   
					After selecting the language for on-screen setup   
					menus, a welcome screen is displayed.   
					The automatic speaker setup is performed   
					following instructions on screen. Refer to   
					step 2 of “Using the Automatic Speaker   
					Setup” (➔ page 24). When this setting is   
					complete, the setup wizard continues to   
					“Source Connection”.   
					About the HYBRID STANDBY indicator   
					Initial Setup   
					By way of optimized circuitry, this function reduces   
					
					
					light in either of the following conditions:   
					–“HDMI Through” is enabled (the HDMI indicator is   
					off).   
					Welcome to initial setup. Have you connected all the speakers and devices?   
					Before starting, please connect speakers and sources.   
					Now, would you like to start initial setup?   
					1st Step : Audyssey MultEQ: Auto Setup   
					2nd Step : Source Connection   
					3rd Step : Remote Mode Setup   
					4th Step : Network Connection   
					`Do it Later:   
					Yes   
					No   
					Skips this setting.   
					Press ENTER and continue to “Source   
					Connection”.   
					HOME Exit   
					–“Network Standby” is enabled (the NET indicator   
					is off).   
					Note   
					• If Zones are turned on or, if a mobile device connected to   
					the Front Input (MHL) is charging, the HYBRID STANDBY   
					indicator won’t light.   
					En-22   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Follow the instructions on screen to perform   
					the network checking.   
					The checking is complete when the message   
					“Successfully connected.” appears at the   
					middle of the screen. Press ENTER to terminate   
					the initial setup.   
					Source Connection   
					Remote Mode Setup   
					2 
					3 
					This step checks the connection of source   
					components.   
					With this step, you can enter remote control codes for   
					the components you want to operate.   
					Use q/wto select one of the following options,   
					Use q/wto select one of the following options,   
					1 
					1 
					
					`Yes, Continue:   
					and then press ENTER.   
					`Yes:   
					Performs the remote control code input.   
					Refer to step 5 of “Looking up for Remote   
					Control Codes” (➔ page 76).   
					`No, Skip:   
					Tip   
					• If you have selected “Wireless”, you need to perform   
					the wireless LAN setup. See “Performing Wireless   
					LAN Setup” (➔ page 27). This completes the initial   
					setup.   
					Performs the checkings.   
					`No, Skip:   
					Skips this step and continues to “Remote   
					Mode Setup”.   
					If an error message appears, select one of the   
					following options and press ENTER.   
					`Retry:   
					Performs the checking again.   
					`No, Do it Later:   
					Skips this step and continues to “Network   
					Connection”.   
					Select the input selector for which you want to   
					2 
					check the connection and press ENTER.   
					The picture and sound of the corresponding   
					
					verification prompt.   
					When you’re finished, select one of the   
					following options and press ENTER.   
					2 
					`Yes, Done:   
					Skips this step and terminates the initial   
					setup. The setup wizard goes to   
					“Terminating the Initial Setup”.   
					The setup wizard continues to “Network   
					Connection”.   
					`No, not yet:   
					When prompted, use q/wto select one of the   
					3 
					following options and then press ENTER.   
					`Yes:   
					You can enter other remote control codes.   
					Confirms that the source is properly   
					displayed.   
					`No:   
					Terminating the Initial Setup   
					Displays an error report. Follow the   
					troubleshooting instructions and recheck the   
					source.   
					This step ends the initial setup process.   
					Network Connection   
					This step checks your network connection.   
					Press ENTER.   
					To restart the initial setup, select “Initial Setup”   
					1 
					Use q/wto select one of the following options,   
					4 
					Use q/wto select one of the following options,   
					1 
					in the “Hardware Setup” menu (➔ page 73).   
					and then press ENTER.   
					`Yes:   
					and then press ENTER.   
					`Yes:   
					Returns to step 2.   
					Performs the checkings.   
					`No, Done Checking:   
					The setup wizard continues to “Remote   
					Mode Setup”.   
					`No, Skip:   
					Skips this step and terminates the initial   
					setup.   
					En-23   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Measurement procedure   
					Note   
					Using the Automatic Speaker Setup   
					• Make the room as quiet as possible. Background noise and   
					Radio Frequency Interference (RFI) can disrupt the room   
					measurements. Close windows, televisions, radios, air   
					conditioners, fluorescent lights, home appliances, light   
					dimmers, or other devices. Turn off the cell phone (even if   
					it is not in use) or place it away from all audio electronics.   
					• The microphone picks up test tones played through each   
					speaker as Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup runs.   
					To create a listening environment in your home   
					theater that all listeners will enjoy, Audyssey MultEQ   
					takes measurements at up to six positions within the   
					listening area. Position the microphone at ear height   
					of a seated listener with the microphone tip pointed   
					directly at the ceiling using a tripod. Do not hold the   
					microphone in your hand during measurements as   
					this will produce inaccurate results.   
					With the supplied calibrated microphone,   
					Audyssey MultEQ automatically determines the   
					number of speakers connected, their size for   
					purposes of bass management, optimum crossover   
					frequencies to the subwoofer (if present), and   
					distances from the primary listening position.   
					® 
					Audyssey MultEQ then removes the distortion caused   
					by room acoustics by capturing room acoustical   
					problems over the listening area in both the frequency   
					and time domain. The result is clear, well-balanced   
					sound for everyone. Audyssey MultEQ can be used   
					• Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker Setup   
					cannot be performed while a pair of headphones is   
					connected.   
					■ First measurement position   
					Also referred to as the Main Listening Position, this   
					refers to the most central position where one would   
					normally sit within the listening environment.   
					Audyssey MultEQ uses the measurements from this   
					position to calculate speaker distance, level, and the   
					optimum crossover value for the subwoofer.   
					® 
					with Audyssey Dynamic EQ and   
					® 
					Audyssey Dynamic Volume (➔ page 64).   
					Before using this function, connect and position all of   
					your speakers.   
					Audyssey MultEQ offers two ways of measuring: the   
					“Audyssey Quick Start” and “Audyssey MultEQ   
					Full Calibration”.   
					• “Audyssey Quick Start” uses the measurement   
					from one position to perform the speaker setting   
					only.   
					■ Second-sixth measurement positions   
					These are the other listening positions (i.e., the   
					places where the other listeners will sit). You can   
					measure up to six positions.   
					• “Audyssey MultEQ Full Calibration” uses the   
					measurement from six positions to correct room   
					response in addition to the speaker setting.   
					The more positions are used in measuring, the better   
					the listening environment will become. We   
					
					to create the best listening environment.   
					The Quick Start takes 2 minutes and Full Calibration   
					takes about 15 minutes.   
					TV   
					d e f   
					c a b   
					: Listening area   
					a to f: Listening position   
					Total measurement time varies depending on the   
					number of speakers.   
					En-24   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Turn on the AV receiver and the connected TV.   
					On the TV, select the input to which the AV   
					receiver is connected.   
					Adjust the subwoofer volume level to 75 dB,   
					and then press ENTER.   
					Test tones are played through the subwoofer.   
					Use the volume control on the subwoofer.   
					Use q/wto select an option, and then press   
					1 
					2 
					4 
					9 
					ENTER.   
					MultEQ: Auto Setup   
					AUDYSSEY   
					Set the speaker setup microphone at the Main   
					Listening Position a, and connect it to the   
					SETUP MIC jack.   
					-- Review Speaker Configuration --   
					Subwoofer   
					Front   
					Center   
					Yes   
					100Hz   
					40Hz   
					Note   
					• If your subwoofer does not have a volume control,   
					disregard the displayed level and press ENTER to   
					proceed to the next step.   
					Surround   
					100Hz   
					None   
					120Hz   
					2ch   
					Front High   
					Surround Back   
					Surround Back Ch   
					SETUP MIC jack   
					• If you set the subwoofer’s volume control to its   
					maximum and the level displayed is lower than 75 dB,   
					leave the subwoofer’s volume control at its maximum   
					and press ENTER to proceed to the next step.   
					Save   
					Cancel   
					The options are:   
					`Save:   
					Use q/wto select “Audyssey Quick Start” or   
					“Audyssey MultEQ Full Calibration”, and then   
					press ENTER.   
					5 
					6 
					Save the calculated settings and exit   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup.   
					Speaker setup microphone   
					Press ENTER.   
					`Cancel:   
					The speaker setting menu appears.   
					® 
					Cancel Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Note   
					and Speaker Setup.   
					Speaker Setup starts.   
					• The on-screen menus appear only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI OUT MAIN. If your TV is   
					connected to other video outputs, use the AV   
					receiver’s display when changing settings.   
					Test tones are played through each speaker as   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup runs. This process takes a few minutes.   
					Please refrain from talking during   
					measurements and do not stand between   
					speakers and the microphone.   
					Do not disconnect the speaker setup microphone   
					during Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					
					setup.   
					Tip   
					• You can view the calculated settings for the speaker   
					configuration, speaker distances, and speaker levels   
					by using e/r.   
					When you’ve finished making the settings,   
					press ENTER.   
					3 
					Use q/wto select a target, and use e/rto   
					change the setting.   
					10   
					MultEQ: Auto Setup   
					AUDYSSEY   
					After the results of Audyssey MultEQ have been   
					saved, the menu will display the “Audyssey”   
					(➔ page 64), “Dynamic EQ” (➔ page 64),   
					“Dynamic Volume” (➔ page 64) settings.   
					Speakers Type (Front)   
					Powered Zone 2   
					Surround Back/Front High   
					Subwoofer   
					Normal   
					No   
					Surround Back   
					Yes   
					If you select “Audyssey Quick Start”, you will go   
					to step 9.   
					Perform the “2. Speaker Setup” according to your   
					speaker configuration:   
					Note   
					–Speakers Type (Front) (➔ page 59)   
					–Powered Zone 2 (➔ page 59)   
					–Surround Back/Front High (➔ page 60)   
					–Subwoofer (➔ page 60)   
					Place the speaker setup microphone at the   
					
					Audyssey MultEQ performs more   
					• When “Audyssey Quick Start” has been used for   
					measurement, “Audyssey” cannot be selected.   
					• These settings are applied to all input selectors.   
					7 
					8 
					measurements. This takes a few minutes.   
					Press ENTER.   
					If you use a powered subwoofer(s), go to step 4.   
					If not, go to step 5.   
					11   
					12   
					When prompted, repeat step 7.   
					Disconnect the speaker setup microphone.   
					En-25   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Error Messages   
					Note   
					The setup of the speaker can be done manually   
					(➔ page 59).   
					The setup of the volume level of each speaker also   
					can be done manually (➔ pages 60, 61).   
					• You can cancel Audyssey MultEQ® Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup at any point in this procedure simply by   
					disconnecting the setup microphone.   
					• Do not connect or disconnect any speakers during   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker Setup.   
					• If the AV receiver is muted, it will be unmuted automatically   
					when Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup starts.   
					• Changes to the room after Audyssey MultEQ Room   
					Correction and Speaker Setup requires you run   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker Setup   
					again, as room EQ characteristics may have changed.   
					While Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup is in progress, one of the error   
					messages below may appear.   
					MultEQ: Auto Setup   
					Note   
					AUDYSSEY   
					Ambient noise is too high.   
					• Please note that THX recommends any THX main   
					
					speakers using Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup, please make sure manually that any THX   
					speakers are set to “80Hz(THX)” crossover (➔ page 59).   
					• Sometimes due to the electrical complexities of subwoofers   
					and the interaction with the room, THX recommends setting   
					the level and the distance of the subwoofer manually.   
					
					notice irregular results when setting the level and/or   
					distance of the main speakers. If this happens, THX   
					recommends setting them manually.   
					Retry   
					Cancel   
					Error message   
					The options are:   
					`Retry:   
					Try again.   
					`Cancel:   
					Using a Powered Subwoofer   
					Cancel Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup.   
					If you’re using a powered subwoofer and it outputs   
					very low-frequency sound at a low volume level, it   
					may not be detected by Audyssey MultEQ Room   
					Correction and Speaker Setup.   
					• Ambient noise is too high.   
					The background noise is too loud. Remove the   
					source of the noise and try again.   
					• Speaker Matching Error!   
					The number of speakers detected was different   
					from that of the first measurement. Check the   
					speaker connection.   
					If the “Subwoofer” appears on the “Review Speaker   
					Configuration” screen as “No”, increase the   
					subwoofer’s volume to the half-way point, set it to its   
					highest crossover frequency, and then try running   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup again. Note that if the volume is set too high   
					and the sound distorts, detection issues may occur,   
					so use an appropriate volume level. If the subwoofer   
					has a low-pass filter switch, set it to Off or Direct.   
					Refer to your subwoofer’s instruction manual for   
					details.   
					• Writing Error!   
					This message appears if saving fails. Try saving   
					again. If this message appears after 2 or 3   
					attempts, contact your Onkyo dealer.   
					• Speaker Detect Error   
					This message appears if a speaker is not detected.   
					“No” means that no speaker was detected.   
					Tip   
					• See “Speaker Configuration” for appropriate settings   
					(➔ page 12).   
					En-26   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					■ PIN code method   
					Use q/wto select “Network Connection”, and   
					e/rto select “Wireless”, and then press   
					ENTER (➔ page 72).   
					Performing Wireless LAN Setup   
					5 
					6 
					1. Use q/wto select “PIN Code” and then press   
					ENTER.   
					A wireless LAN (WLAN) is a local area network that   
					relies on wireless communication.   
					To achieve a wireless network connection, you will   
					need the following component:   
					An 8-digit PIN code is displayed. The PIN   
					code is displayed scrolling on the AV   
					receiver’s display.   
					The “Wireless Setup” menu is displayed on   
					screen.   
					Tip   
					2. Input the provided code in your Access Point.   
					For information on the registration process,   
					please refer to the instruction manual   
					provided with your Access Point device.   
					• The same setting is available even if “Wireless” is   
					selected in “Network Connection” in initial setup   
					(➔ page 23).   
					■ Access point   
					Also known as the base station, it links your AV   
					receiver (wireless client) with a PC or network.   
					Access points fall into two categories: the bridge   
					type that only performs data relay in a local area   
					network, or the router type that has a built-in router   
					functionality.   
					Press q/wto select (North American models)   
					Press ENTER to confirm.   
					“Push Button Configuration (Other   
					7 
					Connection to your Access Point starts and Wi-Fi   
					indicator flashes. After the connection to your   
					Access Point is completed, Wi-Fi indicator lights   
					and the connection status is displayed on the   
					screen.   
					This completes the wireless LAN setup.   
					You can review your setup with the “Status”   
					option on the “Wireless Setup” menu.   
					*1   
					Routers)” /(excluding North American   
					models) “Push Button Configuration (Select   
					from Router)”, and press ENTER.   
					The method to make settings by “Push Button   
					Configuration” is displayed, providing the   
					following two options:   
					To achieve a wireless network connection, it is   
					
					setup can be done either automatically or manually.   
					You use your AV receiver as a wireless client   
					(wireless terminal) and connect it to a PC or to the   
					Internet.   
					Tip   
					*1   
					(North American models) To connect to Linksys   
					Note   
					E/EA Router, select “Push Button Configuration   
					(Linksys E/EA Router)” and make settings   
					following the instructions on the screen.   
					• If Wi-Fi indicator doesn’t light, the connection to your   
					Access Point is not done successfully. Configure this   
					setting again (➔ page 85).   
					Automatic wireless LAN setup   
					■ Push Button method   
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME.   
					1 
					1. Use q/wto select “Push Button” and then   
					press ENTER.   
					Use e/ror q/wto select “Setup”, and then   
					2 
					2. Press the WPS button on your Access Point   
					device.   
					press ENTER.   
					Use q/wto select “Hardware Setup”, and then   
					3 
					Tip   
					press ENTER.   
					• How long the WPS button should be pressed differs   
					depending on the type of Access Point device. Refer   
					to the instruction manual provided with your Access   
					Point device for operations.   
					Use q/wto select “Network”, and then press   
					4 
					ENTER.   
					En-27   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Turning On & Basic Operations   
					Select “OK” and press ENTER.   
					Connection to your Access Point starts and Wi-Fi   
					indicator flashes. After the connection to your   
					Access Point is completed, Wi-Fi indicator lights   
					and the connection status is displayed on the   
					screen.   
					Manual wireless LAN setup   
					Use q/wto select the Access Point you wish to   
					connect to, and then press ENTER.   
					Depending on your encryption settings, the   
					security of your Access Point will provide one of   
					the following patterns:   
					7 
					8 
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME.   
					1 
					Use e/ror q/wto select “Setup”, and then   
					2 
					press ENTER.   
					■ WEP method   
					This completes the wireless LAN setup.   
					You can review your setup with the “Status”   
					option on the “Wireless Setup” menu.   
					Use q/wto select “Hardware Setup”, and then   
					1. Use q/wto select “Default Key ID” and then   
					3 
					press ENTER.   
					press ENTER.   
					2. Use q/wto choose an ID between 1 and 4,   
					and then press ENTER.   
					Use q/wto select “Network”, and then press   
					4 
					Note   
					ENTER.   
					• If Wi-Fi indicator doesn’t light, the connection to your   
					Access Point is not done successfully. Configure this   
					setting again (➔ page 85).   
					3. Use q/wto select “Password” and then press   
					ENTER.   
					Use q/wto select “Network Connection”, and   
					5 
					e/rto select “Wireless”, and then press   
					4. Use the keyboard on screen to enter the   
					password and confirm with “OK”.   
					ENTER (➔ page 72).   
					The “Wireless Setup” menu is displayed on   
					screen.   
					■ WPA/WPA2 method   
					1. Use q/wto select “Password” and then press   
					Tip   
					ENTER.   
					• The same setting is available even if “Wireless” is   
					selected in “Network Connection” in initial setup   
					(➔ page 23).   
					2. Use the keyboard on screen to enter the   
					password and confirm with “OK”.   
					Use q/wto select “Search Wireless Network”   
					6 
					■ No encryption   
					and then press ENTER.   
					A list of available Access Points is displayed.   
					If your Access Point device is not secured by   
					encryption, there is no need to input any secret   
					key.   
					Tip   
					• If Access Point you wish to connect to is not displayed   
					in the list of available Access Points, the setting also   
					can be made by entering “SSID”, “Security”, and   
					“Password” manually after selecting “Direct Input”.   
					Tip   
					• When you select the Access Point you wish to connect to   
					from the list of available Access Points, “SSID” and   
					“Security” are automatically displayed. These settings can   
					be changed manually.   
					En-28   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Playback   
					• “Playing Music Files on a Shared Folder”   
					(➔ page 36)   
					Select the input on the AV receiver to play the   
					AV components.   
					2 
					• “Remote Playback” (➔ page 37)   
					• “Listening to AM/FM Radio” (➔ page 38)   
					• “Playing Audio and Video from Separate Sources”   
					(➔ page 40)   
					• “Controlling Other Components” (➔ page 76)   
					• “Using the Onkyo Dock” (➔ page 80)   
					Press the input selector button to which the AV   
					components to be played is connected.   
					Press the TV/CD button to play the audio of the   
					TV. Switching the input on the TV is also   
					required. Select the input to which the AV   
					receiver is connected by using the TV remote   
					controller.   
					Playback   
					* For the CEC compatible TV and the AV components   
					connected with HDMI connections, switching the input   
					is automatically performed. Switch the input manually   
					for other AV components.   
					1 
					2 
					
					Select the desired listening mode.   
					You can enjoy various types of listening mode.   
					The listening mode is switched by pressing   
					Listening mode button on the AV receiver or the   
					remote controller.   
					
					4 
					4 
					This section describes the basic operation such as   
					
					
					
					connection/setup/operation.   
					Adjust the volume.   
					You can enjoy the surround sound.   
					■ Screen Saver   
					3 
					If there is no video signal on the current input source   
					and no operation for a specific time (three minutes by   
					default), a screen saver automatically comes on.   
					Tip   
					• When listening to an HDMI component through the AV   
					receiver, set the HDMI component so that its video can be   
					seen on the TV screen (on the TV, select the input of the   
					HDMI component connected to the AV receiver). If the TV   
					power is off or the TV is set to another input source, this   
					may result in no sound from the AV receiver or the sound   
					may be cut off.   
					1 2   
					3 
					4 
					Tip   
					• The time until the screen saver activates itself can   
					be changed in the “Screen Saver” setting   
					(➔ page 69).   
					• The screen will return to its previous state if the AV   
					receiver is operated.   
					ꢀ 
					See also:   
					(Actual location of buttons depends on the country.)   
					• “Playing an Audio from Bluetooth-enabled Device”   
					(➔ page 31)   
					
					1 
					• “Playing a USB Device” (➔ page 32)   
					• “Listening to TuneIn” (➔ page 32)   
					• “Registering Other Internet Radio” (➔ page 34)   
					• “Playing Music Files on a Server (DLNA)”   
					(➔ page 34)   
					components.   
					
					
					En-29   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					TOP MENU   
					This button displays the top menu for each media or   
					service.   
					REPEAT   
					a 
					b 
					o 
					Controlling Contents of USB or   
					Network Devices   
					Press this button repeatedly to cycle through the repeat   
					modes.   
					(➔ page 31)   
					q/wand ENTER   
					Tip   
					These buttons navigate through the menus.   
					• See “Controlling Other Components” about the operation of   
					other components (➔ page 76).   
					
					image file format of JPEG, PNG, and BMP is possible. The   
					image file format cannot be displayed in either of the   
					following cases:   
					–Total number of horizontal and vertical pixels is more than   
					2048 x 2048.   
					–Image data size (JPEG/PNG) is more than 4 MB.   
					Press USB or NET first.   
					e/r   
					This button cycles through pages.   
					c 
					d 
					1 
					h 
					This button starts playback.   
					7 
					This button selects the beginning of the current song.   
					Pressing this button twice selects the previous song.   
					e 
					f 
					g 
					5 
					Note   
					This button fast-reverses the current song.   
					• The buttons you can use will differ depending on the   
					devices and media used for playback.   
					3 
					This button pauses playback.   
					• When you select the NET input selector on the AV receiver   
					for the first time, “DISCLAIMER” screen is displayed on TV.   
					Please read the contents thoroughly before using network   
					service. Select “Agree” if you agree with the content. If you   
					disagree, network service is not available on the AV   
					receiver (➔ page 89).   
					SEARCH   
					a 
					b 
					i 
					You can toggle between the playback screen and the   
					list screen during playback.   
					DISPLAY   
					h 
					i 
					j 
					k 
					l 
					m 
					n 
					o 
					This button switches between song information during   
					playback.   
					Press this button while the list screen is displayed to   
					return to the playback screen.   
					c 
					d 
					e 
					f 
					g 
					MENU   
					This button displays the menu of Internet radio   
					services.   
					RETURN   
					This button returns to the previous menu.   
					j 
					k 
					4 
					This button fast-forwards the current song.   
					l 
					m 
					n 
					6 
					This button selects the next song.   
					2 
					This button stops playback.   
					RANDOM   
					This button performs random playback.   
					En-30   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Pairing the AV receiver with a Bluetooth-   
					enabled device   
					Understanding Icons on the Display   
					Playing an Audio from Bluetooth-   
					enabled Device   
					This section describes icons that appear on the AV   
					receiver’s display during media playback.   
					Pairing is an operation where Bluetooth-enabled   
					devices register with each other beforehand. Use the   
					procedure below to pair the AV receiver with your   
					Bluetooth-enabled device. Once a pairing operation is   
					performed, it does not need to be performed again.   
					About the Bluetooth Wireless Technology   
					Icon   
					Description   
					Bluetooth wireless technology is a short-range   
					wireless technology that enables wireless data   
					communication between digital devices. Bluetooth   
					wireless technology operates within a range of about   
					15 meters (49 feet). You do not need to use a cable   
					for connection, nor is it necessary for the devices to   
					face one another, such is the case with infrared   
					technology.   
					Folder   
					Track   
					Place the Bluetooth-enabled device within   
					1 meter (3.3 feet) from the AV receiver.   
					1 
					Playback   
					Select “BLUETOOTH” in “Input” in Quick   
					2 
					Pause   
					Setup, and press ENTER (➔ page 52).   
					BLUETOOTH indicator flashes and the AV   
					receiver is put to pairing mode.   
					“Now Pairing” appears on the AV receiver’s   
					display.   
					Tip   
					Fast Forward   
					Fast Reverse   
					Artist   
					• The on-screen information appears only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI outputs.   
					• If your Bluetooth-enabled device supports A2DP protocol,   
					its audio file will play through the AV receiver.   
					• Connection is not guaranteed for all Bluetooth-enabled   
					devices.   
					Tip   
					• The same operation can be done by pressing   
					BLUETOOTH button on the AV receiver.   
					• When connecting a Bluetooth-enabled device paired   
					with the AV receiver to the AV receiver, BLUETOOTH   
					input selector is automatically selected.   
					• If you connect the AV receiver to another Bluetooth-   
					enabled device, hold down BLUETOOTH button until   
					BLUETOOTH indicator flashes or make settings in   
					“Status” of “Bluetooth” for pairing (➔ page 73).   
					• Some Bluetooth-enabled device may need to re-   
					establish pairing for each connection.   
					Album   
					Operating on the Remote Controller   
					Repeat One Track   
					Repeat Folder (USB Device)   
					Repeat   
					The Bluetooth-enabled device can be operated by the   
					supplied remote controller.   
					Tip   
					• To operate your Bluetooth-enabled device by the remote   
					controller, the Bluetooth-enabled device must support   
					profile: AVRCP.   
					• Operation by the remote controller is not guaranteed for all   
					Bluetooth-enabled devices.   
					Shuffle   
					Note   
					• “BLUETOOTH” cannot be selected, if you’ve selected   
					NET or USB as input selector in Multi Zone.   
					En-31   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					• When disconnecting on your Bluetooth-enabled device,   
					BLUETOOTH indicator on the AV receiver will go off.   
					• If there is no sound output even after the pairing is done   
					successfully, consult the instruction manual of the   
					Bluetooth-enabled device, and then select the model name   
					of the AV receiver as the audio output device.   
					• While connected to a Bluetooth-enabled device, the AV   
					receiver cannot be detected and a connection cannot be   
					established from another Bluetooth-enabled device.   
					• If you cannot connect with a paired Bluetooth-enabled   
					device, perform the pairing operation between the AV   
					receiver and the Bluetooth-enabled device again.   
					During this period (about 2 minutes), you can   
					operate the Bluetooth-enabled device to pair   
					with the AV receiver.   
					Note   
					3 
					4 
					• While the message “Connecting...” appears on the AV   
					receiver’s display, do not disconnect the USB cable   
					supplied with the USB device from the USB port.   
					Note   
					• When establishing a connection with the AV receiver,   
					select the profile (A2DP, AVRCP) at the Bluetooth-   
					enabled device. If the Bluetooth-enabled device does   
					not support the AVRCP profile, you cannot perform   
					playback or other operations with the AV receiver.   
					Listening to TuneIn   
					You need to connect the AV receiver to your home   
					network (➔ pages 16, 27).   
					Tip   
					Tip   
					• For details on the Bluetooth connection, refer to the   
					instruction manual of the Bluetooth-enabled device.   
					• The on-screen information appears only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI outputs.   
					Note   
					• Due to the characteristic of Bluetooth wireless technology,   
					the sound played on the AV receiver may slightly delay from   
					the sound played on the Bluetooth-enabled device.   
					Once the AV receiver is detected and the   
					model name of the AV receiver appears on the   
					display of your Bluetooth-enabled device,   
					select the model name.   
					When a Bluetooth connection is established   
					successfully, BLUETOOTH indicator will light.   
					TuneIn is a new radio service which offers the music,   
					sports and news all over the world.   
					Over 70,000 radio stations and 2 million on-demand   
					programs are registered, and you can easily enjoy   
					them by selecting stations or programs of your   
					choice. TuneIn is preprogrammed on the AV receiver.   
					Playing a USB Device   
					Tip   
					Tip   
					• The on-screen information appears only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI outputs.   
					Press NET.   
					• The model name appeared on the display of your   
					Bluetooth-enabled device is “Onkyo TX-NR727”.   
					1 
					The network service screen appears, and the   
					NET indicator lights. If it flashes, the AV receiver   
					is not connected to the network correctly. If wired   
					LAN connection is selected, verify that the   
					Ethernet cable is firmly connected to the AV   
					receiver. If wireless LAN connection is selected,   
					verify that the Wi-Fi indicator lights.   
					This section explains how to play music files from a   
					USB device (e.g., USB flash drives and MP3 players).   
					See also:   
					* 
					If passkey is required on the display of the   
					5 
					6 
					Bluetooth-enabled device, enter “0000”.   
					The AV receiver only supports numerical   
					passkey up to 4 digits.   
					* Passkey may be called “Passcode”, “PIN code”, “PIN   
					number” or “Password”.   
					• “Network/USB Features” (➔ page 94).   
					Press USB to select the “USB” input.   
					1 
					2 
					Plug your USB device into the AV receiver’s   
					USB port.   
					Tip   
					Play back the desired music on the Bluetooth-   
					enabled device.   
					The audio is output from the AV receiver.   
					• The same operation can be done by selecting   
					“Network Service” in the Home menu.   
					The USB indicator lights. It will flash if the AV   
					receiver cannot read the USB device.   
					Use q/w/e/rto select “TuneIn” and then   
					2 
					Press ENTER.   
					press ENTER.   
					Tip   
					3 
					A list of the device’s contents appears. To open a   
					folder, use q/wto select it, and then press   
					ENTER.   
					• The AV receiver may not work as normal depending on the   
					circumstance even though the AV receiver is placed within   
					the 15 meters range. In such cases, get the Bluetooth-   
					enabled device closer to the AV receiver and retry the   
					operation.   
					Use q/wto select a music file, and press   
					4 
					ENTER or 1to start playback.   
					En-32   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Category/Area, etc. Store your favorite stations or   
					Setting an TuneIn account   
					Use q/wto select a station or a program, and   
					then press ENTER.   
					3 
					programs in this folder.   
					To create a user account for TuneIn, open a browser   
					window such as Internet Explorer , and connect to   
					1. Select radio stations or programs, and press   
					MENU button on the remote controller.   
					2. Use q/wto select “Add to My Presets”, and   
					press ENTER.   
					Playback starts.   
					® 
					tunein.com website. With a TuneIn account, you can   
					quickly search and browse for stations and programs   
					at tunein.com website and save as your favorites   
					which will automatically appear in your AV receiver   
					My Presets account. If you have a TuneIn account,   
					select “Login” and then “I have a TuneIn account”   
					on the top list. Enter your user name and password to   
					login.   
					tunein   
					Tip   
					My Music   
					0 : 11   
					Great Artist   
					My Favorite   
					
					“My Presets” folder will not be displayed.   
					Go to Menu   
					Tip   
					Either of the following menus can be selected by   
					pressing the MENU button on the remote controller or   
					pressing ENTER button to select “Go to Menu”.   
					`Add to My Presets   
					• Select “Login with a registration code”, and associate a   
					device from my page on TuneIn website by using a   
					registration code displayed on the screen. This allows you   
					to login without entering a user name and a password.   
					In this menu, stations or programs can be stored   
					in “My Presets”.   
					`Remove from My Presets   
					
					My Favorites/My Presets   
					In this menu, stations or programs stored in “My   
					Presets” can be deleted.   
					`Report a problem   
					This menu is used to report problems on TuneIn   
					service or resolve the problems in a wizard style.   
					`View Schedule   
					In this menu, program listings of stations or   
					programs can be displayed.   
					`Clear recents   
					There are two ways you can register specific Internet   
					radio stations (programs) from the TuneIn.   
					• Adding to My Favorites   
					The selected program will be added to “My   
					Favorites” on the network service screen, which   
					appears when pressing NET.   
					1. Select radio stations or programs, and press   
					MENU button on the remote controller.   
					In this menu, all the stations and programs   
					stored in “Recents” can be deleted.   
					`Add to My Favorites   
					2. Use q/wto select “Add to My Favorites”, and   
					press ENTER.   
					3. Use q/w/e/rto select “OK”, and press ENTER.   
					In this menu, stations or programs can be stored   
					in “My Favorites”.   
					Tip   
					• You can rename the stations saved in “My Favorites”   
					(➔ page 34).   
					• Adding TuneIn radio stations or programs to My   
					Presets   
					Select "TuneIn", and press ENTER button to display   
					a folder of “My Presets” on the screen that displays   
					En-33   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Playback   
					Click “Save” to save the Internet radio station.   
					The Internet radio station is then added to “My   
					Favorites”. To play the registered station, press   
					NET, and then select “My Favorites” on the   
					network service screen. A list of registered   
					Internet radio stations appears. Select the one   
					that you saved and press ENTER.   
					Registering Other Internet Radio   
					Changing the Icon Layout on the   
					Network Service Screen   
					5 
					You need to connect the AV receiver to your home   
					network (➔ pages 16, 27).   
					Tip   
					Tip   
					• You need to connect your TV to the HDMI output (HDMI   
					OUT MAIN) to make the following on-screen setting.   
					• The on-screen information appears only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI outputs.   
					The layout of icons can be customized by switching   
					their positions on the network service screen.   
					Internet radio URLs in the following formats are   
					supported: PLS, M3U, and podcast (RSS). However,   
					depending on the type of data or audio format used   
					by the Internet radio station, you may not be able to   
					listen to some stations.   
					To listen to other Internet radio stations, you must   
					register your station in “My Favorites” of the network   
					service screen, as described below.   
					Tip   
					• If you want to add a new station directly from “My   
					Favorites”, select an empty slot in the list and press MENU.   
					Then, select “Create New Station” and press ENTER.   
					Pressing ENTER again will display the keyboard screen.   
					Use that keyboard to enter the station’s name and URL   
					respectively, and then press ENTER.   
					Press NET.   
					The network service screen appears.   
					1 
					Tip   
					• The same operation can be done by selecting   
					“Network Service” in the Home menu.   
					• If you want to delete a station saved in “My Favorites”,   
					press MENU with the station selected or while the station is   
					playing. Then, use q/wto select “Delete from My   
					Favorites” and press ENTER. You can also delete stations   
					from the Web Setup.   
					Press MODE/D (blue) on the remote controller.   
					2 
					Note   
					• Services available may vary depending on the region. See   
					the separate instructions for more information.   
					• Certain network service or contents available through this   
					device may not be accessible in case the service provider   
					terminates its service.   
					Use q/w/e/rto select an icon to move, and   
					3 
					then press ENTER.   
					• If you want to rename a station, select the desired station   
					and press MENU. Then, use q/wto select “Rename this   
					station” and press ENTER.   
					Use q/w/e/rto select another icon as the   
					4 
					destination, and then press ENTER.   
					The icons switch positions and the message   
					“Completed!” appears.   
					• You can save up to 40 Internet radio stations.   
					Select “Network” on the Setup menu to verify   
					your IP address (➔ page 72).   
					1 
					Take a note of the IP address.   
					Playing Music Files on a Server (DLNA)   
					On your computer, start your web browser.   
					2 
					3 
					You need to connect the AV receiver to your home   
					network (➔ pages 16, 27).   
					Enter the AV receiver’s IP address in the   
					browser’s Internet address (URL) field.   
					Tip   
					® 
					If you are using Internet Explorer , you can also   
					• The on-screen information appears only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI outputs.   
					enter the URL by selecting “Open...” on the “File”   
					menu.   
					Information on the AV receiver is then shown on   
					your Internet browser (Web Setup).   
					This section explains how to play music files on a   
					computer or media server through the AV receiver   
					(Server Playback).   
					Click on the “My Favorites” tab, and enter the   
					Internet radio station’s name and URL.   
					4 
					En-34   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Windows Media Player Setup   
					On the “Stream” menu, select “Turn on media   
					streaming”.   
					A dialog box appears.   
					Use q/w/e/rto select “DLNA”, and press   
					2 
					3 
					3 
					4 
					ENTER.   
					■ Windows Media Player 11 Setup   
					Use q/wto select a server, and then press   
					This section explains how to configure Windows   
					Media Player 11 so that the AV receiver can play the   
					music files stored on your computer.   
					Tip   
					ENTER.   
					• If the media streaming is already activated, clicking on   
					“More streaming options...” in the “Stream” menu will   
					display a list of the playback devices connected to the   
					network. You can skip step 3.   
					The menu is displayed according to the server   
					functions.   
					Start Windows Media Player 11.   
					Note   
					1 
					2 
					• The search function does not work with media servers   
					which do not support this function.   
					• Photos and movies stored on a media server cannot   
					be accessed from the AV receiver.   
					• Depending on the sharing settings in the media server,   
					the AV receiver may not able to access the content.   
					See the instruction manual of the media server.   
					Move your cursor and click on “Turn on media   
					streaming”.   
					A list of media server appears. Wording may vary   
					slightly depending on the network location.   
					On the “Library” menu, select “Media   
					Sharing”.   
					The “Media Sharing” dialog box appears.   
					Select the “Share my media” check box, and   
					then click “OK”.   
					3 
					On the “Media streaming options”, select the   
					AV receiver and confirm that it is set to   
					“Allowed”.   
					4 
					5 
					A list of the supported devices appears.   
					Use q/wto select an item, and then press   
					5 
					Select the AV receiver in the list, and then   
					click “Allow”.   
					4 
					ENTER or 1to start playback.   
					Click “OK” to close the dialog box.   
					This completes the Windows Media Player 12   
					configuration.   
					You can now play the music files in your   
					Windows Media Player 12 library.   
					The corresponding icon will be checked.   
					dlna   
					Click “OK” to close the dialog box.   
					This completes the Windows Media Player 11   
					configuration.   
					5 
					My favorite song 1   
					0 :11 / 3:00   
					Artist name   
					My favorite album   
					You can now play the music files in your   
					Windows Media Player 11 library through the AV   
					receiver.   
					Playing music files on a server (DLNA)   
					Start your computer or media server.   
					1 
					2 
					Tip   
					Note   
					• Windows Media Player 11 can be downloaded for free   
					from the Microsoft web site.   
					Press NET.   
					• Depending on the media server, 5/4/3may not   
					The network service screen appears, and the   
					NET indicator lights. If it flashes, the AV receiver   
					is not connected to the network correctly. If wired   
					LAN connection is selected, verify that the   
					Ethernet cable is firmly connected to the AV   
					receiver. If wireless LAN connection is selected,   
					verify that the Wi-Fi indicator lights.   
					work.   
					• If the message “No Item.” appears, this means that no   
					information can be retrieved from the server. In this   
					case, check your server, network, and AV receiver   
					connections.   
					■ Windows Media Player 12 Setup   
					This section explains how to configure Windows   
					Media Player 12 so that the AV receiver can play the   
					music files stored on your personal computer.   
					Start Windows Media Player 12.   
					1 
					Tip   
					• The same operation can be done by selecting   
					“Network Service” in the Home menu.   
					En-35   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Playback   
					Playing music files on a shared folder   
					■ Creating a shared folder   
					Playing Music Files on a Shared Folder   
					In order to enjoy Home Media, you must first create a   
					shared folder on your computer.   
					Right-click the folder that you want to share.   
					This section explains how to play music files on a   
					computer or NAS (Network Attached Storage)   
					through the AV receiver.   
					1 
					2 
					3 
					Select “Properties”.   
					Press NET.   
					1 
					The network service screen appears, and the   
					NET indicator lights. If it flashes, the AV receiver   
					is not connected to the network correctly. If wired   
					LAN connection is selected, verify that the   
					Ethernet cable is firmly connected to the AV   
					receiver. If wireless LAN connection is selected,   
					verify that the Wi-Fi indicator lights.   
					On the “Sharing” tab, select “Advanced   
					Sharing”.   
					Windows 8/Windows 7 Setup   
					Check the check box of “Share this folder”   
					and then click “OK”.   
					■ Setting the sharing options   
					4 
					Select “Choose homegroup and sharing   
					options” on the Control Panel.   
					Under “Network File and Folder Sharing”,   
					select “Share”.   
					1 
					5 
					Tip   
					Select “Everyone” from the pull-down menu,   
					click “Add”, and then click “Share”.   
					Tip   
					6 
					• If this option is not available, verify that “View by:” is set   
					to “Category”.   
					• The same operation can be done by selecting   
					“Network Service” in the Home menu.   
					Tip   
					Select “Change advanced sharing settings”.   
					2 
					3 
					• With this setting, everyone is allowed to access the   
					folder. If you want to assign a user name and   
					password to the folder, make the corresponding   
					settings for “Permissions” in “Advanced Sharing” of the   
					“Sharing” tab.   
					Use q/w/e/rto select “Home Media”, and   
					2 
					press ENTER.   
					Under “Home or Work”, verify that the   
					following items are checked:   
					Use q/wto select a server, and then press   
					3 
					“Turn on network discovery”, “Turn on file and   
					printer sharing”, “Turn on sharing so anyone with   
					network access can read and write files in the   
					Public folders”, and “Turn off password protected   
					sharing”.   
					ENTER.   
					Tip   
					• Verify that “Workgroup” is properly set.   
					Note   
					• The server name of your computer can be viewed on   
					the computer properties screen.   
					• When using NAS (Network Attached Storage), refer to   
					the instruction manual provided with your NAS unit.   
					Use q/wto select the desired shared folder   
					4 
					Select “Save changes” and click “OK” on the   
					confirmation screen.   
					4 
					and then press ENTER.   
					When asked for a user name and password,   
					enter the necessary login information.   
					Tip   
					5 
					• The login information will be remembered for the next   
					time you log in.   
					• The login information is that of the user account set   
					when creating a shared folder.   
					Use q/wto select a music file and then press   
					6 
					ENTER or 1.   
					The playback of the selected file starts.   
					En-36   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Click “OK” to close the dialog box.   
					This completes the Windows Media Player 12   
					configuration.   
					You can now play the music files in your   
					Windows Media Player 12 library.   
					Adjusting the Volume.   
					Remote Playback   
					5 
					5 
					You can adjust the volume by adjusting the   
					volume bar in the “Remote playback” window.   
					The default maximum volume level is 82 (0dB). If   
					you wish to change this, enter the value from the   
					Web Setup in your browser. Refer to step 3 of   
					“Registering Other Internet Radio” for details   
					(➔ page 34).   
					The volume value of the remote window and the   
					volume value of the AV receiver may not always   
					match.   
					You need to connect the AV receiver to your home   
					network (➔ pages 16, 27).   
					Tip   
					• The on-screen information appears only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI outputs.   
					Tip   
					• On the “Stream” menu, confirm that “Allow remote   
					control of my Player...” is checked.   
					Remote playback is supported by Windows Media   
					Player 12.   
					Remote Playback means you can play the music files   
					stored on a media server or personal computer with   
					the AV receiver by operating the controller device in   
					the home network.   
					Using Remote Playback   
					Adjustments you make to the volume in the AV   
					receiver will not be reflected in the “Remote   
					playback” window.   
					Turn on the AV receiver.   
					1 
					2 
					Start Windows Media Player 12.   
					To enable remote playback, you must first   
					configure Windows Media Player 12.   
					Windows Media Player 12 Setup   
					Note   
					This section explains how to configure Windows   
					Media Player 12 so that the AV receiver can play the   
					music files stored on your personal computer.   
					• Remote playback cannot be used in any of the following   
					cases:   
					–Network services are being used.   
					On Windows Media Player 12, right-click on a   
					music file.   
					3 
					–Contents are being played from a USB device.   
					–“Agree” is not selected on the “DISCLAIMER” screen   
					displayed on the TV when you select the NET input   
					selector on the AV receiver for the first time.   
					The right-click menu appears.   
					Start Windows Media Player 12.   
					1 
					2 
					Tip   
					• For selecting another media server, select the desired   
					media server from the “Other Libraries” menu on   
					Windows Media Player 12.   
					On the “Stream” menu, select “Turn on media   
					streaming”.   
					A dialog box appears.   
					Select the AV receiver in “Remote playback”.   
					4 
					Tip   
					The “Play to” window appears and playback on   
					the AV receiver starts. Operations during remote   
					playback can be made from the “Play to” window   
					of Windows 8/Windows 7 on your personal   
					computer.   
					• If the media streaming is already activated, clicking on   
					“More streaming options...” in the “Stream” menu will   
					display a list of the playback devices connected to the   
					network. You can skip step 3.   
					Move your cursor and click on “Turn on media   
					streaming”.   
					A list of media server appears. Wording may vary   
					slightly depending on the network location.   
					3 
					A playback screen will be displayed on the   
					connected TV.   
					Tip   
					• If the operating system of your personal computer is   
					Windows 8, click “Play to” and select the AV receiver.   
					On the “Media streaming options”, select the   
					AV receiver and confirm that it is set to   
					“Allowed”.   
					4 
					En-37   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Playback   
					■ Tuning into stations by frequency   
					You can tune into AM and FM stations directly by   
					entering the appropriate frequency.   
					Press TUNING q/w.   
					Listening to AM/FM Radio   
					2 
					Searching stops when a station is found.   
					This section describes the procedure of using the   
					buttons on the front panel, unless otherwise specified.   
					When tuned into a station, the TUNED indicator   
					lights. When tuned into a stereo FM station, the   
					FM STEREO indicator lights as shown.   
					On the remote controller, press TUNER   
					repeatedly to select “AM” or “FM”, followed by   
					D.TUN.   
					1 
					Using the Tuner   
					With the built-in tuner you can enjoy AM and FM radio   
					stations. You can store your favorite stations as   
					presets for quick selection.   
					TUNED   
					AUTO   
					You can also change the frequency steps   
					(➔ page 69).   
					(Actual display depends on the country.)   
					FM STEREO   
					Within 8 seconds, use the number buttons to   
					Press TUNER to select either “AM” or “FM”.   
					2 
					1 
					enter the frequency of the radio station.   
					For example, to tune to 87.5 (FM), press 8, 7, 5   
					or 8, 7, 5, 0.   
					If you have entered the wrong number, you can   
					retry after 8 seconds.   
					In this example, FM has been selected.   
					Each time you press TUNER, the radio band   
					changes between AM and FM.   
					Tip   
					• Tuning into weak FM stereo stations   
					If the signal from a stereo FM station is weak, it may   
					be impossible to get good reception. In this case,   
					switch to manual tuning mode and listen to the station   
					in mono.   
					Band   
					Frequency   
					Presetting AM/FM Stations   
					You can store a combination of up to 40 of your   
					favorite AM/FM radio stations as presets.   
					■ Manual tuning mode   
					In manual tuning mode, FM stations will be in mono.   
					(Actual display depends on the country.)   
					Tuning into Radio Stations   
					■ Auto tuning mode   
					Tune into the AM/FM station that you want to   
					store as a preset.   
					1 
					Press TUNING MODE so that the AUTO   
					indicator goes off on the AV receiver’s   
					display.   
					1 
					See the previous section.   
					Press MEMORY.   
					The preset number flashes.   
					2 
					Press TUNING MODE so that the AUTO   
					Press and hold TUNING q/w.   
					1 
					2 
					indicator lights on the AV receiver’s display.   
					The frequency stops changing when you release   
					the button.   
					Press the buttons repeatedly to change the   
					frequency one step at a time.   
					(Actual display depends on the country.)   
					While the preset number is flashing (about 8   
					3 
					seconds), use PRESET e/rto select a preset   
					from 1 through 40.   
					En-38   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					■ What is RDS?   
					■ Displaying Radio Text (RT)   
					Press MEMORY again to store the station or   
					channel.   
					The station or channel is stored and the preset   
					number stops flashing.   
					Repeat this procedure for all of your favorite   
					AM/FM radio stations.   
					4 
					RDS stands for Radio Data System and is a method   
					of transmitting data in FM radio signals. It was   
					developed by the European Broadcasting Union   
					(EBU) and is available in most European countries.   
					Many FM stations use it these days. In addition to   
					displaying text information, RDS can also help you   
					find radio stations by type (e.g., news, sport, rock,   
					etc.).   
					Press RT/PTY/TP once.   
					The RT information scrolls across the AV   
					receiver’s display.   
					1 
					Note   
					• The message “Waiting” may appear while the AV   
					receiver waits for the RT information.   
					• If the message “No Text Data” appears, no RT   
					information is available.   
					■ Selecting Presets   
					The AV receiver supports four types of RDS   
					information:   
					PS (Program Service)   
					When tuned to an RDS station that’s broadcasting PS   
					information, the station’s name will be displayed.   
					Pressing DISPLAY will display the frequency for 3   
					seconds.   
					To select a preset, use PRESET e/ron the AV   
					1 
					receiver, or the remote controller’s CH +/–.   
					Tip   
					■ Finding Stations by Type (PTY)   
					You can search for radio stations by type.   
					• You can also use the remote controller’s number   
					buttons to select a preset directly.   
					Press RT/PTY/TP twice.   
					The current program type appears on the AV   
					receiver’s display.   
					1 
					RT (Radio Text)   
					When tuned to an RDS station that’s broadcasting   
					text information, the text will be shown on the AV   
					receiver’s display.   
					PTY (Program Type)   
					This allows you to search for RDS radio stations by   
					type.   
					TP (Traffic Program)   
					This allows you to search for RDS radio stations that   
					broadcast traffic information (➔ page 40).   
					■ Deleting Presets   
					Use PRESET e/rto select the type of   
					2 
					Select the preset that you want to delete.   
					See the previous section.   
					program you want.   
					See the table shown later in this chapter.   
					1 
					While holding down MEMORY, press TUNING   
					MODE.   
					To start the search, press ENTER.   
					2 
					3 
					The AV receiver searches until it finds a station of   
					the type you specified, at which point it stops   
					briefly before continuing with the search.   
					The preset is deleted and its number disappears   
					from the AV receiver’s display.   
					When a station you want to listen to is found,   
					press ENTER.   
					If no stations are found, the message “Not   
					Found” appears.   
					4 
					Using RDS (excluding North American and   
					Taiwanese models)   
					Note   
					• RDS works only in areas where RDS broadcasts are   
					available.   
					When tuned into an RDS station, the RDS indicator   
					lights.   
					When the station is broadcasting text information, the   
					text can be displayed.   
					• In some cases, the text characters displayed on the AV   
					receiver may not be identical to those broadcast by the   
					radio station. Also, unexpected characters may be   
					displayed when unsupported characters are received. This   
					is not a malfunction.   
					• If the signal from an RDS station is weak, RDS data may be   
					displayed intermittently or not at all.   
					En-39   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					■ Listening to Traffic News (TP)   
					RDS program types (PTY)   
					Playing Audio and Video from Separate   
					Sources   
					Type   
					Display   
					You can search for stations that broadcast traffic   
					news.   
					None   
					None   
					You can listen to the audio of one input source while   
					watching the video of another. This function takes   
					advantage of the fact that when an audio-only input   
					source (PHONO, TV/CD, PC, TUNER) is selected,   
					the video input source remains unchanged. The   
					following procedure shows how to listen to a CD   
					player’s audio source connected to TV/CD IN while   
					watching a Blu-ray Disc/DVD player’s video source   
					connected to BD/DVD.   
					News reports   
					Current affairs   
					Information   
					Sport   
					News   
					Press RT/PTY/TP three times.   
					Affairs   
					1 
					If the current radio station is broadcasting TP   
					(Traffic Program), “[TP]” will appear on the AV   
					receiver’s display. If “TP” without square brackets   
					appears, this means that the station is not   
					broadcasting TP.   
					Info   
					Sport   
					Education   
					Educate   
					Drama   
					Culture   
					Science   
					Varied   
					Pop M   
					Rock M   
					Easy M   
					Light M   
					Classics   
					Other M   
					Weather   
					Finance   
					Children   
					Social   
					Drama   
					Culture   
					To locate a station that is broadcasting TP,   
					press ENTER.   
					Science and technology   
					Varied   
					2 
					Tip   
					The AV receiver searches until it finds a station   
					that’s broadcasting TP.   
					If no stations are found, the message “Not   
					Found” appears.   
					Pop music   
					Rock music   
					Middle of the road music   
					Light classics   
					Serious classics   
					Other music   
					Weather   
					
					assign all video inputs to “- - - - -” (➔ page 58).   
					Press BD/DVD.   
					1 
					2 
					Press TV/CD.   
					The audio output changes to the CD source, but   
					the video of previously-selected BD/DVD is   
					retained.   
					Finance   
					Children’s programmes   
					Social affairs   
					Religion   
					Start playback on your Blu-ray Disc/DVD and   
					CD players.   
					3 
					Religion   
					Phone In   
					Travel   
					You can now enjoy watching your Blu-ray   
					Disc/DVD with the sound of your CD player.   
					Phone in   
					Travel   
					Leisure   
					Leisure   
					Jazz   
					Jazz music   
					Country music   
					National music   
					Oldies music   
					Folk music   
					Documentary   
					Alarm test   
					Country   
					Nation M   
					Oldies   
					Folk M   
					Document   
					TEST   
					Alarm   
					Alarm!   
					En-40   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					PURE AUDIO button and indicator   
					(European, Australian and Asian models)   
					(North American and Taiwanese models)   
					Using the Listening Modes   
					About Listening Modes   
					This button selects the Pure Audio listening mode.   
					When this mode is selected, the AV receiver’s display   
					and analog video circuitry are turned off. Only video   
					signals input through HDMI input can be output from   
					the HDMI output. The indicator lights when this mode   
					is selected. Pressing this button again will select the   
					previous listening mode.   
					The AV receiver’s listening modes can transform your   
					listening room into a movie theater or concert hall,   
					with high fidelity and stunning surround sound.   
					Selecting Listening Modes   
					■ Listening Mode Buttons   
					Press RECEIVER first.   
					MOVIE/TV, MUSIC, GAME,THX   
					Note   
					• The Dolby Digital and DTS listening modes can only be   
					selected if your Blu-ray Disc/DVD player is connected to the   
					AV receiver with a digital audio connection (coaxial, optical,   
					or HDMI).   
					(European, Australian and Asian models)   
					
					of the input signal. To check the format, see “Displaying   
					Source Information” (➔ page 49).   
					• While a pair of headphones is connected, you can select   
					the following listening modes: Pure Audio (European,   
					Australian and Asian models), Mono, Direct, and Stereo.   
					PURE AUDIO   
					MOVIE/TV, MUSIC, GAME,THX   
					MOVIE/TV button   
					This button selects the listening modes intended for   
					use with movies and TV.   
					MUSIC button   
					This button selects the listening modes intended for   
					use with music.   
					GAME button   
					This button selects the listening modes intended for   
					use with video games.   
					MUSIC   
					MOVIE/TV   
					GAME   
					THX   
					THX button   
					This button selects the THX listening modes.   
					En-41   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Input Source   
					■ Onkyo-Original DSP Listening Modes   
					The following audio formats are supported by the listening modes.   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Speaker   
					Source Layout   
					This is mono (monophonic) sound.   
					A 
					Orchestra   
					Suitable for classical or operatic music,   
					this mode emphasizes the surround   
					channels in order to widen the stereo   
					image, and simulates the natural   
					reverberation of a large hall.   
					A CN   
					This is stereo (stereophonic) sound. Two independent audio signal channels   
					are reproduced through two speakers.   
					S 
					S 
					O r c h e s t r a   
					D 
					This is 5.1-channel surround sound. This surround system has five main   
					channels of sound and a sixth subwoofer channel (called the point-one   
					channel).   
					D 
					F 
					G 
					Unplugged   
					
					and jazz, this mode emphasizes the   
					front stereo image, giving the impression   
					of being right in front of the stage.   
					H 
					This is 7.1-channel surround sound. This is a further sound enhancement to   
					5.1-channel sound with two additional speakers that provide greater sound   
					envelopment and more accurate positioning of sounds.   
					F 
					U n p l u g g e d   
					This is DTS-ES surround sound. This surround system can produce a discrete   
					or a matrix-encoded sixth channel from existing DTS 5.1 encoded material.   
					G 
					Studio-Mix   
					Suitable for rock or pop music, listening   
					to music in this mode creates a lively   
					sound field with a powerful acoustic   
					image, like being at a club or rock   
					concert.   
					S t u d i o – M i x   
					This is Dolby Digital EX surround sound. This provides a center back surround   
					channel from 5.1-channel sources.   
					H 
					Speaker Layout   
					TV Logic   
					This mode adds realistic acoustics to TV   
					shows produced in a TV studio,   
					surround effects to the entire sound, and   
					clarity to voices.   
					The illustration shows which speakers are activated in each channel. See   
					“Speaker Configuration” for the speaker setup (➔ page 59).   
					T V L o g i c   
					Z 
					X 
					C 
					Game-RPG   
					G a me – R PG   
					Game-Action   
					In this mode, the sound has a dramatic   
					feel with a similar atmosphere to   
					Orchestra mode.   
					In this mode, sound localization is   
					distinct with emphasis on bass.   
					G a me – A c t i o n   
					Game-Rock   
					In this mode, sound pressure is   
					emphasized to heighten live feel.   
					G a me – R o c k   
					B 
					V 
					Game-Sports   
					Suitable for audio source with much   
					reverberation.   
					G a me – S p o r t s   
					All Ch Stereo   
					Ideal for background music, this mode   
					fills the entire listening area with stereo   
					sound from the front, surround, and   
					surround back speakers.   
					XCN   
					A l   
					l 
					C h S t e r e o   
					Full Mono   
					In this mode, all speakers output the   
					same sound in mono, so the sound you   
					hear is the same regardless of where   
					you are within the listening room.   
					F u l   
					l 
					M o n o   
					En-42   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Playback   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					Listening Mode   
					DSD*4   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					T-D (Theater-   
					Dimensional)   
					With this mode you can enjoy a virtual   
					surround sound even with only two or   
					three speakers. This works by   
					controlling how sounds reach the   
					listener’s left and right ears. Good   
					results may not be possible if there’s too   
					much reverb, so we recommend that   
					you use this mode in an environment   
					with little or no natural reverb.   
					In this mode, audio from the input source   
					is output without surround-sound   
					processing. The speaker configuration   
					(presence of speakers), crossover   
					frequency, speaker distance, A/V Sync   
					and much of the processing set via the   
					audio setup are enabled. See “On-   
					screen Setup” for more details   
					A ZXC   
					S N   
					D 
					D XCN   
					D S D   
					T – D   
					Dolby Digital   
					F 
					D o l b y   
					D 
					G 
					H 
					Dolby Digital Plus*5   
					D XCN   
					F XCN   
					*3   
					D o l b y   
					D 
					+ 
					(➔ page 52).   
					Dolby TrueHD   
					■ Listening Modes   
					D o l b y T r u e HD   
					DTS   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					D XCN   
					D T S   
					Pure Audio*1*2   
					In this mode, the display and video   
					circuitry are turned off, minimizing   
					possible noise sources for the ultimate in   
					high-fidelity audio reproduction. (As the   
					analog video circuitry is turned off, only   
					video signals input through HDMI IN can   
					be output from the HDMI output.)   
					A ZXC   
					DTS-HD High   
					Resolution Audio   
					D XCN   
					F XCN   
					*3   
					S N   
					P u r e A A u d i o   
					*3   
					D 
					F 
					G 
					H 
					D T S – HD HR   
					DTS-HD Master   
					Audio   
					D T S – HD MS T R   
					Direct   
					In this mode, audio from the input source   
					is output without surround-sound   
					DTS Express   
					D XCN   
					D XCN   
					D i r e c t   
					processing. The speaker configuration   
					(presence of speakers) and speaker   
					distance settings are enabled, but much   
					of the processing set via the audio setup   
					is disabled. See “On-screen Setup” for   
					more details (➔ page 52).   
					D T S E x p r e s s   
					DTS 96/24*6   
					This mode is for use with DTS 96/24   
					sources. This is high-resolution DTS   
					with a 96 kHz sampling rate and 24-bit   
					resolution, providing superior fidelity.   
					Use it with DVDs that bear the DTS   
					96/24 logo.   
					D T S 9 6 / 2 4   
					Stereo   
					Sound is output from the front left and   
					right speakers and subwoofer.   
					
					N 
					S t e r e o   
					DTS-ES Discrete*7   
					This mode is for use with DTS-ES   
					Discrete soundtracks, which use a   
					discrete surround back channel for true   
					6.1/7.1-channel playback. The seven   
					totally separate audio channels provide   
					better spatial imaging and 360-degree   
					sound localization, perfect for sounds   
					that pan across the surround channels.   
					Use it with DVDs that bear the DTS-ES   
					logo, especially those with a DTS-ES   
					Discrete soundtrack.   
					G V   
					Mono   
					Use this mode when watching an old   
					movie with a mono soundtrack, or use it   
					with the foreign language soundtracks   
					recorded in the left and right channels of   
					some movies. It can also be used with   
					DVDs or other sources containing   
					multiplexed audio, such as karaoke   
					DVDs.   
					E S D i s c r e t e   
					M o n o   
					Multichannel   
					
					multichannel sources.   
					D XCN   
					F 
					M u l   
					t 
					i c h   
					En-43   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					DTS-ES Matrix*7   
					This mode is for use with DTS-ES Matrix   
					soundtracks, which use a matrix-   
					encoded back-channel for 6.1/7.1-   
					channel playback. Use it with DVDs that   
					bear the DTS-ES logo, especially those   
					with a DTS-ES Matrix soundtrack.   
					Dolby Pro Logic IIz   
					Height   
					Dolby Pro Logic IIz Height is designed   
					to more effectively use existing program   
					material when height channel speaker   
					outputs are present. Dolby Pro Logic   
					IIz Height can be used to upmix a   
					variety of sources from movies and   
					
					upmix game content.   
					G V   
					S B   
					D 
					E S M a t r i x   
					F 
					P L   
					z 
					H e i g h t   
					G 
					H 
					Dolby Pro Logic IIx*8 Dolby Pro Logic IIx expands any 2-   
					channel source for 7.1-channel   
					Dolby Pro Logic II   
					playback. It provides a very natural and   
					seamless surround-sound experience   
					that fully envelops the listener. As well   
					as music and movies, video games can   
					also benefit from the dramatic spatial   
					effects and vivid imaging.   
					Dolby EX   
					These modes expand 5.1-channel   
					sources for 6.1/7.1-channel playback.   
					They’re especially suited to Dolby EX   
					soundtracks that include a matrix-   
					encoded surround back channel. The   
					additional channel adds an extra   
					dimension and provides an enveloping   
					surround sound experience, perfect for   
					rotating and fly-by sound effects.   
					D V   
					P L   
					P L   
					P L   
					P L   
					P L   
					P L   
					M o v i e   
					M u s i c   
					G a m e   
					H 
					D o l b y E X   
					D o l b y   
					D 
					E X   
					If you’re not using any surround back   
					speakers, Dolby Pro Logic II will be   
					used instead of Dolby Pro Logic IIx.   
					• Dolby PLIIx Movie   
					Use this mode with any stereo or Dolby   
					Surround (Pro Logic) movie (e.g., TV,   
					DVD, VHS).   
					S XCN   
					D V   
					x 
					x 
					x 
					M o v i e   
					M u s i c   
					G a m e   
					DTS Neo:6   
					This mode expands any 2-channel   
					source for up to 7.1-channel playback. It   
					uses seven full-bandwidth channels of   
					matrix decoding for matrix-encoded   
					material, providing a very natural and   
					seamless surround sound experience   
					that fully envelops the listener.   
					• Dolby PLIIx Music   
					Use this mode with any stereo or Dolby   
					Surround (Pro Logic) music source   
					(e.g., CD, radio, cassette, TV, VHS,   
					DVD).   
					• DTS Neo:6 Cinema   
					Use this mode with any stereo movie   
					(e.g., TV, DVD, VHS).   
					S XCN   
					D V   
					N e o : 6 C i n e m a   
					N e o : 6 M u s i c   
					• Dolby PLIIx Game   
					• DTS Neo:6 Music   
					Use this mode with video games,   
					especially those that bear the Dolby   
					Pro Logic II logo.   
					Use this mode with any stereo music   
					source (e.g., CD, radio, cassette, TV,   
					VHS, DVD).   
					• Dolby PLIIx Movie   
					• Dolby PLIIx Music   
					These modes use the Dolby Pro Logic   
					IIx modes to expand 5.1-channel   
					sources for 7.1-channel playback.   
					• DTS Neo:6   
					N e o : 6   
					This mode uses DTS Neo:6 to expand   
					5.1-channel sources for 6.1/7.1-   
					channel playback.   
					En-44   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Playback   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					Listening Mode   
					THX   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					Audyssey DSX*9   
					• Audyssey DSX   
					Founded by George Lucas, THX   
					develops stringent standards that   
					ensure movies are reproduced in movie   
					theaters and home theaters just as the   
					director intended. THX Modes carefully   
					optimize the tonal and spatial   
					characteristics of the soundtrack for   
					reproduction in the home-theater   
					environment. They can be used with 2-   
					channel matrixed and multichannel   
					sources. Surround back speaker output   
					depends on the source material and the   
					selected listening mode.   
					D B   
					Audyssey DSX® is a scalable system   
					that adds new speakers to improve   
					surround impression. Starting with a   
					5.1 system Audyssey DSX first adds   
					Wide channels for the biggest impact   
					on envelopment. Research in human   
					hearing has proven that information   
					from the Wide channels is much more   
					critical in the presentation of a realistic   
					soundstage than the Back Surround   
					channels found in traditional 7.1   
					systems. Audyssey DSX then creates   
					a pair of Height channels to reproduce   
					the next most important acoustical and   
					perceptual cues. In addition to these   
					new Wide and Height channels,   
					Audyssey DSX applies Surround   
					Envelopment Processing to enhance   
					the blend between the front and   
					surround channels.   
					F 
					A u d y s s e y D S X   
					G 
					H 
					• THX Cinema   
					D CN   
					F 
					T H X C i n e m a   
					T HXMu s i c   
					T H X G a m e s   
					
					soundtracks for playback in a home   
					theater environment. In this mode, THX   
					Loudness Plus is configured for cinema   
					levels and Re-EQ, Timbre Matching,   
					and Adaptive Decorrelation are active.   
					• THX Music   
					THX Music mode is tailored for listening   
					to music, which is typically mastered at   
					significantly higher levels than movies.   
					In this mode, THX Loudness Plus is   
					configured for music playback and only   
					Timbre Matching is active.   
					G 
					H 
					• Dolby Pro Logic II Movie +   
					Audyssey DSX   
					• Dolby Pro Logic II Music +   
					Audyssey DSX   
					• Dolby Pro Logic II Game +   
					Audyssey DSX   
					The combination of Dolby Pro Logic II   
					and Audyssey DSX modes can be   
					used.   
					S B   
					P L   
					P L   
					P L   
					M o v i e D S X   
					M u s i c D S X   
					G a m e D S X   
					• THX Games   
					THX Games mode is meant for   
					spatially accurate playback of game   
					audio, which is often mixed similarly to   
					movies but in a smaller environment.   
					THX Loudness Plus is configured for   
					game audio levels, with Timbre   
					Matching active.   
					The PLII and Audyssey DSX   
					indicators light on the AV receiver’s   
					display.   
					En-45   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					• Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx Movie + THX   
					Cinema   
					• Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx Music + THX   
					Music   
					• Dolby Pro Logic II/IIx Game + THX   
					Games   
					The combination of Dolby Pro Logic   
					II/IIx*8 and THX Cinema/Music/Games   
					modes can be used.   
					• THX Select2 Cinema   
					S CN   
					D V   
					T HXS2 C i n e m a   
					T H X S 2 M u s i c   
					T H X S 2 G a m e s   
					THX Select2 Cinema mode plays 5.1   
					movie using 8 speakers giving you the   
					best possible movie watching   
					experience. In this mode, THX ASA   
					processing blends the side surround   
					speakers and back surround speakers   
					providing the optimal mix of ambient   
					and directional surround sounds.   
					• THX Select2 Music   
					For the replay of multichannel music,   
					the THX Select2 Music should be   
					selected. In this mode, THX ASA   
					
					channels of all 5.1 encoded music   
					sources such as DTS, Dolby Digital,   
					DVD-Audio, etc. to provide a wide and   
					stable rear soundstage.   
					The PLII/PLIIx and THX indicators light   
					on the AV receiver’s display.   
					• Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie + THX   
					Cinema   
					• Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music + THX   
					Music   
					The combination of Dolby Pro Logic IIx   
					and THX Cinema/Music modes can be   
					used.   
					The PLIIx and THX indicators light on   
					the AV receiver’s display.   
					D V   
					H 
					• THX Select2 Games   
					For the replay of stereo and   
					multichannel game audio, the THX   
					Select2 Games mode should be   
					selected. In this mode, THX ASA   
					processing is applied to the surround   
					channels of all 5.1 and 2.0 encoded   
					game sources such as analog, PCM,   
					DTS, and Dolby Digital. This accurately   
					places all game audio surround   
					information creating a full 360 degree   
					playback environment. THX Select2   
					Games is unique as it gives you a   
					smooth transition of audio in all points   
					of the surround field.   
					• Dolby Pro Logic IIz Height + THX   
					Cinema   
					• Dolby Pro Logic IIz Height + THX   
					Music   
					• Dolby Pro Logic IIz Height + THX   
					Games   
					The combination of Dolby Pro Logic IIz   
					Height and THX Cinema/Music/Games   
					modes can be used.   
					S B   
					D 
					F 
					G 
					H 
					The PLIIz and THX indicators light on   
					the AV receiver’s display.   
					• DTS Neo:6 Cinema + THX Cinema   
					
					S CN   
					• Dolby Pro Logic II Game + THX   
					Select2 Games   
					S V   
					• DTS Neo:6 + THX Cinema   
					• DTS Neo:6 + THX Music   
					• DTS Neo:6 + THX Games   
					The combination of DTS Neo:6 and   
					THX Cinema/Music/Games modes can   
					be used. The Neo:6 and THX   
					indicators light on the AV receiver’s   
					display.   
					D V   
					H 
					The combination of Dolby Pro Logic II   
					Game and THX Select2 Games modes   
					can be used. The PLII and THX   
					indicators light on the AV receiver’s   
					display.   
					En-46   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Playback   
					Listening Mode   
					Description   
					Input   
					Source Layout   
					Speaker   
					• THX Surround EX   
					D V   
					T H X S u r r E X   
					This mode expands 5.1-channel   
					sources for 6.1/7.1- channel playback.   
					It’s especially suited to Dolby Digital EX   
					sources. THX Surround EX, also   
					known as Dolby Digital Surround EX, is   
					a joint development between Dolby   
					Laboratories and THX Ltd.   
					H 
					Note   
					*1   
					(North American and Taiwanese models) This listening mode is not available.   
					Pure Audio cannot be selected when Zone 2/3 is active.   
					*2   
					Besides, if you activate Zone 2/3 while Pure Audio is selected, the listening mode will   
					automatically switch to Direct.   
					Based on the audio channel signal contained in the source, the corresponding speakers   
					will output the sound.   
					The AV receiver can input the DSD signal from HDMI IN. Depending on the player,   
					setting the output on the player side to PCM might bring better sound.   
					For the Blu-ray Discs, Dolby Digital is used in a 3.1/5.1-channel speaker system.   
					DTS is used depending on the configuration of the AV receiver.   
					If there are no surround back speakers, DTS is used.   
					*3   
					*4   
					*5   
					*6   
					*7   
					*8   
					*9   
					If there are no surround back speakers, Dolby Pro Logic II is used.   
					This listening mode can be selected only when all the following conditions are satisfied:   
					–Center speaker is connected.   
					–Front high speakers is connected.   
					En-47   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					be sure to go to the THX Audio Setup screen and   
					choose the setting that closely corresponds to the   
					back speaker spacing (➔ page 61). This will re-   
					optimize the surround sound field.   
					ASA is used in four modes: THX Select2 Cinema,   
					THX Select2 Music, THX Select2 Games and Dolby   
					Pro Logic II + THX Select2 Games.   
					Dialogue Normalization   
					spatial errors that occur. On this product, when the   
					THX indicator is on, THX features are automatically   
					added in Cinema modes (e.g. THX Cinema, THX   
					Surround EX).   
					Dialogue Normalization (DialogNorm) is a feature of   
					Dolby Digital, which is used to keep the programs at   
					the same average listening level so the user does not   
					have to change the volume control between Dolby   
					Digital, Dolby Digital Plus and Dolby TrueHD   
					Timbre Matching   
					The human ear changes our perception of a sound   
					depending on the direction from which the sound is   
					coming. In a movie theater, there is an array of   
					surround speakers so that the surround information is   
					all around you. In a home theater, you may only have   
					two speakers located to the side of your head. In this   
					case, the Timbre Matching feature filters the   
					information going to the surround speakers so that   
					they more closely match the tonal characteristics of   
					the sound coming from the front speakers. This   
					ensures seamless panning between the front and   
					surround speakers.   
					programs. When playing back software which has   
					been encoded in Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus and   
					Dolby TrueHD, sometimes you may see a brief   
					message in the front panel display which will read   
					“DialogNorm: X dB” (X being a numeric value). The   
					display is showing how the program level relates with   
					THX calibration level. If you want to play the program   
					at calibrated theatrical levels, you may wish to adjust   
					the volume. For example, if you see the following   
					message: “DialogNorm: + 4 dB” in the front panel   
					display, to keep the overall output level at THX   
					calibrated loudness, just turn down the volume control   
					by 4 dB. However, unlike a movie theater where the   
					playback loudness is preset, you can choose your   
					preferred volume setting for best enjoyment.   
					The listening mode may not be selected depending   
					on the input signal. The signal input from the   
					external AV components can be displayed by the   
					function on the next page.   
					Adaptive Decorrelation   
					In a movie theater, a large number of surround   
					speakers help create an enveloping surround sound   
					experience. If a home theater only has two sidewall   
					surround speakers, the surround speakers may   
					sound similar to headphones lacking spaciousness   
					and envelopment. Surround sounds will also collapse   
					toward the closet speaker as you move away from the   
					middle seating position. Adaptive Decorrelation   
					slightly changes one surround channel’s time and   
					phase relationship with respect to the other surround   
					experience as in a movie theater using only two   
					speakers.   
					THX Cinema Processing   
					THX is an exclusive set of standards and   
					technologies established by the world-renowned film   
					production company Lucasfilm Ltd. THX grew from   
					George Lucas’ personal desire to make your   
					experience of the film soundtrack in both movie   
					theaters and in your home theater as faithful as   
					possible to what the director intended.   
					Movie soundtracks are mixed in special environments   
					called dubbing stages and are designed to be played   
					back in movie theaters with similar equipment and   
					conditions. Most of those soundtracks are remixed   
					using flat response loudspeakers similar to those   
					used in the small home theater environment before   
					being transferred onto Blu-ray Discs, DVD, etc.   
					THX engineers developed patented technologies to   
					accurately translate the sound from the movie theater   
					environment into the home, correcting the tonal and   
					ASA (Advanced Speaker Array)   
					ASA is a proprietary THX technology which   
					processes the audio on the two side and two back   
					surround speakers for the optional surround sound   
					experience. When you set up your home theater   
					system using eight speaker outputs (Left, Center,   
					Right, Surround Right, Surround Back Right,   
					Surround Back Left, Surround Left, and Subwoofer),   
					En-48   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Displaying Source Information   
					Using the Sleep Timer   
					Setting the Display Brightness   
					You can display various information about the current   
					input source as follows.   
					With the sleep timer, you can set the AV receiver to   
					turn off automatically after a specified period.   
					You can adjust the brightness of the AV receiver’s   
					display, and switch the MASTER VOLUME indicator   
					off and on in conjunction.   
					Press RECEIVER once followed by DISPLAY   
					repeatedly to cycle through the available   
					information.   
					Press RECEIVER once followed by SLEEP   
					1 
					1 
					repeatedly to select the required sleep time.   
					The sleep time can be set from 90 to 10 minutes   
					in 10 minute steps.   
					Press RECEIVER once followed by DIMMER   
					repeatedly to cycle through the following   
					patterns:   
					1 
					Tip   
					• Normal brightness + indicator off.   
					• Dim brightness + indicator off.   
					• Dimmer brightness + indicator off.   
					• Normal brightness + indicator on (default).   
					The SLEEP indicator lights on the AV receiver’s   
					display when the sleep timer has been set. The   
					specified sleep time appears for about 5   
					seconds, then the previous display reappears.   
					• Alternatively, you can use DISPLAY on the AV   
					receiver.   
					The following information can be typically displayed.   
					Tip   
					Tip   
					Input source &   
					volume*1   
					• If you need to cancel the sleep timer, press SLEEP   
					repeatedly until the SLEEP indicator goes off.   
					• To check the time remaining until the AV receiver   
					sleeps, press SLEEP. Note that if you press again on   
					SLEEP as the time being displayed is 10 minutes or   
					less, the sleep timer will go off.   
					• (North American and Taiwanese models)   
					Alternatively, you can use DIMMER on the AV   
					receiver.   
					Listening mode   
					Signal format*2   
					Sampling   
					frequency*2   
					Input signal   
					resolution   
					Output resolution   
					*1   
					When AM or FM radio is used, the band, preset number,   
					and frequency are displayed.   
					If the input signal is digital, the signal format is displayed.   
					*2   
					Information is displayed for about three seconds, then   
					the previously displayed information reappears.   
					En-49   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					Changing the Input Display   
					Using the Whole House Mode   
					The Whole House Mode is useful when you want to   
					add extra background music to your home party; this   
					
					
					The Whole House Mode selects the same input   
					source for Multi Zone as the main room’s.   
					See also:   
					When you connect an u-capable Onkyo   
					component, you must configure the input display so   
					that ucan work properly.   
					This setting can be done only from the front panel.   
					Press TV/CD or GAME.   
					1 
					“TV/CD” or “GAME” appears on the AV receiver’s   
					• “2. Speaker Setup” (➔ page 59)   
					display.   
					
					
					2 
					3 seconds) to change the input display.   
					
					display.   
					While holding down ZONE 2, press ZONE 3 on   
					
					1 
					To cancel the Whole House Mode, change the   
					input source for the main room or select a   
					listening mode (➔ page 41).   
					■ TV/CD:   
					TV/CD → DOCK   
					→ 
					TAPE   
					Note   
					■ GAME:   
					
					• The Whole House Mode only supports analog audio   
					and audio from NET or USB input selector.   
					• To adjust the volume of Multi Zone, switch the AV   
					receiver to Multi Zone control. See “Adjusting the   
					Volume for Zone 2” (➔ page 75) for the volume   
					adjustment of Multi Zone.   
					“ 
					Note   
					• “DOCK” can be selected for the “TV/CD” or “GAME”   
					input selector, but not at the same time.   
					• Enter the appropriate remote control code before using   
					the remote controller for the first time (➔ page 77).   
					• The Whole House Mode is not available in either of the   
					
					–The “Audio TV Out (Main)” setting is set to “On”   
					(➔ page 70) or “Audio TV Out (Sub)” setting is set   
					to “On” (➔ page 71) and you’re listening through   
					your TV speakers.   
					–“HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On” (➔ page 69) and   
					you’re listening through your TV speakers.   
					–a pair of headphones is connected.   
					Muting the AV Receiver   
					You can temporarily mute the output of the AV   
					receiver.   
					Press RECEIVER followed by MUTING.   
					The output is muted and the MUTING indicator   
					1 
					flashes on the AV receiver’s display.   
					Tip   
					• To unmute, press MUTING again or adjust the volume.   
					• Muting is automatically cancelled when the AV   
					receiver is set to standby.   
					En-50   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Playback   
					a short while after the AV receiver is turned on.   
					components connected through HDMI, you can   
					easily switch between inputs as their previews are   
					displayed on a single screen.   
					Using the Home Menu   
					Please wait until it becomes operable.   
					Press ENTER to display the network service   
					screen. If you want to use the Internet radio   
					services, use q/w/e/rto select the desired   
					service. Pressing ENTER again switches to that   
					selection. If you want to play music files on a   
					computer or media server, use q/w/e/rto   
					select “DLNA” and then press ENTER. If you   
					want to play music files on a computer or NAS   
					(Network Attached Storage), use q/w/e/rto   
					select “Home Media” and then press ENTER.   
					The Home menu provides quick access to frequently   
					used menus.   
					Press ENTER to display the main preview   
					(currently selected HDMI input) and the   
					
					q/wor e/rto select a preview thumbnail and   
					pressing ENTER will switch the AV receiver to   
					that input source.   
					Tip   
					• The on-screen menus appear only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI OUT MAIN.   
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME.   
					The Home menu will be superimposed on the TV   
					screen.   
					1 
					Tip   
					• If no video signals are present, the thumbnails will be   
					filled in black.   
					• You can specify the number of preview thumbnails as   
					well as their positioning on screen (➔ page 71).   
					Tip   
					■ USB   
					• Alternatively, you can use HOME on the AV receiver.   
					
					portable players and USB storage devices   
					connected to the AV receiver’s USB port   
					(➔ page 32). Note that this selection will be   
					grayed out for a short while after the AV receiver   
					is turned on. Please wait until it becomes   
					operable.   
					Note   
					
					–HDMI IN 5/6/7 is the current HDMI input source, or   
					–No signal is present on the current input source.   
					• Depending on video signals, the picture may not be   
					properly rendered on the preview thumbnails of   
					InstaPrevue.   
					Press ENTER to select a drive or browse the   
					contents of the media connected, followed by   
					q/wto select the desired folder or track.   
					Pressing ENTER as a track is selected will start   
					playback.   
					Use e/ror q/wand ENTER to make the   
					■ Firmware Update   
					2 
					desired selection.   
					Press HOME to close the menu.   
					`With this selection, you can update the firmware   
					of the AV receiver. Note that this selection will be   
					grayed out for a short while after the AV receiver   
					is turned on. Please wait until it becomes   
					operable.   
					■ Setup   
					`With this selection, you can access the common   
					settings of the on-screen Setup menu.   
					Press ENTER to display the Setup menu   
					(➔ page 56).   
					Press ENTER to start the procedure   
					(➔ page 90).   
					■ Network Service   
					Tip   
					You need to connect the AV receiver to your home   
					network (➔ pages 16, 27).   
					• You can also access frequently used settings from Quick   
					Setup (➔ page 52).   
					`With this selection, you can use various Internet   
					radio services or play the contents stored in media   
					
					
					■ InstaPrevue   
					`With this selection, you can preview audio/video   
					streams coming from HDMI inputs (HDMI   
					IN 1/2/3/4/AUX INPUT). Even with multiple   
					En-51   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					In addition, previews of the video streams coming   
					Using the Quick Setup   
					from HDMI inputs (HDMI IN 1/2/3/4/AUX INPUT)   
					*2   
					are displayed.   
					Use q/wto select an input source and view the   
					related information. Pressing ENTER switches to   
					the selected input source.   
					Advanced Operations   
					On-screen Setup   
					RECEIVER   
					■ Audio (➔ page 53)   
					
					“Treble”, “Phase Matching Bass”, “Subwoofer   
					Level”, “Center Level”, “Audyssey”,   
					ENTER,   
					*3   
					*3   
					“Dynamic EQ ”, “Dynamic Volume ”, “Late   
					Night”, “Music Optimizer”, “Re-EQ” and “Re-   
					EQ(THX)”.   
					q/w/e/r   
					Q SETUP   
					RETURN   
					*4   
					
					This section describes the procedure for using the   
					remote controller unless otherwise specified.   
					`You can change the following settings: “Wide   
					*5   
					Mode” and “Picture Mode ”.   
					Press RECEIVER followed by Q SETUP.   
					
					screen.   
					1 
					2 
					With the AV receiver connected to a TV, there are two   
					ways of changing the settings on-screen: using the   
					Quick Setup or the Setup Menu (HOME).   
					See also:   
					• “Picture Adjust” (➔ page 66)   
					*6   
					■ Information   
					■ Quick Setup   
					`You can view the information of the following   
					items: “Audio”, “Video” and “Tuner”.   
					The Quick Setup provides quick access to frequently   
					used settings. You can change settings and view the   
					current information.   
					B D / DV D   
					I n p u t   
					A u d i o   
					V i d e o   
					I n f o r m a t i o n   
					L i s t e n i n g M o d e   
					*7   
					■ Listening Mode   
					`You can select the listening modes that are   
					grouped in the following categories: “MOVIE/TV”,   
					“MUSIC”, “GAME”, and “THX”.   
					■ Setup menu (HOME)   
					The Setup menu (HOME) provides a convenient way   
					to change the AV receiver’s various settings. Settings   
					are organized into 9 categories.   
					Use q/wto select the category and e/rto   
					select the listening mode. Press ENTER to   
					switch to the selected listening mode.   
					Use q/wand ENTER to make the desired   
					selection.   
					Tip   
					Press Q SETUP to close the menu.   
					Press RETURN to return to the previous menu.   
					Note   
					• The on-screen menus appear only on a TV that is   
					connected to HDMI OUT MAIN.   
					*1   
					“BLUETOOTH” cannot be selected, if you’ve selected   
					NET or USB as input selector in Multi Zone.   
					• The video preview is not displayed when:   
					– HDMI IN 5/6/7 is the current HDMI input source, or   
					– No signal is present on the current input source.   
					• The video of the currently-selected input is displayed on   
					the main screen, not on a preview thumbnail.   
					*1   
					■ Input   
					*2   
					`You can select input sources and view the   
					following information: the name of input selectors,   
					input assignments, the name of the device paired   
					with the AV receiver via Bluetooth, radio   
					information, and ARC function setting.   
					En-52   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					*3   
					*4   
					*5   
					“Dynamic EQ” and “Dynamic Volume” cannot be   
					selected when any of the THX listening modes is   
					selected, with “Loudness Plus” set to “On” or “Preserve   
					THX Settings” set to “Yes” (➔ page 62).   
					• When the “Monitor Out” setting is set to “Sub”, “Video”   
					cannot be selected (➔ page 57).   
					Phase Matching Bass   
					Using the Audio Settings of Quick   
					Setup   
					■ Phase Matching Bass   
					`Off   
					`On   
					You can change various audio settings from the   
					Quick Setup (➔ page 52).   
					• This setting cannot be used with the NET, USB and   
					BLUETOOTH input selectors.   
					From the warm low notes produced by a cello to the   
					deep frequencies of electronic music, a good audio   
					system should be able to deliver plenty of bass   
					resonance.   
					While traditional enhancement systems effectively   
					boost low-frequency sound, they are often prone to   
					the effects of phase shifting, which can overwhelm   
					mid-range frequencies and muddy the sound. Our   
					Phase-Matching Bass Boost technology effectively   
					preserves mid-range clarity-allowing vocals and   
					strings to shine-while maintaining a smooth, powerful   
					bass response at all volume levels.   
					Note   
					• These settings are not available in either of the following   
					cases:   
					–The “Audio TV Out (Main)” setting is set to “On”   
					(➔ page 70) or “Audio TV Out (Sub)” setting is set to   
					“On” (➔ page 71) and you’re listening through your TV   
					speakers.   
					Only when you have selected “Custom” in the “Picture   
					Mode” (➔ page 66), pressing ENTER allows you to   
					adjust the following items via the Quick Setup:   
					“Brightness”, “Contrast”, “Hue” and “Saturation”. Press   
					RETURN to return to the “Picture Mode” setting.   
					Depending on the input source and listening mode, not   
					all channels shown here output the sound.   
					
					cases:   
					
					(➔ page 70) or “Audio TV Out (Sub)” setting is set to   
					
					speakers.   
					*6   
					*7   
					–“HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On” (➔ page 69) and   
					you’re listening through your TV speakers.   
					Tone Control   
					■ Bass   
					Note   
					`–10dB to 0dB to +10dB in 2 dB steps.   
					You can boost or cut low-frequency sounds   
					output from the front speakers.   
					– “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On” (➔ page 69) and   
					you’re listening through your TV speakers.   
					• The Phase Matching Bass is disabled when the Direct,   
					Pure Audio (European, Australian and Asian models), or   
					THX listening mode is selected.   
					• If the “Subwoofer” setting is set to “No”, this setting is fixed   
					to “Off”.   
					Explanatory Notes   
					■ Treble   
					`–10dB to 0dB to +10dB in 2 dB steps.   
					You can boost or cut high-frequency sounds   
					output from the front speakers.   
					■ Phase Matching Bass   
					a 
					b 
					`Off   
					Operating on the AV receiver   
					`On   
					You can adjust the bass and treble for the front   
					speakers, except when the Direct, Pure Audio   
					(European, Australian and Asian models) or THX   
					listening mode is selected.   
					Press TONE repeatedly to select “PM Bass”.   
					1 
					2 
					aSetting target   
					bSetting options (default setting underlined)   
					Use – and + to change the setting.   
					Operating on the AV receiver   
					Press TONE repeatedly to select either “Bass”   
					or “Treble”.   
					1 
					Use – and + to adjust.   
					2 
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 52)   
					En-53   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					• The setting is stored individually for each input selector.   
					• “Dynamic EQ” and “Dynamic Volume” cannot be selected   
					when any of the THX listening modes is selected, with   
					“Loudness Plus” set to “On” or “Preserve THX Settings”   
					set to “Yes” (➔ page 62).   
					• With Dolby TrueHD sources, the Late Night function cannot   
					be used when “TrueHD Loudness Management” is set to   
					“Off”.   
					Speaker Levels   
					■ Subwoofer Level   
					`–15dB to 0dB to +12dB in 1 dB steps.   
					Music Optimizer   
					■ Center Level   
					Late Night   
					■ Music Optimizer   
					`Off   
					`–12dB to 0dB to +12dB in 1 dB steps.   
					You can adjust the volume of each speaker while   
					listening to an input source.   
					■ Late Night   
					
					For Dolby Digital and Dolby Digital Plus sources,   
					These temporary adjustments are cancelled when the   
					AV receiver is set to standby. To save the setting you   
					made here, go to “Level Calibration” (➔ page 61)   
					before setting the AV receiver to standby.   
					The Music Optimizer function enhances the sound   
					quality of compressed music files. When set to “On”,   
					the M.Opt indicator lights on the AV receiver’s   
					display.   
					the options are:   
					`Off   
					`Low:   
					Small reduction in dynamic range.   
					`High:   
					Note   
					Tip   
					• You cannot use these function while the AV receiver is   
					muted.   
					• (North American and Taiwanese models) Alternatively,   
					you can use MUSIC OPTIMIZER on the AV receiver.   
					Large reduction in dynamic range.   
					• These settings cannot be used while a pair of headphones   
					is connected.   
					• Speakers that are set to “No” or “None” in   
					“Speaker Configuration” (➔ page 59) cannot be adjusted.   
					For Dolby TrueHD sources, the options are:   
					`Auto:   
					Note   
					• The Music Optimizer function only works with PCM digital   
					audio input signals with a sampling rate below 48 kHz and   
					analog audio input signals.   
					The Late Night function is set to “On” or “Off”   
					automatically.   
					When NET or USB input selector is selected, this function   
					even works with digital audio input signals with a sampling   
					rate below 48 kHz (except DSD signals and Dolby TrueHD   
					signals) regardless of the PCM digital audio input signals   
					with a sampling rate below 48 kHz.   
					• The Music Optimizer is disabled when the Direct or Pure   
					Audio (European, Australian and Asian models)   
					listening mode is selected.   
					`Off   
					`On   
					® 
					Audyssey   
					Turn this setting on to reduce the dynamic range of   
					Dolby Digital material so that you can still hear quiet   
					
					
					to disturb anyone.   
					■ Audyssey   
					See “Audyssey” in “4. Source Setup” (➔ page 64).   
					■ Dynamic EQ   
					See “Dynamic EQ” in “4. Source Setup” (➔ page 64).   
					• The setting is stored individually for each input selector.   
					Note   
					■ Dynamic Volume   
					• The effect of the Late Night function depends on the   
					
					
					or no effect when you select the different options.   
					• The Late Night function can be used only when the input   
					source is Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus, or Dolby   
					TrueHD.   
					• The Late Night function is set to “Off” when the AV receiver   
					is set to standby. For Dolby TrueHD sources, it will be set   
					
					See “Dynamic Volume” in “4. Source Setup”   
					(➔ page 64).   
					Note   
					• These technologies can be used when all the following   
					conditions are met:   
					–Room Correction and Speaker Setup is completed. Note   
					that “Audyssey” requires the “Audyssey MultEQ Full   
					Calibration” method.   
					–Any listening mode other than Direct or Pure Audio   
					(European, Australian and Asian models) is selected.   
					–A pair of headphones is not connected.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 52)   
					En-54   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Re-EQ (Re-Equalization)   
					Movie soundtracks were designed for playback in   
					large movie theaters using professional equipment. If   
					the movies were not remixed for the home theater,   
					the tonal balance of the soundtracks can be   
					excessively bright and harsh when played back over   
					home audio equipment. In those instances, Re-   
					Equalization restores the correct tonal balance for   
					listening to a movie soundtrack in a smaller home   
					environment.   
					■ Re-EQ   
					`Off   
					`On   
					This function can be used with the following listening   
					modes: Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby   
					TrueHD, Multichannel, DTS, DTS-HD High   
					Resolution Audio, DTS-HD Master Audio, DTS   
					Express, DSD, Dolby EX, Dolby Pro Logic IIz Height,   
					Dolby PLIIx Movie, DTS Neo:6 Cinema and 5.1-   
					channel source + Neo:6.   
					■ Re-EQ(THX)   
					`Off   
					`On   
					This function can be used with the following listening   
					modes: THX Cinema, THX Surround EX, and   
					THX Select2 Cinema.   
					Note   
					• These settings cannot be used while a pair of headphones   
					is connected.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 52)   
					En-55   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Main menu item   
					Sub menu item   
					Using the Setup Menu (HOME)   
					Setup Menu Items   
					6. Miscellaneous   
					(➔ page 69)   
					Volume Setup   
					OSD Setup   
					Tuner   
					Main menu item   
					Sub menu item   
					Monitor Out   
					Remote   
					indicator   
					7. Hardware Setup   
					(➔ page 69)   
					1. Input/Output Assign   
					(➔ page 57)   
					HDMI   
					HDMI Input   
					Auto Standby   
					Network   
					Component Video Input   
					Digital Audio Input   
					Speaker Settings   
					Speaker Configuration   
					Speaker Distance   
					Level Calibration   
					Equalizer Settings   
					THX Audio Setup   
					Multiplex/Mono   
					Dolby   
					RECEIVER   
					Initial Setup   
					Remote ID   
					Remote Mode Setup   
					2. Speaker Setup   
					(➔ page 59)   
					8. Remote Controller   
					Setup   
					(➔ page 73)   
					ENTER,   
					q/w/e/r   
					9. Lock Setup   
					(➔ page 73)   
					Setup   
					RETURN   
					3. Audio Adjust   
					(➔ page 62)   
					HOME   
					DTS   
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME.   
					1 
					2 
					Audyssey DSX   
					Theater-Dimensional   
					LFE Level   
					
					press ENTER.   
					4. Source Setup   
					(➔ page 64)   
					Audyssey   
					Use q/wto select a main menu item, and then   
					3 
					4 
					5 
					IntelliVolume   
					press ENTER.   
					A/V Sync   
					Use q/wto select a sub menu item, and then   
					Name Edit   
					press ENTER.   
					Picture Adjust   
					Audio Selector   
					Use q/wto select a setting target, and use e/r   
					to change the setting.   
					5. Listening Mode Preset BD/DVD   
					Press HOME to close the menu.   
					(➔ page 68)   
					CBL/SAT   
					Press RETURN to return to the previous menu.   
					STB/DVR   
					GAME   
					PC   
					Note   
					• This procedure can also be performed on the AV receiver   
					by using HOME, the cursor buttons, and ENTER.   
					• During Audyssey MultEQ® Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup, messages, etc., that are displayed on the TV screen   
					will appear on the AV receiver’s display.   
					AUX   
					TUNER   
					TV/CD   
					PHONO   
					NET   
					USB   
					BLUETOOTH   
					En-56   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Explanatory Notes   
					Note   
					1. Input/Output Assign   
					Monitor Out   
					• The “HDMI Through” setting is only available for the HDMI   
					OUT MAIN jack (➔ page 70).   
					2. Speaker Setup   
					a 
					b 
					■ Resolution   
					`Through:   
					Select this to pass video through the AV receiver   
					at the same resolution and with no conversion.   
					
					On the “Monitor Out” settings, you can select   
					whether or not to have the video sources’ images   
					
					If you connect your TV to HDMI output, “Monitor Out”   
					setting is automatically set and composite video and   
					Speaker Configuration   
					■ Subwoofer   
					`Yes   
					c 
					d 
					`No   
					* 
					Select this to have the AV receiver automatically   
					convert video at resolutions supported by your   
					TV.   
					component video sources are upconverted and   
					output.   
					aMain Menu   
					bSub Menu   
					Composite video,   
					component video   
					*1   
					`480p (480p/576p), 720p, 1080i, 1080p :   
					Select the desired output resolution.   
					
					cSetting target   
					HDMI   
					HDMI   
					dSetting options (default setting underlined)   
					IN   
					Select this for an output resolution four times   
					that of 1080p. Depending on the resolution   
					supported by your TV, it will result in either 3840   
					× 2160 or 4096 × 2160 pixels.   
					OUT   
					Composite video,   
					component video   
					You can specify the output resolution for HDMI OUT   
					MAIN and have the AV receiver upconvert the picture   
					resolution as necessary to match the resolution   
					supported by your TV.   
					Note   
					• See “The video and audio signal flow” (➔ page 17) for   
					charts showing how the “Monitor Out” and “Resolution”   
					settings affect the video signal flow through the AV   
					receiver.   
					Sub Menu   
					Main Menu   
					Tip   
					• You can see the picture by pressing ENTER to check the   
					“Resolution” setting for HDMI OUT MAIN (excluding NET,   
					USB and BLUETOOTH input source).   
					■ Monitor Out   
					`Main:   
					Note   
					Select this if your TV is connected to HDMI OUT   
					• With some TVs, video signals are processed in the same   
					way as “Through” when this setting is set to “4K”.   
					• If the “Monitor Out” setting is set to “Sub”, this setting is   
					fixed to “Through”.   
					• If the “Monitor Out” setting is set to “Both”, this setting is   
					fixed to “Auto”.   
					MAIN.   
					`Sub:   
					Select this if your TV is connected to HDMI OUT   
					SUB.   
					`Both:   
					• For optimum video performance, THX recommends using   
					the HDMI output and setting the video resolution to   
					“Through”.   
					Select this if your TVs are connected to HDMI   
					OUT MAIN and HDMI OUT SUB. Video signals   
					are output from both HDMI outputs at the   
					resolution supported by both TVs.   
					*1   
					When signal is 1080p input at 24 frames per second, it   
					will be 1080p output at 24 frames per second.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-57   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ BD/DVD, CBL/SAT, STB/DVR, GAME, PC, TV/CD,   
					PHONO   
					`HDMI1, HDMI2, HDMI3, HDMI4, HDMI5, HDMI6,   
					HDMI7:   
					Select the input to which the component has   
					
					`- - - - -:   
					
					sources from the HDMI output. The video output   
					signal from the HDMI output is the one   
					configured in “Component Video Input”.   
					Each HDMI input cannot be assigned to two input   
					selectors or more. When HDMI1 - HDMI7 have   
					already been assigned, you must first set any   
					unused input selectors to “- - - - -” or you will be   
					unable to assign HDMI1 - HDMI7 to other input   
					selectors.   
					HDMI Input   
					Component Video Input   
					If you connect a video component to an HDMI input,   
					you must assign that input to an input selector. For   
					example, if you connect your Blu-ray Disc/DVD player   
					to HDMI IN 2, you must assign “HDMI2” to the   
					“BD/DVD” input selector.   
					If you’ve connected your TV to the AV receiver with   
					an HDMI cable, composite video and component   
					video sources can be upconverted and output by the   
					
					by selecting the “- - - - -” option. See “The video and   
					audio signal flow” for more information on video   
					signal flow and upconversion (➔ page 17).   
					If you connect a video component to a component   
					video input, you must assign that input to an input   
					selector. For example, if you connect your Blu-ray   
					Disc/DVD player to COMPONENT VIDEO IN, you   
					must assign “IN1” to the “BD/DVD” input selector.   
					Here are the default assignments.   
					Input selector   
					BD/DVD   
					CBL/SAT   
					STB/DVR   
					GAME   
					Default assignment   
					- - - - -   
					* 
					IN1   
					- - - - -   
					- - - - -   
					PC   
					- - - - -   
					Composite video,   
					component video   
					AUX   
					- - - - - (Fixed)   
					- - - - -   
					HDMI   
					HDMI   
					TV/CD   
					IN   
					PHONO   
					- - - - -   
					Note   
					■ BD/DVD, CBL/SAT, STB/DVR, GAME, PC, TV/CD,   
					PHONO   
					`IN1:   
					Select the input to which the component has   
					been connected.   
					`- - - - -:   
					• If no video component is connected to the HDMI input (even   
					if the HDMI input is assigned), the AV receiver selects the   
					video source based on the setting of “Component Video   
					Input”.   
					• When an HDMI IN is assigned to an input selector as   
					explained here, the same HDMI IN will be set as a priority   
					in the “Digital Audio Input”. In this case, if you want to use   
					the coaxial or optical audio input, make the appropriate   
					selection in the “Audio Selector” setting (➔ page 67).   
					• Do not assign an HDMI IN to the TV/CD selector while   
					“HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On” (➔ page 69), otherwise   
					appropriate CEC (Consumer Electronics Control) operation   
					will not be guaranteed.   
					• If you assign “- - - - -” to an input selector that is currently   
					selected in “HDMI Through” (➔ page 70), the “HDMI   
					Through” setting will be automatically switched to “Off”.   
					• “AUX” is used only for input from the front panel.   
					• In order for the AV receiver to upconvert component input   
					to HDMI output, the source output must be set to 480i/576i.   
					When signal is input at resolution of 480p/576p and more,   
					error message will be displayed.   
					OUT   
					Composite video,   
					component video   
					Here are the default assignments.   
					Output composite video sources from the HDMI   
					output.   
					Input selector   
					BD/DVD   
					CBL/SAT   
					STB/DVR   
					GAME   
					Default assignment   
					HDMI1   
					HDMI2   
					Note   
					HDMI3   
					• When composite video and component video sources are   
					upconverted for HDMI OUT SUB, only signals with a   
					resolution of 480i/576i are output and the resolution   
					remains the same. If your TV doesn’t support this   
					resolution, there will be no picture (➔ page 89).   
					• “AUX” is fixed to the “- - - - -” option.   
					HDMI4   
					PC   
					HDMI5   
					AUX   
					Front/MHL (Fixed)   
					- - - - -   
					TV/CD   
					PHONO   
					- - - - -   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-58   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ Speakers Type (Front)   
					`Normal:   
					Select this if you’ve connected your front   
					speakers normally.   
					`Bi-Amp:   
					Digital Audio Input   
					2. Speaker Setup   
					If you connect a component to a digital audio input,   
					you must assign that input to an input selector. For   
					example, if you connect your CD player to the   
					COAXIAL IN 1, you must assign “COAXIAL1” to the   
					“TV/CD” input selector.   
					Here you can check the settings made by   
					® 
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup function, or set them manually, which is useful   
					
					using Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup function (➔ page 24).   
					Select this if you’ve bi-amped your front   
					speakers.   
					Here are the default assignments.   
					
					`No   
					`Yes:   
					Input selector   
					BD/DVD   
					CBL/SAT   
					STB/DVR   
					GAME   
					Default assignment   
					COAXIAL1   
					COAXIAL2   
					- - - - -   
					Note   
					• These settings are not available in either of the following   
					cases:   
					–a pair of headphones is connected.   
					–The “Audio TV Out (Main)” setting is set to “On”   
					
					
					speakers.   
					–“HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On” (➔ page 69) and   
					you’re listening through your TV speakers.   
					Zone 2 speakers can be used (Powered Zone 2   
					enabled).   
					- - - - -   
					Note   
					PC   
					- - - - -   
					
					Powered Zone 2 cannot be used.   
					• When the “Powered Zone 2” setting is set to “Yes” and   
					Zone 2 is turned on, the surround back and front high   
					speakers cannot be used.   
					AUX   
					- - - - - (Fixed)   
					OPTICAL   
					- - - - -   
					TV/CD   
					PHONO   
					Speaker Settings   
					■ BD/DVD, CBL/SAT, STB/DVR, GAME, PC, TV/CD,   
					PHONO   
					`COAXIAL1, COAXIAL2, OPTICAL:   
					Select the input to which the component has   
					been connected.   
					Speaker Configuration   
					If you change these settings, you must run   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup again (➔ page 24).   
					This setting is set automatically by   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup function (➔ page 24).   
					`- - - - -:   
					If you bi-amp the front speakers, you must change the   
					“Speakers Type (Front)” setting. For details on   
					speaker wire connection, see “Bi-amping the Front   
					Speakers” (➔ page 14).   
					Select if the component is connected to an   
					analog audio input.   
					With these settings, you can specify which speakers   
					are connected and a crossover frequency for each   
					speaker. Specify “Full Band” for speakers that can   
					output low frequency bass sounds adequately, for   
					example, speakers with a good sized woofer. For   
					smaller speakers, specify a crossover frequency.   
					Sounds below the crossover frequency will be output   
					by the subwoofer instead of the speaker. Refer to   
					your speaker’s manuals to determine the optimum   
					crossover frequencies. If you set up your speakers   
					using Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and   
					Speaker Setup, please make sure manually that any   
					THX speakers are set to “80Hz(THX)” crossover.   
					Note   
					• When an HDMI IN is assigned to an input selector in   
					“HDMI Input” (➔ page 58), the same HDMI IN will be set   
					as a priority in this assignment. In this case, if you want to   
					use the coaxial or optical audio input, make the appropriate   
					selection in the “Audio Selector” (➔ page 67).   
					• Supported sampling rates for PCM signals (stereo/mono)   
					from a digital input (optical and coaxial) are   
					Note   
					• When bi-amping is used, the AV receiver is able to drive up   
					to 5.1 speakers in the main room.   
					• Before you change these settings, turn down the volume.   
					■ Speaker Impedance   
					`4ohms:   
					Select if the impedance of any speaker is   
					4 ohms or more but less than 6.   
					`6ohms:   
					32/44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz/16, 20, 24 bit.   
					• “AUX” is fixed to the “- - - - -” option.   
					Select if the impedances of all speakers are   
					between 6 and 16 ohms.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-59   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					*5   
					If anything else than “None” is selected in “Surround   
					Back”, this setting is automatically set to “None”.   
					■ Subwoofer   
					`Yes   
					Note   
					• When the “Subwoofer” setting is set to “No” or the “Front”   
					setting to anything other than “Full Band”, this setting is   
					fixed to “- - -”.   
					• This setting is set to “On” automatically when the   
					“Subwoofer” and “Front” settings are set for the first time   
					to “Yes” and “Full Band” respectively.   
					`No   
					■ Surround Back Ch   
					`1ch:   
					Select if only one surround back speaker L is   
					connected.   
					`2ch:   
					■ Front   
					`Full Band   
					`40Hz to 80Hz(THX) to 100Hz, 120Hz, 150Hz,   
					200Hz   
					• If you’re using THX-certified speakers, select “Off(THX)”.   
					Select if two (left and right) surround back   
					speakers are connected.   
					Note   
					Speaker Distance   
					• If the “Subwoofer” setting is set to “No”, the “Front” setting   
					is fixed at “Full Band”.   
					Note   
					• If the “Surround Back” setting is set to “None”, this setting   
					cannot be selected.   
					*1   
					*1   
					This setting is set automatically by   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					
					■ Center , Surround   
					`Full Band   
					`40Hz to 80Hz(THX) to 100Hz, 120Hz, 150Hz,   
					200Hz   
					■ LPF of LFE   
					(Low-Pass Filter for the LFE Channel)   
					`80Hz, 90Hz, 100Hz, 120Hz   
					`Off:   
					Low-Pass Filter is not applied.   
					With this setting, you can specify the cutoff   
					frequency of the LFE channel’s low-pass filter   
					(LPF), which can be used to filter out unwanted   
					hum. The LPF only applies to sources that use the   
					LFE channel.   
					Here you can specify the distance from each speaker   
					to the listening position so that the sound from each   
					speaker arrives at the listener’s ears as the sound   
					designer intended.   
					`None   
					*1*2*3*5   
					■ Front High   
					`Full Band   
					`40Hz to 80Hz(THX) to 100Hz, 120Hz, 150Hz,   
					200Hz   
					■ Unit   
					`feet:   
					`None   
					Distances can be set in feet. Range: 1.0ft to   
					30.0ft in 1.0 foot steps.   
					`meters:   
					Distances can be set in meters. Range: 0.30m   
					to 9.00m in 0.30 meter steps.   
					(The default setting varies from country to country.)   
					*1*2*3*4   
					■ Surround Back   
					`Full Band   
					`40Hz to 80Hz(THX) to 100Hz, 120Hz, 150Hz,   
					200Hz   
					Note   
					• If you’re using THX-certified speakers, select “80Hz”.   
					■ Double Bass   
					`None   
					■ Left, Front High Left, Center, Front High Right,   
					Right, Surround Right, Surround Back Right,   
					Surround Back Left, Surround Left, Subwoofer   
					`Specify the distance from each speaker to your   
					listening position.   
					Note   
					This setting is NOT set automatically by   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup function (➔ page 24).   
					® 
					*1   
					“Full Band” can be selected only when “Full Band” is   
					selected in the “Front” setting.   
					If the “Surround” setting is set to “None”, this setting   
					*2   
					cannot be selected.   
					If the “Speakers Type (Front)” setting is set to   
					`On   
					
					*3   
					Note   
					
					
					be selected.   
					Turn this setting on to boost bass output by feeding   
					bass sounds from the front left, right, and center   
					channels to the subwoofer. Default setting: “- - - -”   
					• Speakers that you set to “No” or “None” in   
					“Speaker Configuration” cannot be selected (➔ page 59).   
					• When the “Powered Zone 2” setting is set to “Yes” and   
					Zone 2 is turned on, the surround back and front high   
					speakers cannot be used.   
					*4   
					
					this setting is automatically set to “None”.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-60   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Level Calibration   
					Equalizer Settings   
					THX Audio Setup   
					With the Equalizer settings, you can adjust the tone of   
					speakers individually with a 5-band equalizer. The   
					volume of each speaker can be set.   
					■ Surr Back Speaker Spacing   
					`<1ft (<0.3m)   
					`1ft-4ft (0.3m-1.2m)   
					`>4ft (>1.2m)   
					You can specify the distance between your surround   
					back speakers.   
					This setting is set automatically by   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup function (➔ page 24).   
					® 
					■ Manual Equalizer   
					`On:   
					Here you can adjust the level of each speaker with   
					the built-in test tone so that the volume of each   
					speaker is the same at the listening position.   
					You can adjust the equalizer for each speaker   
					
					Note   
					Press wto select “Channel”, and then use   
					• Cannot be set if:   
					*1   
					1 
					■ Left, Front High Left, Center , Front High Right,   
					–“Surround Back” is set to “None” (➔ page 60).   
					–“Surround Back Ch” is set to “1ch” (➔ page 60).   
					–“Powered Zone 2” is set to “Yes” (➔ page 59) and   
					
					e/rto select a speaker.   
					Right, Surround Right, Surround Back Right,   
					Surround Back Left, Surround Left   
					`–12dB to 0dB to +12dB in 1 dB steps.   
					Use q/wto select a frequency, and then use   
					2 
					the e/rto adjust the level at that frequency.   
					The volume at each frequency can be adjusted   
					from –6dB to 0dB to +6dB in 1 dB steps.   
					*1   
					■ Subwoofer   
					■ THX Ultra2/Select2 Subwoofer   
					`No   
					`Yes   
					`–15dB to 0dB to +12dB in 1 dB steps.   
					Tip   
					Note   
					
					“16kHz”. And for the subwoofer, “25Hz”, “40Hz”,   
					“63Hz”, “100Hz”, or “160Hz”.   
					• Low frequencies (e.g., 63 Hz) affect bass sounds; high   
					frequencies (e.g., 16 kHz) affect treble sounds.   
					If you’re using a THX-certified subwoofer, set this   
					setting to “Yes”.   
					• These settings cannot be calibrated when the AV receiver   
					is muted.   
					• Speakers that you set to “No” or “None” in   
					“Speaker Configuration” cannot be selected (➔ page 59).   
					• When the “Powered Zone 2” setting is set to “Yes” and   
					Zone 2 is turned on, the surround back and front high   
					speakers cannot be used.   
					• The test tone is output at the standard level for THX, which   
					is 0 dB (absolute volume setting 82). If you normally listen   
					at volume settings below this, be careful because the test   
					tone will be much louder.   
					Note   
					• If the “Subwoofer” setting is set to “No”, this setting cannot   
					be selected (➔ page 60).   
					Use qto select “Channel”, and then use e/r   
					3 
					to select another speaker.   
					■ BGC   
					`Off   
					`On   
					Repeat steps 1 and 2 for each speaker.   
					You cannot select speakers that you set to “No”   
					or “None” in the “Speaker Configuration”   
					(➔ page 59).   
					If your listening room layout (for practical or aesthetic   
					reasons) locates most of the listeners close to the   
					rear wall, the resulting bass level can be sufficiently   
					reinforced by the boundary that the overall sound   
					becomes “boomy”. THX Select2 Plus receivers   
					contain a Boundary Gain Compensation (BGC)   
					feature to improve bass balance.   
					*1   
					For the center speaker and subwoofer, the level settings   
					
					(➔ page 54).   
					`Off:   
					Tone off, response flat.   
					Tip   
					• If you’re using a handheld sound level meter, adjust the   
					level of each speaker so that it reads 75 dB SPL at the   
					listening position, measured with C-weighting and slow   
					reading.   
					Note   
					• When the Direct or Pure Audio (European, Australian,   
					and Asian models) listening mode is selected, the   
					equalizer settings have no effect.   
					• If “Audyssey” is enabled, it prevails over this setting   
					
					Note   
					• This setting is only available if “THX Ultra2/Select2   
					Subwoofer” is set to “Yes”.   
					• If the “Subwoofer” setting is set to “No”, this setting cannot   
					be selected (➔ page 60).   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-61   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ Loudness Plus   
					`Off   
					Dolby   
					3. Audio Adjust   
					■ PL IIx Music (2ch Input)   
					These settings apply to only 2-channel stereo   
					sources.   
					If you’re not using any surround back speakers, these   
					settings apply to Dolby Pro Logic II, not Dolby Pro   
					
					`On   
					With the Audio Adjust functions and settings, you can   
					adjust the sound and listening modes as you like.   
					When the “Loudness Plus” setting is set to “On”, it is   
					possible to enjoy even subtle nuances of audio   
					expression at low volume. This is only available when   
					the THX listening mode is selected.   
					Multiplex/Mono   
					■ Multiplex   
					■ Preserve THX Settings   
					`Yes   
					`No   
					If this setting is set to “Yes”, Dynamic EQ and   
					Dynamic Volume have no effect in THX listening   
					mode.   
					Input Channel   
					`Main   
					`Sub   
					`Main/Sub   
					This setting determines which channel of a stereo   
					multiplex source is output. Use it to select audio   
					channels or languages with multiplex sources,   
					multilingual TV broadcasts, and so on.   
					Panorama   
					`On   
					`Off   
					With this setting, you can broaden the width of the   
					front stereo image when using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx   
					Music listening mode.   
					Note   
					Dimension   
					`–3 to 0 to +3   
					• This setting is fixed at “Yes” if “Loudness Plus” is set to   
					“On”.   
					With this setting, you can move the sound field   
					forward or backward when using the Dolby Pro Logic   
					IIx Music listening mode. Higher settings move the   
					sound field backward. Lower settings move it forward.   
					If the stereo image feels too wide, or there’s too much   
					surround sound, move the sound field forward to   
					improve the balance. Conversely, if the stereo image   
					feels like it’s in mono, or there’s not enough surround   
					sound, move it backward.   
					■ Mono   
					Input Channel   
					`Left + Right   
					`Left   
					`Right   
					This setting specifies the channel to be used for   
					playing any 2-channel digital source such as Dolby   
					Digital, or 2-channel analog/PCM source in the Mono   
					listening mode.   
					THX Loudness Plus   
					THX Loudness Plus is a new volume control   
					technology featured in THX Ultra2 Plus™ and THX   
					Select2 Plus™ Certified receivers. With THX   
					Loudness Plus, home theater audiences can now   
					experience the rich details in a surround mix at any   
					volume level. A consequence of turning the volume   
					below Reference Level is that certain sound elements   
					can be lost or perceived differently by the listener.   
					THX Loudness Plus compensates for the tonal and   
					spatial shifts that occur when the volume is reduced   
					by intelligently adjusting ambient surround channel   
					levels and frequency response. This enables users   
					experience the true impact of soundtracks regardless   
					of the volume setting. THX Loudness Plus is   
					automatically applied when listening in any THX   
					listening mode. The new THX Cinema, THX Music,   
					and THX Games modes are tailored to apply the   
					proper THX Loudness Plus settings for each type of   
					content.   
					Center Width   
					`0 to 3 to 7   
					Output Speaker   
					`Center:   
					Mono audio is output by the center speaker.   
					`Left / Right:   
					Mono audio is output by the front left and right   
					speakers.   
					This setting determines which speakers output mono   
					audio when the Mono listening mode is selected.   
					With this setting, you can adjust the width of the   
					sound from the center speaker when using the Dolby   
					Pro Logic IIx Music listening mode. Normally, if you’re   
					using a center speaker, the center channel sound is   
					output from only the center speaker. (If you’re not   
					using a center speaker, the center channel sound will   
					be distributed to the front left and right speakers to   
					create a phantom center.) This setting controls the   
					front left, right, and center mix, allowing you to adjust   
					the weight of the center channel sound.   
					Note   
					• If the “Center” setting is set to “None” (➔ page 60), this   
					setting cannot be selected.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-62   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ PL IIz Height Gain   
					■ TrueHD Loudness Management   
					Theater-Dimensional   
					`Low   
					`Off   
					■ Listening Angle   
					`Mid   
					`On   
					`Wide:   
					`High   
					This setting specifies whether or not to apply the Late   
					Night processing on a Dolby TrueHD source.   
					Select if the listening angle is greater than 30   
					degrees.   
					`Narrow:   
					The Height Gain Control in Dolby Pro Logic IIz   
					enables the listener to select how much gain is   
					applied to the front high speakers. There are three   
					settings, “Low”, “Mid” and “High”, and the front high   
					speakers are accentuated in that order. While “Mid” is   
					the default listening setting, the listener may adjust   
					the Height Gain Control to their personal preference.   
					Note   
					• When this setting is set to “Off”, the Late Night function for   
					Dolby TrueHD sources is automatically fixed to “Off”.   
					• When this setting is set to “Off”, the Dialogue Normalization   
					information is not available for Dolby TrueHD sources.   
					Select if the listening angle is less than 30   
					degrees.   
					With this setting, you can optimize the Theater-   
					Dimensional listening mode by specifying the angle of   
					the front left and right speakers relative to the   
					listening position. Ideally, the front left and right   
					speakers should be equidistant from the listening   
					position and at an angle close to one of the two   
					available settings.   
					DTS   
					Note   
					• If the “Front High” settings is set to “None” (➔ page 60),   
					this setting cannot be selected.   
					• If the “Powered Zone 2” setting is set to “Yes” and Zone 2   
					is turned on, this setting cannot be selected.   
					■ Neo:6 Music   
					Center Image   
					`0 to 2 to 5   
					The DTS Neo:6 Music listening mode creates 6-   
					channel surround sound from 2-channel stereo   
					sources. With this setting, you can specify by how   
					much the front left and right channel output is   
					attenuated in order to create the center channel.   
					Changing the value from “0” to “5” will spread the   
					sound of the center channel to left and right   
					(outwards).   
					■ Dolby EX   
					`Auto:   
					Front left speaker   
					Front right speaker   
					If the source signal contains a Dolby EX flag, the   
					Dolby EX or THX Surround EX listening mode is   
					used.   
					Listening angle: 30°   
					`Manual:   
					You can select any available listening mode.   
					
					signals are handled. This setting is unavailable if no   
					surround back speakers are connected. This setting   
					is effective with Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus and   
					Dolby TrueHD only.   
					Note   
					• For best results, we recommend setting “Narrow” to 20°   
					and “Wide” to 40°.   
					® 
					Audyssey DSX   
					LFE Level   
					■ Soundstage   
					`–3dB to Reference to +3dB   
					With this setting, you can adjust the sound stage when   
					using Audyssey DSX.   
					Note   
					*1   
					*2   
					■ Dolby Digital , DTS , Multich PCM, Dolby   
					*3   
					• If the “Surround Back” setting is set to “None”   
					(➔ page 60), this setting cannot be selected.   
					• If the “Powered Zone 2” setting is set to “Yes” and Zone 2   
					is turned on, this setting cannot be selected.   
					• If the “Front High” setting is enabled (➔ page 60), this   
					setting is fixed to “Manual”.   
					TrueHD, DTS-HD Master Audio, DSD   
					`–QdB, –20dB, –10dB, or 0dB   
					Note   
					With these settings, you can set the level of the LFE   
					(Low Frequency Effects) channel individually for each   
					input sources.   
					• This listening mode can be selected only when all the   
					following conditions are satisfied:   
					–The center speaker is connected.   
					If you find that low-frequency effects are too loud   
					when using one of these sources, change the setting   
					to –20 dB or –QdB.   
					–The front high speakers are connected.   
					–Powered Zone 2 is not in use.   
					*1   
					Dolby Digital and Dolby Digital Plus sources   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					En-63   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					(➔ page 56)   
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					*2   
					*3   
					DTS and DTS-HD High Resolution sources   
					DSD (Super Audio CD) sources   
					■ Dynamic EQ   
					`Off   
					`On:   
					at reference level when the master volume control is   
					set to the 0 dB position. At that level you can hear the   
					mix as the mixers heard it.   
					® 
					Audyssey Dynamic EQ is referenced to the standard   
					film mix level. It makes adjustments to maintain the   
					reference response and surround envelopment when   
					the volume is turned down from 0 dB. However, film   
					reference level is not always used in music or other   
					non-film content. Audyssey Dynamic EQ Reference   
					Level Offset provides three offsets from the film level   
					reference (5 dB, 10 dB, and 15 dB) that can be   
					selected when the mix level of the content is not   
					within the standard.   
					Audyssey Dynamic EQ becomes active.   
					The Dynamic EQ indicator will light.   
					4. Source Setup   
					Items can be set individually for each input selector.   
					Press the input selector buttons to select an input   
					source.   
					With Audyssey Dynamic EQ, you can enjoy great   
					sound even when listening at low volume levels.   
					Audyssey Dynamic EQ solves the problem of   
					deteriorating sound quality as volume is decreased by   
					taking into account human perception and room   
					acoustics. It does so by selecting the correct   
					frequency response and surround volume levels   
					moment-by-moment so that the content sounds the   
					way it was created at any volume level — not just at   
					reference level.   
					® 
					Audyssey   
					The tone for each speaker is set automatically by   
					Audyssey MultEQ Room Correction and Speaker   
					Setup. To enable the following settings, you must first   
					perform the Room Correction and Speaker Setup   
					(➔ page 24).   
					® 
					Note   
					• If “Dynamic EQ” setting is set to “Off”, this technology   
					cannot be used.   
					• These technologies cannot be used when a pair of   
					headphones is connected.   
					■ Reference Level   
					Audyssey Dynamic EQ Reference Level Offset   
					■ Dynamic Volume   
					`0dB:   
					`Off   
					`Light:   
					■ Audyssey   
					`Off   
					`Movie:   
					Select this setting for movie material.   
					The Audyssey indicator will light.   
					`Music:   
					This should be selected for movie contents.   
					`5dB:   
					Select this setting for content that has a very   
					wide dynamic range, such as classical music.   
					`10dB:   
					Select this setting for jazz or other music that   
					has a wider dynamic range. This setting should   
					also be selected for TV content as that is usually   
					mixed at 10 dB below film reference.   
					`15dB:   
					Activates Light Compression Mode.   
					`Medium:   
					Activates Medium Compression Mode.   
					`Heavy:   
					Activates Heavy Compression Mode. This   
					setting affects volume the most. It quiets the   
					loud parts, such as explosions, and boosts the   
					quiet parts so they can be heard.   
					Select this setting for music material.   
					The Audyssey indicator will light.   
					Note   
					• When “Audyssey Quick Start” has been used for   
					measurement, “Audyssey” cannot be selected.   
					• Audyssey equalizing does not work with DSD sources.   
					Note   
					Select this setting for pop/rock music or other   
					program material that is mixed at very high   
					listening levels and has a compressed dynamic   
					range.   
					• If you want to use Audyssey Dynamic EQ or   
					Audyssey Dynamic Volume® with THX listening modes, set   
					the “Loudness Plus” setting to “Off” and set “Preserve   
					THX Settings” to “No” (➔ page 62).   
					Movies are mixed in rooms calibrated for film   
					reference. To achieve the same reference level in a   
					home theater system each speaker level must be   
					adjusted so that –30 dBFS band-limited (500 Hz to   
					2000 Hz) pink noise produces 75 dB sound pressure   
					level at the listening position. A home theater system   
					automatically calibrated by Audyssey MultEQ will play   
					• If you make Dynamic Volume active, “Dynamic EQ” is set   
					to “On”. The Dynamic Vol indicator will light.   
					• When “Dynamic EQ” is set to “Off”, “Dynamic Volume” is   
					automatically switched to “Off”.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-64   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					® 
					–“HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On” (➔ page 69) and   
					you’re listening through your TV speakers.   
					• A/V Sync is disabled when the Pure Audio (European,   
					Australian and Asian models) or Direct listening mode is   
					used with an analog input source.   
					About Audyssey Dynamic EQ   
					IntelliVolume   
					Audyssey Dynamic EQ solves the problem of   
					deteriorating sound quality as volume is decreased by   
					taking into account human perception and room   
					acoustics. Dynamic EQ selects the correct frequency   
					response and surround levels moment-by-moment at   
					any user-selected volume setting. The result is bass   
					response, tonal balance and surround impression   
					that remain constant despite changes in volume.   
					Dynamic EQ combines information from incoming   
					source levels with actual output sound levels in the   
					room, a prerequisite for delivering a loudness   
					■ IntelliVolume   
					`–12dB to 0dB to +12dB in 1 dB steps   
					With IntelliVolume, you can set the input level for   
					each input selector individually. This is useful if one of   
					your source components is louder or quieter than the   
					others.   
					• This setting cannot be used with the NET, USB and   
					BLUETOOTH input selectors.   
					Name Edit   
					Use e/rto set the level.   
					You can enter a custom name for each individual   
					input selector and radio preset for easy identification.   
					When entered, the custom name will appear on the   
					display.   
					The custom name is edited using the keyboard   
					
					If a component is noticeably louder than the others,   
					use eto reduce its input level. If it’s noticeably   
					quieter, use rto increase its input level.   
					correction solution. Audyssey Dynamic EQ works in   
					® 
					tandem with Audyssey MultEQ to provide well-   
					Note   
					balanced sound for every listener at any volume level.   
					• IntelliVolume does not work for Zone 2/3.   
					® 
					■ Name   
					About Audyssey Dynamic Volume   
					A/V Sync   
					Audyssey Dynamic Volume solves the problem of   
					large variations in volume level between television   
					programs, commercials, and between the soft and   
					loud passages of movies. Dynamic Volume looks at   
					the preferred volume setting by the user and then   
					monitors how the volume of program material is being   
					perceived by listeners in real time to decide whether   
					an adjustment is needed. Whenever necessary,   
					Dynamic Volume makes the necessary rapid or   
					gradual adjustments to maintain the desired playback   
					volume level while optimizing the dynamic range.   
					Audyssey Dynamic EQ is integrated into   
					Use q/w/e/rto select a character, and then   
					1 
					■ A/V Sync   
					press ENTER.   
					Repeat this step to enter up to 10 characters.   
					`0msec to 800msec in 10 msec steps   
					When using progressive scanning on your Blu-ray   
					Disc/DVD player, you may find that the picture and   
					sound are out of sync. With this setting, you can   
					correct this by delaying the audio signals.   
					Press ENTER to view the TV picture while setting the   
					delay when the video source is output to HDMI OUT   
					MAIN.   
					To store a name when you’re done, be sure to   
					2 
					select “OK” by using q/w/e/r, and then press   
					ENTER.   
					To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.   
					Dynamic Volume so that as the playback volume is   
					adjusted automatically, the perceived bass response,   
					tonal balance, surround impression and dialog clarity   
					remain the same whether watching movies, flipping   
					between television channels or changing from stereo   
					to surround sound content.   
					The range of values you can adjust will depend on   
					whether your TV or display supports HDMI Lip Sync   
					and if the “Lip Sync” setting is set to “On” or not   
					(➔ page 71).   
					Note   
					• This setting is not available in either of the following cases:   
					–The “Audio TV Out (Main)” setting is set to “On”   
					(➔ page 70) or “Audio TV Out (Sub)” setting is set to   
					“On” (➔ page 71) and you’re listening through your TV   
					speakers.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-65   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					mode. See “Monitor Out” for details on the   
					Picture Adjust   
					Name input area   
					monitor output setting (➔ page 57).   
					Using Picture Adjust, you can adjust the picture   
					quality and reduce any noise appearing on the   
					screen.   
					Press ENTER to view the TV picture while setting   
					when the video source is output to HDMI OUT MAIN.   
					To return to the previous screen, press RETURN.   
					4 - 4. Name Edit   
					Name   
					BD/DVD   
					*1   
					■ Picture Mode   
					`Custom:   
					All settings can be performed manually.   
					`Cinema:   
					Select when the picture source is a movie or   
					a 
					n 
					b 
					o 
					c 
					p 
					d 
					q 
					e 
					r 
					f 
					g 
					t 
					h 
					u 
					i 
					j 
					k 
					x 
					l 
					m 
					z 
					s 
					v 
					9 
					w 
					0 
					y 
					^ 
					1 
					, 
					2 
					. 
					3 
					/ 
					4 
					; 
					5 
					: 
					6 
					@ 
					7 
					[ 
					8 
					] 
					– 
					\ 
					Space   
					Shift   
					Back Space   
					OK   
					alike.   
					`Game:   
					*1*6   
					■ Wide Mode   
					+10   
					Shift   
					CLR   
					All Erase   
					This setting determines the aspect ratio.   
					Select when the video source is a game   
					console.   
					`Standard:   
					`4:3:   
					A 
					N 
					! 
					B 
					O 
					˝ 
					C 
					P 
					# 
					D 
					Q 
					$ 
					E 
					R 
					F 
					S 
					& 
					` 
					G 
					T 
					’ 
					H 
					I 
					J 
					K 
					L 
					M 
					U 
					( 
					V 
					) 
					W 
					_ 
					X 
					= 
					Y 
					˜ 
					Z 
					| 
					% 
					Does not adjust picture quality (changes   
					resolution).   
					< 
					> 
					? 
					+ 
					{ 
					} 
					Space   
					Shift   
					Back Space   
					OK   
					`Bypass:   
					+10   
					Shift   
					CLR   
					All Erase   
					Does not adjust picture quality (does not change   
					resolution).   
					*1   
					*2   
					`Full:   
					a 
					b 
					c d   
					e 
					With “Picture Mode”, you can change the following   
					settings to be suitable for the movie or game screen   
					by one operation: “Game Mode”, “Film Mode”, “Edge   
					Enhancement”, “Noise Reduction”, “Brightness”,   
					“Contrast”, “Hue”, “Saturation” or “Color   
					Temperature”.   
					a Toggles between lower and upper case   
					*1   
					characters.   
					b Moves the cursor left or right in the Name input   
					area.   
					c Moves the cursor backward and deletes one   
					`Zoom:   
					*2   
					character.   
					*2*3*4   
					■ Game Mode   
					d Enters a space character.   
					`Off   
					`On   
					e Confirms your entry.   
					If video signal delay occurs during playback on a video   
					component (i.e., game console), select the   
					corresponding input source and set the “Game Mode”   
					setting to “On”. The delay will decrease but in return   
					the picture quality will become poor.   
					Tip   
					• To name a radio preset, use TUNER to select AM or FM,   
					and then select the preset (➔ page 38).   
					• To restore a name to its default, erase all characters with   
					CLR, select “OK” and then press ENTER.   
					`Wide Zoom:   
					*1   
					This can also be performed by using +10 on the remote   
					controller.   
					*2   
					Press CLR on the remote controller to delete all the   
					characters you have input.   
					
					Note   
					According to the input signals and monitor   
					output setting, the AV receiver automatically   
					selects the “4:3”, “Full”, “Zoom” or “Wide Zoom”   
					• This setting cannot be used for the NET, USB and   
					BLUETOOTH input selectors.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-66   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					*2*4   
					*1*2*4   
					■ Hue   
					■ Film Mode   
					Audio Selector   
					`Video:   
					`–50 to 0 to +50   
					“Film Mode” detection is not applied and the   
					input signal is handled as a video source.   
					■ Audio Selector   
					`ARC:   
					With this setting, you can adjust the color hue   
					between “–50” and “+50”.   
					`Auto:   
					The audio signal from your TV tuner can be sent   
					to HDMI OUT MAIN of the AV receiver.   
					With this selection, the TV’s audio can be   
					automatically selected as a priority among other   
					assignments.   
					*1*2*4   
					
					*1   
					Detects whether the input signal is a video or a   
					movie. If it is a movie, the appropriate   
					conversion is applied.   
					
					With this setting, you can adjust saturation. “–50” is   
					the weakest color. “+50” is the strongest color.   
					The AV receiver will adjust to the picture source,   
					automatically converting it to the appropriate   
					progressive signal and reproducing the natural quality   
					of the original picture.   
					*2*4   
					`HDMI:   
					■ Color Temperature   
					`Warm   
					This can be selected when HDMI IN has been   
					assigned as an input source. If both HDMI   
					(HDMI IN) and digital audio inputs (COAXIAL IN   
					or OPTICAL IN) have been assigned, HDMI   
					input is automatically selected as a priority.   
					`COAXIAL:   
					`Normal   
					`Cool   
					*2*4*5   
					■ Edge Enhancement   
					`Off   
					`Low   
					`Mid   
					With this setting, you can adjust the color   
					temperature.   
					Note   
					This can be selected when COAXIAL IN has   
					been assigned as an input source. If both   
					coaxial and HDMI inputs have been assigned,   
					coaxial input is automatically selected as a   
					priority.   
					`High   
					• “Picture Adjust” cannot be used when:   
					–The NET, USB or BLUETOOTH input selector is   
					selected, or   
					–“Monitor Out” is set to “Sub”.   
					This procedure can also be performed on the remote   
					With this setting, you can make the picture appear   
					sharper.   
					*2*4*5   
					■ Noise Reduction   
					`Off   
					`Low   
					`Mid   
					*1   
					`OPTICAL:   
					controller by using the Quick Setup (➔ page 52).   
					When the “Picture Mode” setting is set to anything other   
					than “Custom”, this setting cannot be used.   
					If the “Resolution” setting is set to “4K” (➔ page 57),   
					this setting is fixed at “Off”.   
					Press CLR if you want to reset to the default value.   
					If the “Game Mode” setting is set to “On”, this setting is   
					fixed at “Off”.   
					This can be selected when OPTICAL IN has   
					been assigned as an input source. If both optical   
					and HDMI inputs have been assigned, optical   
					input is automatically selected as a priority.   
					`Analog:   
					The AV receiver always outputs analog signals.   
					You can set priorities of audio output when there are   
					both digital and analog inputs.   
					*2   
					*3   
					`High   
					With this setting, you can reduce noise appearing on   
					the screen. Select the desired level.   
					*4   
					*5   
					*1*2*4   
					■ Brightness   
					`–50 to 0 to +50   
					With this setting, you can adjust the picture   
					
					*6   
					When a 3D video source is input, “Wide Mode” is fixed to   
					“Full”.   
					Note   
					• This setting can be made only for an input source that is   
					assigned to HDMI IN, COAXIAL IN, or OPTICAL IN.   
					• This setting cannot be used with the NET, USB and   
					BLUETOOTH input selectors.   
					• When using the Whole House Mode, “Audio Selector” is   
					fixed to “Analog”.   
					*1*2*4   
					■ Contrast   
					`–50 to 0 to +50   
					
					
					*1   
					You can select “ARC” if you select the TV/CD input   
					selector. But you cannot if you’ve selected “Off” in the   
					“Audio Return Channel” setting (➔ page 71).   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-67   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Setting the Incoming Digital Signal (Fixed   
					Mode)   
					• For the “BLUETOOTH” input selector, only “Digital” is   
					available.   
					5. Listening Mode Preset   
					You can assign a default listening mode to each input   
					source that will be selected automatically when you   
					
					the default listening mode to be used with Dolby   
					Digital input signals. You can select other listening   
					modes during playback, but the mode specified here   
					will be resumed once the AV receiver has been set to   
					standby.   
					■ Analog/PCM/Digital   
					■ Fixed Mode   
					`Off:   
					With this setting, you can specify the listening mode   
					used when an analog (CD, TV, LD, VHS, MD,   
					turntable, radio, cassette, cable, satellite, etc.) or   
					PCM digital (CD, DVD, etc.) audio signal is played.   
					The format is detected automatically. If no digital   
					input signal is present, the corresponding analog   
					input is used instead.   
					`PCM:   
					Note   
					Only 2-channel PCM format input signals will be   
					heard. If the input signal is not PCM, the PCM   
					indicator will flash and noise may also be   
					produced.   
					• For the “AUX” input selector, only “PCM” is available.   
					■ Mono/Multiplex Source   
					Use q/wto select the input source that you   
					1 
					want to set, and then press ENTER.   
					The following menu appears.   
					With this setting, you can specify the listening mode   
					used when a mono digital audio signal is played   
					
					`DTS:   
					Only DTS (but not DTS-HD) format input signals   
					will be heard. If the input signal is not DTS, the   
					dts indicator will flash and there will be no   
					sound.   
					5-1. Listening Mode Preset   
					BD/DVD   
					■ 2ch Source   
					Analog/PCM   
					Mono/Multiplex Source   
					2ch Source   
					Dolby D/Dolby D Plus/TrueHD   
					DTS/DTS-ES/DTS-HD   
					Other Multich Source   
					Last Valid e r   
					With this setting, you can specify the listening mode   
					used when 2-channel (2/0) stereo digital sources,   
					such as Dolby Digital or DTS, are played.   
					Last Valid   
					Last Valid   
					Last Valid   
					Last Valid   
					Last Valid   
					When “HDMI”, “COAXIAL” or “OPTICAL” is selected   
					in the “Audio Selector” setting, you can then specify   
					the signal type in “Fixed Mode”.   
					■ Dolby D/Dolby D Plus/TrueHD   
					Default listening mode for analog and PCM sources.   
					With this setting, you can specify the listening mode   
					used when Dolby Digital or Dolby Digital Plus   
					format digital audio signals are played (DVD, etc.).   
					Specifies the default listening mode for Dolby   
					TrueHD sources, such as Blu-ray or HD DVD (input   
					via HDMI).   
					Normally, the AV receiver detects the signal format   
					automatically. However, if you experience either of   
					the following issues when playing PCM or DTS   
					material, you can manually set the signal format to   
					PCM or DTS.   
					• If the beginnings of tracks from a PCM source are   
					cut off, try setting the format to PCM.   
					• If noise is produced when fast forwarding or   
					reversing a DTS CD, try setting the format to DTS.   
					Use q/wto select the signal format that you   
					want to set, and then use e/rto select a   
					listening mode.   
					2 
					Only listening modes that can be used with each   
					input signal format can be selected (➔ pages 41   
					to 48).   
					■ DTS/DTS-ES/DTS-HD   
					With this setting, you can specify the listening mode   
					used when DTS or DTS-HD High Resolution format   
					digital audio signals are played (DVD, LD, CD,   
					etc.). Specifies the default listening mode for DTS-   
					HD Master Audio sources, such as Blu-ray or HD   
					DVD (input via HDMI).   
					The “Last Valid” option means that the listening   
					mode selected last will be used.   
					The “Straight Decode” option means that   
					straight decoding listening mode (Dolby Digital,   
					DTS, etc.) is selected.   
					Note   
					• The setting will be reset to “Off” when you change the   
					setting in “Audio Selector”.   
					Note   
					■ Other Multich Source   
					• For the “TUNER” input selector, only “Analog” will be   
					available.   
					• For the “NET” or “USB” input selector, “Digital” and   
					“TrueHD“ will be available.   
					Specifies the default listening mode for   
					multichannel PCM sources from HDMI IN such as   
					DVD-Audio, and DSD multichannel sources such   
					as Super Audio CD.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-68   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ Headphone Level   
					`–12dB to 0dB to +12dB   
					With this setting, you can specify the headphone   
					volume relative to the main volume. This is useful if   
					there’s a volume difference between your speakers   
					and your headphones.   
					6. Miscellaneous   
					Volume Setup   
					7. Hardware Setup   
					Tuner   
					■ Volume Display   
					`Absolute:   
					■ AM/FM Frequency Step (North American and   
					Taiwanese models)   
					Displayed range is Min, 1 to 99, Max.   
					`Relative (THX):   
					`10kHz/200kHz:   
					
					OSD Setup   
					Select the frequency step according to your   
					area.   
					Displayed range is –QdB, –81dB to +18dB.   
					With this setting, you can choose how the volume level   
					is displayed.   
					■ On Screen Display   
					`On   
					`Off   
					This preference determines whether operation details   
					are displayed on-screen when an AV receiver   
					function is adjusted.   
					■ AM Frequency Step (European, Australian and   
					Asian models)   
					`10kHz:   
					
					The absolute value 82 is equivalent to the relative   
					value 0 dB.   
					Note   
					Select the frequency step according to your   
					area.   
					For AM/FM tuning to work properly, you must specify   
					the AM/FM frequency step used in your area.   
					• If the absolute value is set to 82, “82Ref” will appear on the   
					display and the THX indicator will flash.   
					Even when “On” is selected, operation details may   
					not be output if the input source is connected to an   
					HDMI IN.   
					■ Muting Level   
					`–QdB (fully muted), –50dB to –10dB in 10 dB   
					■ Language   
					Note   
					steps.   
					(North American models)   
					`English, Deutsch, Français, Español, Italiano,   
					Nederlands, Svenska   
					This setting determines how much the output is muted   
					when the muting function is used (➔ page 50).   
					• When this setting is changed, all radio presets will be   
					deleted.   
					■ Maximum Volume   
					`Off, 50 to 99 (Absolute display)   
					`Off, –32dB to +17dB (Relative display)   
					With this setting, you can limit the maximum volume.   
					To disable this setting, select “Off”.   
					(European, Australian and Asian models)   
					`English, Deutsch, Français, Español, Italiano,   
					Nederlands, Svenska, Русский язык, 中文   
					HDMI   
					■ HDMI CEC (RIHD)   
					`Off   
					`On   
					Turn this setting on to allow p-compatible   
					components connected via HDMI to be controlled by   
					the AV receiver (➔ page 16).   
					(Taiwanese models)   
					`English, Deutsch, Français, Español, Italiano,   
					Nederlands, Svenska, 中文   
					This setting determines the language used for the on-   
					screen menus.   
					■ Power On Volume   
					`Last, Min, 1 to 99 or Max (Absolute display)   
					`Last, –QdB, –81dB to +18dB (Relative display)   
					With this preference, you can specify the volume   
					setting to be used each time the AV receiver is turned   
					on.   
					To use the same volume level that was used when   
					the AV receiver was turned off, select “Last”.   
					The “Power On Volume” setting cannot be set higher   
					than the “Maximum Volume” setting.   
					■ Screen Saver   
					`3min, 5min, 10min   
					`Off   
					With this setting, you can set the time until the screen   
					saver activates itself. Once active, the screen saver   
					will go off and the screen will return to its previous   
					state if the AV receiver is operated in any way.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-69   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ HDMI Through   
					`Off   
					`BD/DVD, CBL/SAT, STB/DVR, GAME, PC, AUX,   
					TV/CD, PHONO:   
					Selects the input source for which the HDMI   
					Through function is enabled.   
					`Last:   
					■ Audio TV Out (Main)   
					`Off   
					`On   
					This preference determines whether the incoming   
					audio signal is output from HDMI OUT MAIN. You   
					may want to turn this preference on if your TV is   
					connected to HDMI OUT MAIN and you want to listen   
					to the audio from a connected component through   
					your TV’s speakers. Normally, this should be set to   
					“Off”.   
					Note   
					• When the setting is set to “On” and the menu is closed, the   
					names of connected p-compatible components and   
					“RIHD On” are displayed on the AV receiver.   
					“Search…” → “(name)” → “RIHD On”   
					When the AV receiver cannot receive the name of the   
					component, it is displayed as “Player*” or “Recorder*”, etc.   
					(“*” shows up and indicates the number of components,   
					when two or more are received).   
					The HDMI Through function is activated on the   
					input source selected at the time of setting the   
					AV receiver to standby mode.   
					
					the AV receiver via an HDMI cable, the name of the   
					connected component is displayed on the AV receiver   
					display. For example, while you are watching TV   
					broadcasting, if you operate a Blu-ray Disc/DVD player   
					(being powered on) with the remote control of the AV   
					receiver, the name of the Blu-ray Disc/DVD player will be   
					displayed on the AV receiver.   
					• Set it to “Off” when a connected piece of equipment is not   
					compatible or it is unclear whether the equipment is   
					compatible or not.   
					• If operation is not normal when set to “On”, change the   
					setting to “Off”.   
					When enabling the HDMI Through function,   
					regardless of whether the AV receiver is on or in   
					standby, both audio and video streams from an HDMI   
					input will be output to the TV or other components via   
					HDMI connection. The HDMI indicator will be dimly-lit   
					in standby mode. Note that the indicator may not light   
					under certain conditions (➔ page 22).   
					This setting is fixed to “Auto” automatically when the   
					above “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” setting is set to “On”,   
					resulting in automatic input source selection.   
					Note   
					• If “On” is selected and the audio can be output from the TV,   
					the AV receiver will output no sound through its speakers.   
					In this case, “TV Speaker” appears on the AV receiver’s   
					display by pressing DISPLAY.   
					• When “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set to “On”, this setting is   
					fixed to “Auto”.   
					• This setting is fixed to “Off” when “Monitor Out” is set to   
					“Sub” (➔ page 57).   
					• With some TVs and input signals, no sound may be output   
					even when this setting is set to “On”.   
					Note   
					• Refer to the connected component’s instruction manual for   
					details.   
					• When the “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” setting is set to “On”, the   
					power consumption on standby mode slightly increases.   
					(Depending on the TV status, the AV receiver will enter   
					standby mode as usual.)   
					• When “Audio TV Out (Main)” or “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set   
					to “On” and you’re listening through your TV’s speakers,   
					turning up the AV receiver’s volume control will make the   
					sound be output from the AV receiver’s front left and right   
					speakers. To stop the AV receiver’s speakers producing   
					sound, change the settings, change your TV’s settings, or   
					turn down the AV receiver’s volume.   
					• Only an input source assigned to an HDMI IN via   
					“HDMI Input” setting is enabled (➔ page 58).   
					• The power consumption in standby mode will increase   
					during the HDMI Through function; however in the following   
					cases, the power consumption can be saved:   
					–The TV is in standby mode.   
					–You are watching a TV program.   
					• Refer to the connected component’s instruction manual for   
					details.   
					• Depending on the connected component, the correct input   
					source may not be selected with the setting fixed to “Auto”.   
					• This setting is set to “Off” automatically when the “HDMI   
					CEC (RIHD)” setting is set to “Off”.   
					• The pcontrol does not support HDMI OUT SUB.   
					Use HDMI OUT MAIN instead.   
					• Listening mode cannot be changed when this setting is set   
					to “On” and the audio is output from the TV.   
					• When the source equipment is connected with the u   
					connection, it may malfunction if “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” is set   
					to “On”.   
					• If the audio signal from the player is not supported by the   
					TV, the audio is not output from the TV even if this setting   
					is enabled. When the audio cannot be output from the TV,   
					(When “Monitor Out” is set to “Both”, the audio cannot be   
					output form the TV connected to both HDMI OUT MAIN and   
					HDMI OUT SUB) the audio is output from the speakers   
					connected to the AV receiver.   
					• This function is only available for the HDMI OUT MAIN jack.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-70   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					■ Audio TV Out (Sub)   
					■ Audio Return Channel   
					■ InstaPrevue   
					`Off   
					`On   
					`Off   
					`Auto:   
					These settings apply to “InstaPrevue” of the Home   
					menu (➔ page 51) and specify the preview display of   
					HDMI video streams.   
					The audio signal from your TV tuner can be sent   
					to HDMI OUT MAIN of the AV receiver.   
					The audio return channel (ARC) function allows an   
					ARC capable TV to send the audio stream to HDMI   
					OUT MAIN of the AV receiver. To use this function,   
					you must select the TV/CD input selector and your TV   
					must be ARC capable. The ARC indicator will light   
					when the audio signal is detected. Default setting:   
					“- - - -”   
					This preference determines whether the incoming   
					audio signal is output from HDMI OUT SUB. You may   
					want to turn this preference on if your TV is   
					connected to HDMI OUT SUB and you want to listen   
					to the audio from a connected component through   
					your TV’s speakers. Normally, this should be set to   
					“Off”.   
					Sub Window   
					`Multi:   
					Displays preview thumbnails all at once.   
					
					Displays preview thumbnails one-by-one.   
					With this setting, you can set the number of preview   
					thumbnails displayed.   
					Note   
					• If “On” is selected and the audio can be output from the TV,   
					the AV receiver will output no sound through its speakers.   
					In this case, “TV Speaker” appears on the AV receiver’s   
					display by pressing DISPLAY.   
					• This setting is fixed to “Off” when “Monitor Out” is set to   
					“Main” (➔ page 57).   
					• When “Monitor Out” is set to “Both” (➔ page 57), and this   
					setting is enabled, set audio output of source component to   
					2ch PCM.   
					• With some TVs and input signals, no sound may be output   
					even when this setting is set to “On”.   
					Position   
					Note   
					(with “Sub Window” set to “Multi”)   
					
					(with “Sub Window” set to “Single”)   
					`Upper Left, Upper Right, Lower Left, Lower   
					Right   
					• This setting is fixed to “- - - -” when the “HDMI CEC (RIHD)”   
					setting is set to “Off”.   
					• This setting is set to “Auto” automatically when the “HDMI   
					CEC (RIHD)” setting is set to “On” for the first time.   
					• If you set “Audio Return Channel” to “Auto”, the “Audio   
					Selector” settings of the TV/CD input selector will be   
					automatically switched to “ARC” (➔ page 67).   
					With this setting, you can set the position of preview   
					thumbnails on the TV screen.   
					Tip   
					Note   
					• After changing the settings of the “HDMI CEC (RIHD)”,   
					“HDMI Through” or “Audio Return Channel”, turn off the   
					power on all connected pieces of equipment and then turn   
					them on again. Refer to the user’s manuals for all   
					connected pieces of equipment.   
					• When “Audio TV Out (Sub)” is set to “On” and you’re   
					listening through your TV’s speakers, turning up the AV   
					receiver’s volume control will make the sound be output   
					from the AV receiver’s front left and right speakers. To stop   
					the AV receiver’s speakers producing sound, change the   
					settings, change your TV’s settings, or turn down the AV   
					receiver’s volume.   
					• Listening mode cannot be changed when this setting is set   
					to “On” and the audio is output from the TV.   
					• When “Monitor Out” is set to “Both” (➔ page 57) and only   
					“Audio TV Out (Sub)” is set to “On”, the audio is not output   
					from the TV connected to HDMI OUT SUB except in the   
					case the audio input is via HDMI.   
					• If the audio signal from the player is not supported by the   
					TV, the audio is not output from the TV even if this setting   
					is enabled. When the audio cannot be output from the TV,   
					
					output form the TV connected to both HDMI OUT MAIN and   
					HDMI OUT SUB) the audio is output from the speakers   
					connected to the AV receiver.   
					• Depending on video signals, the picture may not be   
					properly rendered on the preview thumbnails of   
					InstaPrevue.   
					Auto Standby   
					■ Lip Sync   
					`Off   
					`On   
					■ Auto Standby   
					`Off   
					`On   
					When “Auto Standby” is set to “On”, the ASb   
					indicator lights and the AV receiver will automatically   
					enter standby mode if there is no operation for 30   
					minutes with no audio and no video signal input.   
					“Auto Standby” will appear on the AV receiver’s   
					display and OSD 30 seconds before the Auto   
					Standby comes on.   
					This function allows the AV receiver to automatically   
					correct any delay between the video and the audio,   
					based on the data from the connected monitor.   
					Note   
					• This function works only if your HDMI-compatible TV   
					supports HDMI Lip Sync.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-71   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Default setting: On (European, Australian and   
					Asian models), Off (North American and   
					Taiwanese models)   
					■ MAC Address   
					This is the AV receiver’s MAC (Media Access   
					Control) address. This address cannot be changed.   
					Network   
					This section explains how to configure the AV   
					receiver’s network settings manually.   
					Note   
					■ DHCP   
					`Enable   
					`Disable   
					After modifying the network settings, you must   
					confirm the changes by executing “Save”.   
					
					need to change any of these settings, as the AV   
					receiver is set to use DHCP to configure itself   
					automatically by default (i.e., DHCP is set to   
					“Enable”). If, however, your router’s DHCP server is   
					disabled (you’re for example using static IP), you’ll   
					need to configure these settings yourself, in which   
					case, a knowledge of Ethernet networking is   
					essential.   
					• Set to “On”, the Auto Standby function may activate itself   
					during playback with some sources.   
					• The Auto Standby function does not work when Zone 2/3 is   
					on.   
					This setting determines whether or not the AV   
					receiver uses DHCP to automatically configure its IP   
					Address, Subnet Mask, Gateway, and DNS Server   
					settings.   
					■ HDMI Through   
					`Off   
					`On   
					Note   
					This setting enables or disables the Auto Standby   
					during HDMI Through by detecting the audio/video   
					input signal.   
					When this setting is set to “On”, the AV receiver will   
					automatically enter standby mode if there is no audio   
					and no video signal input during HDMI Through for 30   
					minutes. (The Auto Standby function does not work when   
					Zone 2/3 is on.)   
					• If you select “Disable”, you must configure the “IP   
					Address”, “Subnet Mask”, “Gateway”, and “DNS Server”   
					settings yourself.   
					What’s DHCP?   
					■ IP Address   
					`Class A:   
					“10.0.0.0” to “10.255.255.255”   
					`Class B:   
					“172.16.0.0” to “172.31.255.255”   
					`Class C:   
					“192.168.0.0” to “192.168.255.255”   
					Enter a static IP address provided by your Internet   
					Service Provider (ISP).   
					DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) is used   
					by routers, computers, the AV receiver, and other   
					devices to automatically configure themselves on a   
					network.   
					What’s DNS?   
					When this setting is set to “Off”, the status of HDMI   
					Through is continued regardless of audio/video input   
					signal.   
					The DNS (Domain Name System) translates domain   
					names into IP addresses. For example, when you   
					enter a domain name such as www.onkyousa.com in   
					your Web browser, before accessing the site, your   
					browser uses DNS to translate this into an IP   
					address, in this case 63.148.251.142.   
					Tip   
					• Entering standby mode is possible by setting “HDMI CEC   
					(RIHD)” to “On” and using CEC-compatible component   
					regardless of the above-mentioned setting.   
					See “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” in “7. Hardware Setup” for linked   
					operation (➔ page 69).   
					Most routers use Class C IP addresses.   
					■ Subnet Mask   
					Enter the subnet mask address provided by your ISP   
					(typically 255.255.255.0).   
					■ Network Connection   
					`Wired   
					`Wireless   
					This setting determines whether you connect the AV   
					receiver to network by wired LAN or wireless LAN. If   
					you connect by wireless LAN, select “Wireless”. See   
					“Performing Wireless LAN Setup” for setting   
					(➔ page 27).   
					• When the HDMI Through is enabled, the power   
					consumption slightly increases.   
					■ Gateway   
					Enter the gateway address provided by your ISP.   
					Note   
					• This setting is fixed to “Off” when “Auto Standby” is set to   
					“Off”.   
					■ DNS Server   
					Enter the DNS server address provided by your ISP.   
					■ Proxy URL   
					To use a Web proxy, enter its URL here.   
					Tip   
					• The same setting is available even if “Wireless” is selected   
					in “Network Connection” in initial setup (➔ page 23).   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-72   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					• For details on the Bluetooth connection, refer to the   
					instruction manual of the Bluetooth-enabled device.   
					• The pairing can be done by holding down BLUETOOTH   
					button on the AV receiver until BLUETOOTH indicator   
					flashes.   
					■ Proxy Port   
					If you’re using a Web proxy, enter a proxy port   
					number here.   
					8. Remote Controller Setup   
					Remote ID   
					■ Network Standby   
					`On   
					`Off   
					This setting enables or disables control over the   
					network.   
					When enabled, the NET indicator will be dimly-lit   
					while the AV receiver is in standby mode. Note that   
					
					(➔ page 22).   
					■ Remote ID   
					`1, 2, or 3   
					When several Onkyo components are used in the   
					same room, their remote ID codes may overlap. To   
					differentiate the AV receiver from other components,   
					you can change its remote ID from “1”, to “2” or “3”.   
					Note   
					• This setting cannot be selected if you’ve selected NET or   
					USB as input selector in Multi Zone.   
					Initial Setup   
					If you skipped the initial setup wizard, for example on   
					first-time use, you can reaccess it from here.   
					See “Initial Setup” (➔ page 22).   
					Note   
					• If you do change the AV receiver’s remote ID, be sure to   
					change the remote controller to the same ID (see below),   
					otherwise, you won’t be able to control it with the remote   
					controller.   
					Note   
					Note   
					• When set to “On”, the power consumption slightly   
					increases in standby mode.   
					• This setting cannot be selected if the “Monitor Out” setting   
					is set to “Sub”.   
					Changing the remote controller’s ID   
					■ Update Notice   
					`Enable   
					`Disable   
					While holding down RECEIVER, press and   
					hold down Q SETUP until the remote indicator   
					lights (about 3 seconds).   
					1 
					When this setting is enabled, you will be notified if a   
					firmware update via network of high importance is   
					available.   
					Use the number buttons to enter ID 1, 2, or 3.   
					The remote indicator flashes twice.   
					2 
					Note   
					• Selecting “Never Remind me” on the notification window   
					will switch this setting to “Disable” (➔ page 22).   
					• For details on the update notification, see “Firmware   
					Update Notification” (➔ page 22).   
					Remote Mode Setup   
					See “Looking up for Remote Control Codes”   
					(➔ page 76).   
					■ Bluetooth   
					This setting enables the AV receiver to pair with   
					Bluetooth-enabled device.   
					9. Lock Setup   
					With this preference, you can protect your settings by   
					locking the setup menus.   
					Status   
					Press ENTER button to display “Now Pairing” and   
					start pairing.   
					■ Setup   
					`Locked   
					`Unlocked   
					When “Locked” is selected, the setup menus will be   
					locked and you cannot change any setting.   
					Tip   
					• If pairing setting is not set, “Ready” appears on-screen   
					display. The name of the device paired with the AV receiver   
					is displayed if pairing setting is set.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-73   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Multi Zone   
					In addition to the main listening room, you can also enjoy playback in the other room, or as we call Multi Zone. And, you can select a different source for each room.   
					Making Multi Zone Connections   
					Connecting Your Zone 2 Speakers Directly to the AV receiver   
					Connecting the Zone Speakers to an Additional Amplifier   
					This setup allows you to select different sources for Main room and Zone 2. This is   
					called Powered Zone, as the Zone 2 speakers are powered by the AV receiver.   
					This setup allows 7.1-channel playback in your main listening room and 2-channel   
					stereo playback in Zone 2/3.   
					To use this setup, you must activate the Powered Zone 2 setting (➔ page 59).   
					Main room   
					Main room   
					TV   
					TV   
					AV receiver   
					AV receiver   
					Zone 2   
					Zone 3   
					Zone 2   
					IN   
					IN   
					R 
					L 
					R 
					L 
					R 
					L 
					Receiver/   
					Receiver/   
					integrated amp   
					integrated amp   
					Note   
					• The volume of Zone 2/3 must be set on the Zone 2/3 amplifier.   
					Note   
					• With this setup, the volume of Zone 2 is controlled by the AV receiver.   
					• When Powered Zone 2 is used, playback in the main room is reduced to 5.1 channels.   
					En-74   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Advanced Operations   
					Muting Zone 2   
					Controlling Multi Zone Components   
					8RECEIVER   
					■ Operating on the remote controller   
					■ Operating on the AV receiver   
					INPUT   
					SELECTOR   
					Input selector buttons   
					Press ZONE2 followed by MUTING.   
					1 
					ZONE 2 ZONE 3   
					MASTER VOLUME   
					MUTING   
					ZONE2   
					ZONE3   
					VOLq/w   
					Tip   
					• To unmute, press ZONE2 followed by MUTING again.   
					Zone can also be unmuted by adjusting the volume.   
					Press ZONE2 or ZONE3, then point the remote   
					controller at the AV receiver and press   
					8RECEIVER.   
					1 
					Note   
					• Only analog, NET or USB input source is output from the   
					ZONE 2/ZONE 3 LINE OUT jacks and ZONE 2 L/R   
					terminals.   
					
					main room and Zone 2/3. The same AM/FM radio station   
					will be heard in each room. Namely, if you have selected an   
					FM station for the main room, that station will also be output   
					in Zone 2/3.   
					• You cannot select different input selector NET or USB for   
					your main room and Zone 2/3. Namely, if you have selected   
					USB input selector for Zone 2/3, USB input selector will be   
					selected in main room even if NET has been selected for   
					main room.   
					Zone 2/3 turns on, the Z2 or Z3 indicator lights on   
					the AV receiver’s display.   
					8ON/STANDBY   
					Tip   
					To select an input source for Zone 2/3, press   
					ZONE2 or ZONE3, followed by an INPUT   
					SELECTOR button.   
					2 
					3 
					• The Whole House Mode function shares the input source of   
					main room with Multi Zone (➔ page 50).   
					To turn off Zone 2/3, press ZONE2 or ZONE3,   
					followed by 8RECEIVER.   
					To turn on Zone 2/3 and select an input source,   
					press ZONE 2 or ZONE 3 followed by an input   
					selector button within 8 seconds.   
					1 
					The zone is turned off.   
					Zone 2/3 turns on, the Z2 or Z3 indicator lights on   
					the AV receiver’s display.   
					Adjusting the Volume for Zone 2   
					• BLUETOOTH cannot be selected as input selector in Multi   
					Zone. If you play audio from Bluetooth-enabled device in   
					Multi Zone, select “Z2 Sel: Source” or “Z3 Sel: Source”,   
					and BLUETOOTH as input selector in Main room.   
					• When Zone 2/3 is activated and its input selector is   
					selected, the power consumption of standby mode slightly   
					increases.   
					• While Zone 2/3 is on, ufunctions will not work.   
					• When setting the AV receiver to standby mode while Zone   
					2/3 is active, the Z2 or Z3 indicator is dimly lit.   
					• Activating Zones in the main room when the listening mode   
					is set to Pure Audio (European, Australian and Asian   
					models) will automatically switch it to Direct.   
					• “AUX” cannot be selected as input sources for Zone 2/3.   
					• When “AUX” is the input source of Main room and Zone 2/3   
					is set to share the same source, no sound will be output   
					from Zone 2/3.   
					To select the same source as the main room’s,   
					press ZONE 2 or ZONE 3 twice. “Z2 Sel:   
					Source” or “Z3 Sel: Source” appears on the AV   
					receiver’s display.   
					■ Operating on the remote controller   
					Press ZONE2.   
					1 
					To turn off Zone 2/3, press ZONE 2 or ZONE 3   
					Use VOL q/w.   
					2 
					2 
					followed by 8ON/STANDBY within 8 seconds.   
					The zone is turned off.   
					■ Operating on the AV receiver   
					■ Operating on the remote controller   
					To control Zone 2/3, you must press ZONE2 or   
					ZONE3 on the remote controller first.   
					Press ZONE 2 (the Z2 indicator on the AV   
					receiver’s display flashes).   
					1 
					Use MASTER VOLUME control within 8   
					seconds.   
					2 
					If your Zone 2 speakers are connected to a receiver   
					or integrated amplifier in Zone 2, use its volume   
					control to adjust the volume.   
					En-75   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Controlling Other Components   
					Use q/wto select “Remote Controller Setup”,   
					Entering Remote Control Codes   
					Controlling Other   
					Components   
					3 
					4 
					5 
					and then press ENTER.   
					You’ll need to enter a code for each component that   
					you want to control.   
					Use q/wto select “Remote Mode Setup”, and   
					You can use the AV receiver’s remote controller to   
					control your other AV components, including those   
					made by other manufacturers. This section explains   
					how to enter the remote control code for a component   
					that you want to control: DVD, TV, CD, etc.   
					then press ENTER.   
					Look up the appropriate remote control code   
					Use q/wto select a remote mode, and then   
					1 
					in the separate Remote Control Codes list.   
					The codes are organized by category (e.g., DVD   
					player, TV, etc.).   
					press ENTER.   
					The menu of category selection appears.   
					Use q/wto select a category, and then press   
					6 
					7 
					While holding down the REMOTE MODE   
					ENTER.   
					2 
					Preprogrammed Remote Control   
					Codes   
					button to which you want to assign a code,   
					press and hold down DISPLAY (about 3   
					seconds).   
					The keyboard screen for brand name input   
					appears.   
					The following REMOTE MODE buttons are   
					preprogrammed with remote control codes for   
					controlling the components listed. You do not need to   
					enter a remote control code to control these   
					components.   
					Use q/w/e/rto select a character, and then   
					The remote indicator lights.   
					press ENTER.   
					Note   
					Repeat this step for the first three characters of   
					the brand name.   
					• Remote control codes cannot be entered for   
					RECEIVER and the multi zone button.   
					When you have entered the 3rd character, select   
					“Search” and press ENTER.   
					A list of brand names is retrieved.   
					If the desired brand name is not found:   
					• Only TV remote control codes can be entered for TV.   
					• Except for RECEIVER, TV, and the multi zone button,   
					remote control codes from any category can be   
					assigned for the REMOTE MODE buttons. However,   
					these buttons also work as input selector buttons, so   
					choose a REMOTE MODE button that corresponds   
					with the input to which you connect your component.   
					For example, if you connect your CD player to the CD   
					input, choose TV/CD when entering its remote control   
					code.   
					For details on controlling these components, see the   
					indicated pages.   
					BD/DVD Onkyo Blu-ray Disc player (➔ page 78)   
					Use rto select “Not Listed”, and then press   
					TV/CD   
					Onkyo CD player (➔ page 77)   
					ENTER.   
					STB/DVR Apple TV   
					The keyboard screen for brand name input   
					appears.   
					Use q/wto select a brand, and then press   
					ENTER.   
					Looking up for Remote Control Codes   
					8 
					9 
					Within 30 seconds, use the number buttons to   
					3 
					You can look up for an appropriate remote control   
					code from the on-screen menu.   
					enter the 5-digit remote control code.   
					The remote indicator flashes twice.   
					If the remote control code is not entered   
					successfully, the remote indicator will flash once   
					slowly.   
					A remote control code with its instructions are   
					displayed. Follow the procedure.   
					Note   
					If you can control the component, use q/wto   
					select “OK”, and then press ENTER.   
					The on-screen menu returns to the “Remote   
					Mode Setup” front screen.   
					• You need to connect your TV to the HDMI output (HDMI   
					OUT MAIN) to make the following on-screen setting.   
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME.   
					Note   
					1 
					If you cannot control the component, use q/w   
					to select “Try Next Code” and press ENTER.   
					The next code is displayed.   
					• Though the provided remote control codes are correct at   
					the time of release, they are subject to change.   
					Use e/ror q/wto select “Setup”, and then   
					2 
					press ENTER.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-76   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Controlling Other Components   
					`32901/33104/33504:   
					Onkyo HD DVD player   
					`70868:   
					Remapping Colored Buttons   
					Remote Control Codes for Onkyo   
					Components Connected via RI   
					You can change the configuration of colored buttons,   
					with which REMOTE MODE buttons are preset.   
					Onkyo MD recorder without u   
					Onkyo components that are connected via uare   
					controlled by pointing the remote controller at the AV   
					receiver, not the component. This allows you to   
					control components that are out of view, in a rack, for   
					example.   
					`71323:   
					While holding down the REMOTE MODE   
					Onkyo CD recorder without u   
					1 
					button that you want to program, press and   
					hold down A (Red) until the remote indicator   
					lights (about 3 seconds).   
					`82990:   
					Onkyo Dock without u   
					You can only change colored buttons for   
					components whose codes belong to categories   
					
					player, TV, cable set-top box, etc).   
					Make sure the Onkyo component is connected   
					1 
					Resetting the REMOTE MODE Buttons   
					with an ucable and an analog audio cable   
					(RCA).   
					You can reset a REMOTE MODE button to its default   
					remote control code.   
					See “Connecting Onkyo RI Components” for   
					details (➔ page 20).   
					Within 30 seconds, press the colored buttons   
					2 
					
					The button presses are assigned to each button   
					from left to right. The remote indicator flashes   
					twice, indicating that the sequence has been   
					successfully assigned. If the sequence is not   
					successfully assigned, the remote indicator will   
					flash once slowly.   
					While holding down the REMOTE MODE   
					
					Enter the appropriate remote control code for   
					a REMOTE MODE button, by referring to the   
					previous section.   
					2 
					button that you want to reset, press and hold   
					down HOME until the remote indicator lights   
					(about 3 seconds).   
					`42157:   
					Within 30 seconds, press the REMOTE MODE   
					button again.   
					Onkyo cassette tape deck with u   
					2 
					`81993:   
					The remote indicator flashes twice, indicating that   
					the button has been reset.   
					Each REMOTE MODE button is preprogrammed   
					with a remote control code. When a button is   
					reset, its preprogrammed code is restored.   
					Onkyo Dock with u   
					Press the REMOTE MODE button, point the   
					remote controller at the AV receiver, and   
					operate the component.   
					Tip   
					3 
					• To reset the REMOTE MODE buttons to their default   
					settings, see “Resetting the REMOTE MODE Buttons”.   
					Note   
					Controlling Onkyo components without u   
					If you want to control an Onkyo component by   
					pointing the remote controller directly at it, or you   
					
					connected via u, use the following remote control   
					codes:   
					• If any other button than the colored buttons is pressed, the   
					operation will be cancelled.   
					• This operation cannot be done while the AV receiver is in   
					Receiver mode or when Zone 2/3 is active.   
					Resetting the Remote Controller   
					You can reset the remote controller to its default   
					settings.   
					While holding down RECEIVER, press and   
					hold down HOME until the remote indicator   
					lights (about 3 seconds).   
					1 
					`30627:   
					Onkyo DVD player without u   
					`71817:   
					Within 30 seconds, press RECEIVER again.   
					The remote indicator flashes twice, indicating that   
					the remote controller has been reset.   
					2 
					Onkyo CD player without u   
					`32900/33100/33500:   
					Onkyo Blu-ray Disc player   
					En-77   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Controlling Other Components   
					Controlling MHL-Enabled Mobile Device   
					Controlling Other Components   
					Press the appropriate REMOTE   
					MODE button first.   
					By programming the supplied remote controller with   
					the appropriate remote control code, you can use it to   
					operate your MHL-enabled mobile device.   
					Connect your MHL-enabled mobile device to the AUX   
					INPUT MHL jack. We advise you to program the   
					remote control code on the AUX button.   
					Use the following remote control codes:   
					(North American and Taiwanese models)   
					`33101:   
					By pressing the REMOTE MODE button that’s been   
					programmed with the remote control code for your   
					component, you can control your component as   
					described below.   
					For details on entering a remote control code for other   
					components, see “Entering Remote Control Codes”   
					(➔ page 76).   
					h 
					i 
					Controlling a TV   
					MHL-enabled mobile device   
					(European, Australian, and Asian models)   
					`32910:   
					j 
					TV is preprogrammed with the remote control code   
					*1   
					for controlling a TV that supports the p   
					a 
					b 
					(limited to some models). The TV must be able to   
					receive remote control commands via pand   
					be connected to the AV receiver via HDMI. If   
					controlling your TV via pdoesn’t work very   
					well, program your TV’s remote control code into TV   
					and use the TV remote mode to control your TV.   
					Use the following remote control codes:   
					`11807/13100/13500:   
					MHL-enabled mobile device   
					k 
					l 
					Note   
					• With some mobile devices, reliable operation cannot be   
					guaranteed.   
					c 
					d 
					m 
					n 
					Controlling a Blu-ray Disc/DVD Player, HD   
					DVD Player or DVD Recorder   
					BD/DVD is preprogrammed with the remote control   
					code for controlling a component that supports the   
					TV with p   
					e 
					f 
					*1   
					p 
					(limited to some models). The component   
					Controlling Apple TV   
					must be able to receive remote control commands via   
					pand be connected to the AV receiver via   
					HDMI.   
					By programming the supplied remote controller with   
					the appropriate remote control code, you can use it to   
					operate your Apple TV.   
					Use the following remote control codes:   
					`32910/33101/33501/31612:   
					g 
					
					`02615:   
					Blu-ray Disc/DVD player with p   
					Apple TV   
					o 
					*1   
					The psupported by the AV receiver is the CEC   
					system control function of the HDMI standard.   
					En-78   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Controlling Other Components   
					■ TV operation   
					■ DVD player/DVD recorder operation   
					■ Satellite receiver/Cable receiver operation   
					Available buttons   
					Available buttons   
					TOP MENU   
					Available buttons   
					GUIDE   
					Number: 1 to 9, 0   
					a 8, INPUT, TV VOL q/w g   
					b 
					h 8SOURCE   
					b 
					h 8SOURCE   
					Number: +10*1   
					DISPLAY   
					MUTING   
					CH +/–   
					GUIDE   
					DISPLAY   
					DISPLAY   
					b 
					c q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					i 
					c q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					i 
					c q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					i 
					j 
					
					l 
					m 
					n 
					o 
					SETUP   
					MUTING   
					SETUP   
					MUTING   
					d 
					j 
					d 
					j 
					SETUP   
					CH +/–   
					CH +/–   
					d 
					e 1, 3, 2, 5, 4,   
					k 
					
					k 
					7, 6   
					
					DISC +/–   
					PREV CH   
					e 1, 3, 2, 5, 4,   
					l 
					*1   
					7, 6   
					PREV CH   
					RETURN   
					AUDIO*1   
					CLR   
					A (Red)*1   
					MENU   
					A (Red)   
					RETURN   
					f 
					l 
					f 
					m 
					A (Red)*1   
					B (Green)   
					C (Yellow)*1   
					D (Blue)*1   
					B (Green)   
					C (Yellow)   
					D (Blue)   
					RETURN   
					AUDIO   
					f 
					m 
					n 
					B (Green)*1   
					C (Yellow)*1   
					D (Blue)*1   
					AUDIO*1   
					CLR   
					n 
					o 
					CLR   
					o 
					Number: 1 to 9, 0   
					Number: 1 to 9, 0   
					g 
					g 
					Number: +10*1   
					Number: +10   
					
					■ VCR/PVR operation   
					■ CD player/CD recorder/MD recorder operation   
					Available buttons   
					TOP MENU   
					Available buttons   
					Available buttons   
					b 
					h 8SOURCE   
					Number: 1 to 9, 0   
					GUIDE   
					DISPLAY   
					MUTING   
					CH +/–   
					b 
					h 8SOURCE   
					c q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					g 
					c q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					i 
					j 
					k 
					DISPLAY   
					SETUP   
					Number: +10   
					SETUP   
					c q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					i 
					d 
					d 
					SETUP   
					MUTING   
					CH +/–   
					e 1, 3, 2, 5, 4,   
					h 8SOURCE   
					e 1, 3, 2, 5, 4,   
					d 
					j 
					k 
					l 
					m 
					o 
					7, 6   
					7, 6   
					DISC +/–   
					MENU   
					DISPLAY   
					e 1, 3, 2, 5, 4,   
					i 
					7, 6   
					A (Red)   
					PREV CH   
					RETURN   
					CLR   
					SEARCH   
					MUTING   
					f 
					l 
					m 
					n 
					o 
					f 
					j 
					REPEAT   
					RANDOM   
					MODE   
					DISC +/–   
					RETURN   
					AUDIO*1   
					CLR   
					Number: 1 to 9, 0   
					B (Green)   
					g 
					k 
					Number: +10   
					CLR   
					C (Yellow)   
					o 
					
					■ Cassette tape deck operation   
					Number: 1 to 9, 0   
					Number: +10*1   
					g 
					
					Note   
					e 1, t(Reverse   
					Playback), 2, 5, 4,   
					7, 6   
					h 8SOURCE   
					• With some components, certain buttons may not work as   
					expected, and some may not work at all.   
					• See “Controlling Your iPod/iPhone” about the operation of   
					iPod/iPhone (➔ page 81).   
					MUTING   
					j 
					*1   
					The pfunction is not supported. The p   
					supported by the AV receiver is the CEC system control   
					function of the HDMI standard.   
					En-79   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Controlling Other Components   
					Direct Change   
					The Dock is sold separately. Models sold are   
					different depending on the region.   
					For the latest information on the Onkyo Dock   
					components, see the Onkyo web site at:   
					http://www.onkyo.com   
					Before using the Onkyo Dock components, update   
					your iPod/iPhone with the latest software, available   
					from the Apple web site.   
					For supported iPod/iPhone models, see the   
					instruction manual of the Onkyo Dock.   
					Using the Onkyo Dock   
					RI Dock   
					If you start iPod/iPhone playback while listening to   
					another input source, the AV receiver will   
					automatically switch to the input to which the RI Dock   
					is connected.   
					With the RI Dock, you can easily play the music of   
					your iPod/iPhone, or watch the slideshows and   
					videos of your iPod/iPhone on a TV. In addition, the   
					on-screen display (OSD) allows you to view,   
					navigate, and select your iPod/iPhone model’s   
					contents on your TV, and with the supplied remote   
					controller, you can control your iPod/iPhone from the   
					comfort of your sofa. You can even use the AV   
					receiver’s remote controller to operate your   
					iPod/iPhone.   
					Other Remote Operations   
					You can use the remote controller that came with the   
					AV receiver to control other iPod/iPhone functions.   
					The available functionality depends on the AV   
					receiver.   
					Note   
					• If you use your iPod/iPhone with any other accessories,   
					iPod/iPhone playback detection may not work.   
					• The System On function may not work depending on the RI   
					Dock.   
					Note   
					• Enter the appropriate remote control code before using the   
					AV receiver’s remote controller for the first time   
					(➔ page 77).   
					iPod Alarm   
					If you use the Alarm function on your iPod to start   
					playback, the AV receiver will turn on at the specified   
					time and select your iPod as the input source   
					automatically.   
					• Connect the RI Dock to the AV receiver with an ucable   
					(➔ page 20).   
					• Set the RI Dock’s RI MODE switch to “HDD” or   
					“HDD/DOCK”.   
					Note   
					• Set the AV receiver’s Input Display to “DOCK”   
					(➔ page 50).   
					• Depending on your iPod/iPhone model and generation,   
					some of the linked operations may not be available.   
					• This linked operation won’t work while a video is being   
					played or when the sound set for the alarm is a built-in   
					sound (Beep).   
					■ System Function   
					System On   
					When you turn on the AV receiver, the RI Dock and   
					iPod/iPhone turn on automatically. In addition, when   
					RI Dock and iPod/iPhone are on, the AV receiver can   
					be turned on by pressing 8SOURCE.   
					• This linked operation won’t work with models on which   
					music files cannot be used to set the alarm sound.   
					■ Operating Notes   
					• Use the AV receiver’s volume control to adjust the playback   
					volume.   
					• While your iPod/iPhone is inserted in the RI Dock, its   
					volume control has no effect.   
					• If you do adjust the volume control on your iPod/iPhone   
					while it’s inserted in the RI Dock, be careful that it’s not set   
					too loud before you reconnect your headphones.   
					Auto Power On   
					If you press the remote controller’s 1(Playback)   
					while the AV receiver is on standby, the AV receiver   
					will automatically turn on, select your iPod/iPhone as   
					the input source, and your iPod/iPhone will start   
					playback.   
					En-80   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					
				Controlling Other Components   
					■ uDock operation   
					Controlling Your iPod/iPhone   
					Press the appropriate REMOTE   
					MODE button first.   
					Available buttons   
					By pressing the REMOTE MODE button that’s been   
					programmed with the remote control code for your   
					Dock, you can control your iPod/iPhone in the Dock   
					with the buttons described further in this section.   
					See “Entering Remote Control Codes” for details on   
					entering a remote control code (➔ page 76).   
					See the Dock’s instruction manual for more   
					information.   
					TOP MENU*1   
					a 
					e 8SOURCE*2   
					DISPLAY*3   
					b q/w/e/r, ENTER   
					f 
					MUTING   
					PLAYLIST e/r   
					g 
					e 
					f 
					ALBUM +/–   
					
					h 
					
					i VOL q/w   
					REPEAT   
					MENU   
					MODE*4   
					d 
					j 
					k 
					RANDOM   
					g 
					h 
					• With some iPod/iPhone models, generations and RI Docks,   
					certain buttons may not work as expected.   
					• For detailed operation of iPod/iPhone, please refer to the   
					instruction manual of the RI Dock.   
					RI Dock   
					• Set the RI Dock’s RI MODE switch to “HDD” or   
					“HDD/DOCK”.   
					i 
					*1   
					TOP MENU works as the mode button when used with   
					• 8SOURCE may not work with a remote control   
					code (without u). In this case, make an u   
					connection and enter the remote control code 81993   
					(with u).   
					the DS-A2 RI Dock.   
					This button does not turn the Onkyo DS-A2 or DS-A2X   
					a 
					b 
					j 
					*2   
					RI Dock on or off. Also, your iPod/iPhone may not   
					respond the first time you press this button, in which case   
					you should press it again. This is because the remote   
					controller transmits the On and Standby commands   
					alternately, so if your iPod/iPhone is already on, it will   
					remain on when the remote controller transmits the On   
					command. Similarly, if your iPod/iPhone is already off, it   
					will remain off when the remote controller transmits the   
					Off command.   
					■ With the RI Control   
					Make an uconnection and enter the remote control   
					code 81993 (with u).   
					c 
					d 
					• Set the AV receiver’s Input Display to “DOCK”   
					(➔ page 50).   
					k 
					*3   
					DISPLAY turns on the backlight for a few seconds.   
					Resume mode   
					■ Without the RI Control   
					*4   
					You must enter the remote control code 82990 first   
					(➔ page 77).   
					With the Resume function, you can resume playback of   
					the song that was playing when you removed your   
					iPod/iPhone from the Onkyo DS-A2 RI Dock.   
					En-81   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					
				Appendix   
					seconds). Within 30 seconds, press RECEIVER   
					again.   
					The on-screen information appears only on a TV that   
					is connected to HDMI outputs.   
					Audio   
					Troubleshooting   
					■ There’s no sound, or it’s very quiet   
					Make sure that the digital input source is selected properly.   
					(➔ page 59)   
					If you have any trouble using the AV receiver, look for   
					a solution in this section. If you can’t resolve the issue   
					yourself, contact your Onkyo dealer.   
					Make sure that all audio connecting plugs are pushed in all   
					the way (➔ page 15).   
					Power   
					Resetting the AV receiver   
					Make sure that the inputs and outputs of all components   
					
					■ Can’t turn on the AV receiver   
					Make sure that the power cord is properly plugged into the   
					wall outlet.   
					If you can’t resolve the issue yourself, try resetting the   
					AV receiver before contacting your Onkyo dealer.   
					To reset the AV receiver to its factory defaults, turn it   
					on and, while holding down CBL/SAT, press   
					8ON/STANDBY. “Clear” will appear on the AV   
					receiver’s display and the AV receiver will enter   
					standby mode.   
					Make sure that the polarity of the speaker cables is correct,   
					and that the bare wires are in contact with the metal part of   
					each speaker terminal. (➔ page 13)   
					Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet, wait five   
					seconds or more, then plug it in again.   
					Make sure that the input source is properly selected.   
					(➔ page 29)   
					■ The AV receiver turns off unexpectedly   
					The AV receiver will automatically enter standby mode   
					when Auto Standby has been set and launches.   
					(➔ page 71)   
					Make sure that the speaker cables are not shorting.   
					(➔ page 14)   
					Check the volume. The AV receiver is designed for home   
					theater enjoyment. It has a wide volume range, allowing   
					precise adjustment.   
					■ The AV receiver turns off and after restoring the   
					power, it turns off again   
					If the MUTING indicator is flashing on the AV receiver’s   
					display, press the remote controller’s MUTING button to   
					unmute the AV receiver. (➔ page 50)   
					The protection circuit has been activated. Remove the   
					power cord from the wall outlet immediately. Make sure   
					that all speaker cables and input sources are properly   
					connected, and leave the AV receiver with its power cord   
					disconnected for 1 hour. After that, reconnect the power   
					cord and turn the power on. If the AV receiver turns off   
					again, avoid resetting it and unplug the power cord. Then   
					contact your Onkyo dealer. (➔ page 14)   
					Note that resetting the AV receiver will delete your   
					radio presets and custom settings.   
					While a pair of headphones is connected to the PHONES   
					jack, no sound is output from the speakers. (➔ page 20)   
					If there’s no sound from a DVD player connected to an   
					HDMI IN, check the DVD player’s output settings, and be   
					sure to select a supported audio format.   
					Remote indicator   
					Check the digital audio output setting on the connected   
					device. On some game consoles, such as those that   
					support DVD, the default setting is off.   
					Caution:   
					• If “CHECK SP WIRE” appears on the AV receiver’s   
					display, the speaker cables may be shorting.   
					RECEIVER   
					With some DVD-Video discs, you need to select an audio   
					output format from a menu.   
					If your turntable uses an MC cartridge, you must connect   
					an MC head amp, or an MC transformer.   
					WARNING:   
					• If smoke, smell or abnormal noise is produced by the AV   
					receiver, unplug the power cord from the wall outlet   
					immediately and contact your Onkyo dealer.   
					Make sure that none of the connecting cables are bent,   
					twisted, or damaged.   
					HOME   
					Not all listening modes use all speakers. (➔ page 41)   
					Specify the speaker distances and adjust the individual   
					speaker levels. (➔ pages 60, 61)   
					To reset the remote controller to its factory defaults,   
					while holding down RECEIVER, press and hold down   
					HOME until the remote indicator lights (about 3   
					Make sure that the speaker setup microphone is not still   
					connected.   
					En-82   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					■ The front high and surround back speakers   
					produce no sound   
					Depending on the current listening mode, no sound may be   
					produced by the front high and surround back speakers.   
					Select another listening mode. (➔ page 41)   
					If the input signal format is set to “PCM” or “DTS”. Set it to   
					“Off”. (➔ page 68)   
					If the volume level of each individual speaker has been   
					adjusted to high positive values, then the maximum master   
					volume possible may be reduced. Note that the individual   
					speaker volume levels are set automatically after the   
					Audyssey MultEQ® Room Correction and Speaker Setup   
					has been performed. (➔ pages 24, 61)   
					■ Only the front speakers produce sound   
					When the Stereo or Mono listening mode is selected, only   
					the front speakers and subwoofer produce sound.   
					(➔ page 43)   
					Depending on the sources, the sound produced by the   
					front high and surround back speakers may be weak.   
					■ Noise can be heard   
					In the Mono listening mode, only the front speakers output   
					sound if the “Output Speaker” setting is set to “Left /   
					
					Make sure the speakers are configured correctly.   
					(➔ page 59)   
					Using cable ties to bundle audio cables with power cords,   
					
					performance, so refrain from doing it.   
					When Powered Zone 2 is used, playback in the main room   
					is reduced to 5.1channels and the front high and surround   
					back speakers produce no sound.   
					Make sure the speakers are configured correctly.   
					(➔ page 59)   
					An audio cable may be picking up interference. Try   
					repositioning your cables.   
					■ Only the center speaker produces sound   
					
					When you play source material that contains no information   
					in the LFE channel, the subwoofer produces no sound.   
					■ The Late Night function doesn’t work   
					Make sure the source material is Dolby Digital, Dolby   
					
					If you use the Dolby Pro Logic IIx Movie, Dolby Pro Logic   
					IIx Music, or Dolby Pro Logic IIx Game listening mode with   
					a mono source, such as an AM radio station or mono TV   
					program, the sound is concentrated in the center speaker.   
					Make sure the speakers are configured correctly.   
					(➔ page 59)   
					Make sure that the “TrueHD Loudness Management”   
					setting is not set to “Off”. The Late Night function doesn’t   
					work when this setting is disabled. (➔ page 63)   
					In the Mono listening mode, only the center speaker output   
					sound if the “Output Speaker” setting is set to “Center”.   
					(➔ page 62)   
					■ There’s no sound with a certain signal format   
					Check the digital audio output setting on the connected   
					device. On some game consoles, such as those that   
					support DVD, the default setting is off.   
					■ About DTS signals   
					Make sure the speakers are configured correctly.   
					(➔ page 59)   
					When DTS program material ends and the DTS bitstream   
					stops, the AV receiver remains in DTS listening mode and   
					the dts indicator remains on. This is to prevent noise when   
					you use the pause, fast forward, or fast reverse function on   
					your player. If you switch your player from DTS to PCM,   
					you may not hear any sound because the AV receiver does   
					not switch formats immediately. In such case, you should   
					stop your player for about three seconds and then resume   
					playback.   
					With some DVD-Video discs, you need to select an audio   
					output format from a menu.   
					■ The surround speakers produce no sound   
					When the T-D (Theater-Dimensional), Stereo or Mono   
					listening mode is selected, the surround speakers produce   
					no sound.   
					Depending on the input signal, some listening modes   
					cannot be selected. (➔ pages 41 to 48)   
					Depending on the source and current listening mode, not   
					much sound may be produced by the surround speakers.   
					Try selecting another listening mode. (➔ page 41)   
					■ Can’t select the Pure Audio listening mode   
					(European, Australian and Asian models) The Pure   
					
					on.   
					With some CD and LD players, you won’t be able to   
					playback DTS material properly even though your player is   
					connected to a digital input on the AV receiver. This is   
					usually because the DTS bitstream has been processed   
					(e.g., output level, sampling rate, or frequency response   
					changed) and the AV receiver doesn’t recognize it as a   
					genuine DTS signal. In such cases, you may hear noise.   
					Make sure the speakers are configured correctly.   
					(➔ page 59)   
					■ Can’t get 6.1/7.1 playback   
					■ The center speaker produces no sound   
					When the Stereo or Mono listening mode is selected, the   
					center speaker produces no sound.   
					If no surround back speakers and front high speakers are   
					connected, or the Zone 2 speakers are being used, 6.1/7.1   
					playback is not possible.   
					In the Mono listening mode, only the front speakers output   
					sound if the “Output Speaker” setting is set to “Left /   
					Right”. (➔ page 62)   
					Depending on the number of connected speakers, it is not   
					always possible to select all of the listening modes.   
					(➔ pages 41 to 48)   
					Playing DTS program material, using the pause, fast   
					forward, or fast reverse function on your player may   
					produce a short audible noise. This is not a malfunction.   
					Make sure the speakers are configured correctly.   
					
					
					Check to see if a maximum volume has been set.   
					(➔ page 69)   
					En-83   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Appendix   
					■ The beginning of audio received by an HDMI IN   
					can’t be heard   
					■ There’s no picture from a source connected to   
					an HDMI IN   
					Remote Controller   
					Since it takes longer to identify the format of an HDMI   
					signal than it does for other digital audio signals, audio   
					output may not start immediately.   
					Reliable operation with an HDMI-to-DVI adapter is not   
					guaranteed. In addition, video signals from a PC are not   
					guaranteed. (➔ page 93)   
					■ The remote controller doesn’t work   
					Before operating this unit, be sure to press RECEIVER.   
					Make sure that the batteries are installed with the correct   
					polarity. (➔ page 11)   
					When the resolution is set to any resolution not supported   
					by the TV, no video is output from the HDMI outputs.   
					(➔ page 57)   
					■ There’s no sound during Whole House Mode   
					Make sure you’ve selected an analog audio input.   
					Install new batteries. Don’t mix different types of batteries,   
					or old and new batteries. (➔ page 11)   
					If the message “Resolution Error” appears on the AV   
					
					support the current video resolution and you need to select   
					another resolution on your DVD player.   
					Make sure that the remote controller is not too far away   
					from the AV receiver, and that there’s no obstruction   
					between the remote controller and the AV receiver’s   
					remote control sensor. (➔ page 11)   
					Video   
					■ There’s no picture   
					Make sure that all video connecting plugs are pushed in all   
					the way. (➔ page 18)   
					■ The on-screen menus don’t appear   
					On your TV, make sure that the video input to which the AV   
					receiver is connected is selected.   
					Make sure that the AV receiver is not subjected to direct   
					sunshine or inverter-type fluorescent lights. Relocate if   
					necessary.   
					Make sure that each video component is properly   
					
					If the AV receiver is installed in a rack or cabinet with   
					colored-glass doors, the remote controller may not work   
					reliably when the doors are closed.   
					When the AV receiver is not connected to a TV via HDMI   
					OUT MAIN, on-screen menus are not displayed.   
					If your TV is connected to the HDMI output(s), select   
					“- - - - -” in the “HDMI Input” setting to watch composite   
					video, and component video sources. (➔ page 58)   
					■ The on-screen information does not appear   
					Make sure you’ve selected the correct remote controller   
					mode. (➔ pages 11, 78)   
					If the video source is connected to a component video   
					
					your TV must be connected to either the HDMI output(s) or   
					COMPONENT VIDEO OUT. (➔ pages 15, 58)   
					Depending on the input signal, the on-screen information   
					may not appear when the input signal from HDMI IN is   
					output to a device connected to the HDMI output.   
					When using the remote controller to control other   
					manufacturers’ AV components, some buttons may not   
					work as expected.   
					If the video source is connected to a composite video input,   
					your TV must be connected to the HDMI output(s) or the   
					corresponding composite video output. (➔ page 15)   
					Tuner   
					Make sure you’ve entered the correct remote control code.   
					(➔ page 76)   
					■ Reception is noisy, FM stereo reception is noisy,   
					or the FM STEREO indicator doesn’t light   
					
					Make sure to set the same ID on both the AV receiver and   
					remote controller. (➔ page 73)   
					If the video source is connected to an HDMI input, you   
					must assign that input to an input selector, and your TV   
					must be connected to the HDMI output(s). (➔ pages 15,   
					58)   
					■ Can’t control other components   
					
					Listen to the station in mono. (➔ page 38)   
					If it’s an Onkyo component, make sure that the ucable   
					and analog audio cable are connected properly.   
					Connecting only an ucable won’t be enough.   
					(➔ page 20)   
					(European, Australian and Asian models) While the   
					Pure Audio listening mode is selected, the analog video   
					circuitry is turned off and only video signals input through   
					HDMI IN can be output. (➔ page 41)   
					When listening to an AM station, operating the remote   
					controller may cause noise.   
					Passing cars and airplanes can cause interference.   
					Concrete walls weaken radio signals.   
					Make sure you’ve selected the correct remote controller   
					On your TV, make sure that the video input to which the AV   
					receiver is connected is selected.   
					mode. (➔ pages 11, 78)   
					If nothing improves the reception, install an outdoor   
					antenna.   
					If you’ve connected an cassette tape deck to the TV/CD IN   
					jack, or an RI Dock to the TV/CD IN or GAME IN jacks, for   
					the remote controller to work properly, you must set the   
					input display appropriately. (➔ page 50)   
					When the “Monitor Out” setting is set to “Both”, the “HDMI   
					Through” setting is only available for the HDMI OUT MAIN   
					jack. (➔ pages 57, 70)   
					If you cannot operate it, you will need to enter the   
					appropriate remote control code. (➔ page 76)   
					To control another manufacturer’s component, point the   
					remote controller at that component. (➔ page 76)   
					En-84   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Appendix   
					If you still can’t control your iPod/iPhone, start playback by   
					pressing your iPod/iPhone model’s Play button. Remote   
					operation should then be possible.   
					Place the AV receiver away from the devices emitting   
					To control an Onkyo component that’s connected via u,   
					point the remote controller at the AV receiver. Be sure to   
					enter the appropriate remote control code first.   
					(➔ page 77)   
					electromagnetic waves on the 2.4 GHz band (microwave   
					ovens, game consoles, etc.). If this does not solve the   
					problem, stop using other devices which emit   
					electromagnetic waves.   
					Try resetting your iPod/iPhone.   
					To control an Onkyo component that’s not connected via   
					u, point the remote controller at the component. Be sure   
					to enter the appropriate remote control code first.   
					(➔ page 77)   
					Depending on your iPod/iPhone, some buttons may not   
					work as expected.   
					When other wireless LAN devices are used near the AV   
					receiver, several issues such as interrupted playback and   
					communication may occur. You can avoid these issues by   
					changing the channel of your Wi-Fi router. For instructions   
					on changing channels, see the instruction manual provided   
					with your Wi-Fi router.   
					■ The AV receiver unexpectedly selects my   
					iPod/iPhone as the input source   
					Always pause iPod/iPhone playback before selecting a   
					
					Change function may select your iPod/iPhone as the input   
					source by mistake during the transition between tracks.   
					The entered remote control code may not be correct. If   
					more than one code is listed, try each one.   
					If there is a metallic object near the AV receiver, wireless   
					LAN connection may not be possible as the metal can   
					effect on the radio wave.   
					RI Dock for iPod/iPhone   
					■ iPod/iPhone doesn’t work properly   
					Try reconnecting your iPod/iPhone.   
					■ There’s no sound   
					Make sure your iPod/iPhone is actually playing.   
					If there is more than one access point in the network,   
					
					Make sure your iPod/iPhone is properly inserted in the   
					Dock.   
					It is recommended to place the Wi-Fi router (access point)   
					and the AV receiver in the same room.   
					Zone 2/3   
					Make sure the AV receiver is turned on, the correct input   
					source is selected, and the volume is turned up.   
					■ There’s no sound   
					Audio can be output only when analog, NET or USB input   
					source is selected in Zone 2/3.   
					Bluetooth   
					Make sure the plugs are pushed in all the way.   
					Try resetting your iPod/iPhone.   
					■ Music playback is unavailable on the AV   
					receiver even after successful Bluetooth   
					connection.   
					Depending on the characteristics or specifications of your   
					Bluetooth-enabled device, playback on the AV receiver is   
					not guaranteed.   
					■ The Zone 2 speakers produce no sound   
					Powered Zone 2 cannot be used if “Speakers Type   
					(Front)” is set to “Bi-Amp”. (➔ page 59)   
					■ There’s no video   
					Make sure that your iPod/iPhone model’s TV OUT setting   
					is set to On.   
					Make sure the correct input is selected on your TV or the   
					AV receiver.   
					Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN) Network   
					■ The audio quality is poor after connection with a   
					Bluetooth-enabled device.   
					The Bluetooth reception is poor. Move the Bluetooth-   
					enabled device closer to the AV receiver or remove any   
					obstacle between the Bluetooth-enabled device and the AV   
					receiver.   
					Some versions of the iPod/iPhone do not output video.   
					■ Cannot access to Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN) network   
					or Sound playback is interrupted and   
					communication doesn’t work   
					The setting of SSID and encryption (WEP, etc.) is not   
					correct. Make the same settings for network and the AV   
					receiver.   
					■ The AV receiver’s remote controller doesn’t   
					control my iPod/iPhone   
					Make sure your iPod/iPhone is properly inserted in the   
					Dock. If your iPod/iPhone is in a case, it may not connect   
					properly to the Dock. Always remove your iPod/iPhone   
					from the case before inserting it into the Dock.   
					■ Cannot connect with the AV receiver.   
					The Bluetooth-enabled device does not support the profiles   
					required for the AV receiver.   
					Cannot receive radio wave due to a bad connection.   
					Shorten the distance from wireless LAN access point or   
					remove obstacles for a good visibility, and try again. Place   
					the AV receiver away from microwave ovens or other   
					access points.   
					The iPod/iPhone cannot be operated while it’s displaying   
					the Apple logo.   
					The Bluetooth function of the Bluetooth-enabled device is   
					not enabled. Refer to the user manual of the Bluetooth-   
					enabled device for how to enable the function.   
					Make sure you’ve selected the right remote mode.   
					(➔ page 81)   
					2.4 GHz band for wireless LAN may not be enough.   
					Connect the ETHERNET port and router with the Ethernet   
					cable after selecting “Wired” in “Network Connection”   
					setting in “Network”. (➔ pages 16, 72)   
					When you use the AV receiver’s remote controller, point it   
					toward your AV receiver.   
					En-85   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					■ Bluetooth connection cannot be built   
					■ Can’t connect to the AV receiver from a Web   
					■ The sound changes when I connect my   
					browser   
					headphones   
					When building a Bluetooth connection between the AV   
					receiver and your Bluetooth-enabled device for the first   
					time, if the connection is fail, you need to power off your   
					Bluetooth-enabled device and power on again to clear the   
					device name, and build the connection again.   
					If you’re using DHCP, your router may not always allocate   
					the same IP address to the AV receiver, so if you find that   
					you can’t connect to a server or Internet radio station,   
					
					screen. (➔ page 72)   
					When a pair of headphones is connected, the listening   
					mode is set to Stereo, unless it’s already set to Stereo,   
					Mono, Direct, or Pure Audio (European, Australian and   
					Asian models).   
					If there is metallic object near the AV receiver, Bluetooth   
					connection may not be possible as the metal can effect on   
					the radio wave.   
					■ The speaker distance cannot be set as required   
					The values entered may be automatically adjusted with   
					values best-suited for your home theater.   
					Check the “Network” settings. (➔ page 72)   
					If the wireless LAN and Bluetooth connections are used at   
					the same time, try to connect the ETHERNET port and   
					router with the Ethernet cable after selecting “Wired” in   
					“Network Connection” setting in “Network” for a better   
					connection. (➔ pages 16, 72)   
					USB Device Playback   
					■ The display doesn’t work   
					The display is turned off when the Pure Audio (European,   
					Australian and Asian models) listening mode is selected.   
					■ Can’t access the music files on a USB device   
					Make sure the USB device is plugged in properly.   
					The AV receiver supports USB devices that support the   
					USB mass storage device class. However, playback may   
					
					conform to the USB mass storage device class.   
					(➔ page 94)   
					■ How do I change the language of a multiplex   
					source   
					Use the “Multiplex” setting in the “Audio Adjust” menu to   
					select “Main” or “Sub”. (➔ page 62)   
					Music Server and Internet Radio   
					
					Certain network service or contents available through this   
					device may not be accessible in case the service provider   
					terminates its service.   
					Depending on the type of format, the playback from a USB   
					device may not be performed normally. Check the type of   
					the file formats that is supported. (➔ page 95)   
					■ The ufunctions don’t work   
					To use u, you must make an uconnection and an   
					analog audio connection (RCA) between the component   
					and AV receiver, even if they are connected digitally.   
					(➔ page 20)   
					Check the network connection between the AV receiver   
					and your router or switch. (➔ page 16)   
					USB memory devices with security functions cannot be   
					played.   
					Make sure that your modem and router are properly   
					connected, and make sure they are both turned on.   
					While Zone 2/3 is selected, the ufunctions don’t work.   
					(➔ page 20)   
					Others   
					Make sure the server is up and running and compatible   
					with the AV receiver. (➔ page 94)   
					■ The functions System On/Auto Power On and   
					Direct Change don’t work for components   
					connected via u   
					■ Standby power consumption   
					Check the “Network”settings. (➔ page 72)   
					In the following cases, the power consumption in standby   
					mode may reach up to a maximum of 8.6 W:   
					–The “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” setting is set to “On”.   
					(Depending on the TV status, the AV receiver will enter   
					
					–The “HDMI Through” setting is set to other than “Off”.   
					–The “Network Standby” setting is set to “On”.   
					
					■ Playback stops while listening to music files on   
					the server   
					Make sure your server is compatible with the AV receiver.   
					(➔ page 94)   
					These functions don’t work when Zone 2/3 is turned on.   
					(➔ page 20)   
					■ When performing “Automatic Speaker Setup”,   
					the measurement fails and the message   
					“Ambient noise is too high.” is displayed.   
					If you download or copy large files on your computer,   
					playback may be interrupted. Try closing any unused   
					programs, use a more powerful computer, or use a   
					dedicated server.   
					This can be caused by a malfunction in your speaker unit.   
					Check if the unit produces normal sounds.   
					If an MHL-enabled mobile device connected to the AUX   
					(front) input is charged, the power consumption in standby   
					mode will increase than the figure above. (➔ page 16)   
					If the server is serving large music files to several   
					
					become overloaded and playback may be interrupted.   
					Reduce the number of playback devices on the network,   
					upgrade your network, or use a switch instead of a hub.   
					■ The following settings can be made for the   
					composite video inputs   
					You must use the buttons on the unit to make these   
					settings.   
					En-86   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Appendix   
					• We assume no responsibility whatsoever for any   
					error or damage of network environment or access   
					device resulting from the use of this apparatus.   
					Confirm with the provider or access device maker   
					for more information.   
					On the AV receiver, press the input selector for the   
					input source that you want to set and the HOME   
					button simultaneously. While holding down the   
					input selector button, press HOME until “Video   
					ATT :On” appears on the AV receiver’s display.   
					Then, release both buttons. To turn the setting off,   
					repeat the above process so that “Video ATT :Off”   
					appears on the AV receiver’s display, and release   
					the buttons.   
					• Video Attenuation   
					This setting can be made for the BD/DVD,   
					CBL/SAT, STB/DVR or GAME input.   
					If you have a game console connected to the   
					composite video input, and the picture isn’t very   
					clear, you can attenuate the gain.   
					Radio Wave Caution   
					The AV receiver uses a 2.4 GHz radio wave   
					frequency, which is a band used by other wireless   
					systems as 1 and 2 described below.   
					1. Devices which use a 2.4 GHz radio wave   
					frequency   
					Scope of Operation   
					• Cordless phones   
					• Cordless facsimiles   
					• Microwave ovens   
					• Wireless LAN devices (IEEE802.11b/g/n)   
					• Wireless AV equipment   
					• Wireless controllers for game systems   
					• Microwave oven-based health aids   
					• Video transmitter   
					• Specific type of external monitor and LCD   
					display   
					Use of the AV receiver is limited to home use.   
					(Transmission distances may be reduced depending   
					on communication environment.)   
					In the following locations, poor condition or   
					inability to receive radio waves may cause the   
					audio to be interrupted or stopped:   
					
					iron framed buildings.   
					• Near large metallic furniture.   
					• In a crowd of people or near a building or obstacle.   
					• In a location exposed to the magnetic field, static   
					electricity or radio wave interference from radio   
					communication equipment using the same   
					frequency band (2.4 GHz) as the AV receiver, such   
					as a 2.4 GHz wireless LAN device   
					Video ATT :Off: (default).   
					Video ATT :On: Gain is reduced by 2 dB.   
					■ If the picture on your TV/monitor connected to   
					the HDMI output(s) is unstable, try switching the   
					DeepColor function off   
					2. Less common devices which use a 2.4 GHz   
					radio wave frequency   
					• Anti-theft systems   
					• Amateur radio stations (HAM)   
					• Warehouse logistic management systems   
					• Discrimination systems for train or emergency   
					vehicles   
					To turn off the DeepColor function, simultaneously   
					press the STB/DVR and 8ON/STANDBY buttons   
					on the AV receiver. While holding down STB/DVR,   
					press 8ON/STANDBY until “Deep Color:Off”   
					appears on the AV receiver’s display. Then, release   
					both buttons. To reactivate the DeepColor function,   
					repeat the above process until “Deep Color:On”   
					appears on the AV receiver’s display and release   
					the buttons.   
					(IEEE802.11b/g/n) or microwave oven.   
					• If you live in a heavily populated residential area   
					(apartment, townhouse, etc.) and if your neighbor’s   
					microwave oven is placed near your AV receiver,   
					you may experience radio wave interference. If this   
					occurs, move your AV receiver to a different place.   
					When the microwave oven is not in use, there will be   
					no radio wave interference.   
					If these devices and the AV receiver are used at the   
					same time, the audio may be undesirably stopped or   
					disturbed due to a radio wave interference.   
					Suggestions for improvement   
					• Switch off the devices which emit the radio   
					wave.   
					• Place the interfering devices away from the AV   
					receiver.   
					• The AV receiver uses radio wave, and a third   
					person can receive the wave on purpose or   
					accidentally. Do not use the communication for   
					important or fatal matters.   
					En-87   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Appendix   
					■ Electronic device which requires cautions   
					Hearing aid, pace maker, other medical electronic   
					devices, fire alarm, automatic door, and other   
					automatic control device.   
					When using a pace maker or other medical electronic   
					devices, confirm with the medical electronic device   
					maker or dealer for the effect of the radio wave.   
					Radio Wave Reflections   
					The radio waves received by the AV receiver include   
					the radio wave coming directly from the devices and   
					waves coming from various directions due to   
					reflections by walls, furniture and building (reflected   
					waves). The reflected waves (due to obstacles and   
					reflecting objects) further produce a variety of   
					reflected waves as well as variation in reception   
					condition depending on locations. If the audio cannot   
					be received properly due to this phenomenon, try   
					moving the location of the wireless LAN device a little.   
					Also note that audio may be interrupted due to the   
					reflected waves when a person crosses or   
					The AV receiver contains a microcomputer for   
					signal processing and control functions. In very rare   
					situations, severe interference, noise from an   
					external source, or static electricity may cause it to   
					lockup. In the unlikely event that this happens,   
					unplug the power cord from the wall outlet, wait at   
					least five seconds, and then plug it back in.   
					approaches the space between the AV receiver and   
					the wireless LAN device.   
					• We assume no responsibility whatsoever for any   
					damages resulting from the use of this apparatus   
					except in the cases deemed acceptable under the   
					applicable laws and regulations.   
					• Operation in all environment is not guaranteed for   
					wireless LAN. The communication may not be   
					possible or have desirable communication speed.   
					Onkyo is not responsible for damages (such as CD   
					rental fees) due to unsuccessful recordings caused   
					by the unit’s malfunction. Before you record   
					important data, make sure that the material will be   
					recorded correctly.   
					Before disconnecting the power cord from the wall   
					outlet, set the AV receiver to standby.   
					Precautions   
					• Do not use this apparatus near an electronic device   
					handling high-accuracy controls or weak signals.   
					Doing so may cause an accident due to a   
					malfunction of the device.   
					• Do not use this apparatus in use prohibited location   
					such as an aircraft equipment or a hospital. Doing   
					so may cause an accident due to a malfunction of   
					an electronic device or an electro-medical   
					apparatus. Follow the instructions of the medical   
					facilities.   
					En-88   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Appendix   
					DISCLAIMER   
					Video Resolution Chart   
					
					control of any company which has designed, manufactured or distributed/have distributed this   
					device, and its affiliates (collectively, “Company”). We have no control over the nature, content   
					and availability of those services. The inclusion of any links does not necessarily imply a   
					
					All information, content and services available through this device belong to third parties and   
					are protected by copyright, patent, trademark and/or other intellectual property laws of   
					applicable countries. The information, content and services provided through this device are   
					for your personal, noncommercial use only. Any information, content or services may not be   
					used in any manner other than previously approved by the appropriate content owner or   
					service provider.   
					You may not modify, copy, republish, translate, exploit, create derivative works, upload, post,   
					transmit, sell or distribute in any manner any information, content or services available   
					through this device, unless expressly permitted by the appropriate copyright, patent,   
					trademark and/or other intellectual property owner, including, without limitation, content owner   
					or service provider.   
					The following tables show how video signals at different resolutions are output by   
					the AV receiver.   
					✔: Output available   
					HDMI   
					4K*1   
					Output   
					1080p/24   
					1080p   
					1080i   
					720p   
					480p/576p   
					480i/576i   
					Input   
					HDMI   
					*3   
					4K*2   
					✔ 
					
					1080p/24   
					1080p   
					1080i   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					
					*3   
					✔ 
					*3   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					*3   
					✔ 
					720p   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					*3   
					✔ 
					480p/576p   
					480i/576i   
					1080p   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					*3   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					Component   
					Composite   
					1080i   
					720p   
					480p/576p   
					480i/576i   
					480i/576i   
					*3   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					*3   
					✔ 
					THE CONTENT AND SERVICES AVAILABLE THROUGH THIS DEVICE ARE PROVIDED   
					“AS IS”. COMPANY DOES NOT WARRANT INFORMATION, CONTENT OR SERVICES SO   
					PROVIDED, EITHER EXPRESSLY OR IMPLIEDLY, FOR ANY PURPOSE.   
					COMPANY EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,   
					INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO, WARRANTIES OF TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT,   
					MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.   
					Component   
					1080p   
					Composite   
					480i/576i   
					Output   
					s 
					1080i   
					720p   
					480p/576p   
					480i/576i   
					Input   
					HDMI   
					4K*2   
					1080p/24   
					1080p   
					1080i   
					720p   
					Company makes no representation or warranty of any kind, express or implied, about the   
					completeness, accuracy, validity, legality, reliability, suitability or availability with respect to   
					the information, content or services available through this device. Company shall not be liable,   
					whether in contract or tort, including negligence and strict liability, for any direct, indirect,   
					special, incidental or consequential damages or any other damages arising out of, or in   
					connection with, any information contained in, or as a result of the use of any content or   
					service by you or any third party, even if Company has been advised of the possibility of such   
					damages, nor shall Company be liable for any third party claims against users of this device   
					or any third party.   
					In no event shall Company be responsible nor liable for, without limiting the generality of the   
					foregoing, any interruption or suspension of any information, content or service available   
					through this device. Company is neither responsible nor liable for customer service related to   
					the information, content and services available through this device.   
					480p/576p   
					480i/576i   
					1080p   
					Component   
					Composite   
					✔ 
					1080i   
					✔ 
					720p   
					✔ 
					480p/576p   
					480i/576i   
					480i/576i   
					✔ 
					✔ 
					✔ 
					*1   
					*2   
					Supported resolutions: [3840 × 2160 30 Hz], [3840 × 2160 25 Hz], [3840 × 2160 24 Hz],   
					[4096 × 2160 24 Hz]   
					The AV receiver is compatible with HDMI IN 1 to HDMI IN 4. However, the number of the   
					player that outputs video signal at 4K resolution or the same level at the same time may   
					be up to three.   
					*3   
					Supported resolutions for HDMI OUT SUB.   
					Any question or request for service relating to the information, content or services should be   
					made directly to the appropriate content owners and services providers.   
					En-89   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					Before Starting   
					Limitation of liability   
					The program and accompanying online   
					Firmware Update   
					• Set the “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” setting to “Off”   
					(➔ page 69).   
					• Turn off the controller device connected via network.   
					• Turn off Multi Zone if this function is present.   
					• Stop playback of contents from Internet Radio, USB   
					or servers, etc.   
					To update the firmware of the AV receiver, you can   
					choose from the following two methods: update via   
					network, or update via USB storage. Choose the one   
					that best suits your environment. Before proceeding   
					with the update, please read the corresponding   
					explanations carefully.   
					documentation are furnished to you for use at your   
					own risk. Onkyo will not be liable and you will have   
					no remedy for damages for any claim of any kind   
					whatsoever concerning your use of the program or   
					the accompanying online documentation,   
					regardless of legal theory, and whether arising in   
					tort or contract. In no event will Onkyo be liable to   
					you or any third party for any special, indirect,   
					incidental, or consequential damages of any kind,   
					including, but not limited to, compensation,   
					reimbursement or damages on account of the loss   
					of present or prospective profits, loss of data, or for   
					any other reason whatsoever.   
					■ Update via network   
					You need a Internet connection to update the   
					firmware.   
					Update Procedure   
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME on the   
					remote controller.   
					1 
					■ Update via USB storage (➔ page 91)   
					Please prepare a USB storage device such as a   
					USB flash memory stick. You need at least 32 MB   
					of available space to update the firmware.   
					The Home menu appears on the TV screen.   
					Select “Firmware Update” and press ENTER.   
					2 
					Note that the “Firmware Update” option will be   
					grayed out for a short while after the AV receiver   
					is turned on. Please wait until it becomes   
					operable.   
					See the Onkyo web site for latest information.   
					Note   
					• Check the network connection before updating.   
					• Do not touch any cable or device connected to the AV   
					receiver during the update process.   
					• Do not attempt to access the AV receiver from your PC   
					while it is being updated.   
					• Do not shutdown the power of the AV receiver while it is   
					being updated.   
					• The storage media in the USB card reader may not work.   
					• If the USB device is partitioned, each section will be treated   
					as an independent device.   
					• If the USB device contains a lot of data, the AV receiver   
					may take a while to read it.   
					
					includes the ability to power them.   
					• Onkyo takes no responsibility whatsoever for the loss or   
					damage of data resulting from the use of a USB device with   
					the AV receiver. Onkyo recommends that you back up your   
					important music files beforehand.   
					• If you connect a USB hard disk drive to the USB port,   
					Onkyo recommends that you use its AC adapter to power it.   
					• USB hubs and USB devices with hub functions are not   
					supported. Do not connect your USB device via a USB hub.   
					• USB devices with security functions are not supported.   
					Updating the Firmware via Network   
					Select “Update via NET” and press ENTER.   
					The AV receiver allows you to update the firmware using   
					network connection.   
					3 
					Note that this option will not be available if there   
					is no firmware file newer than the currently   
					installed version. If the AV receiver is not   
					connected to the internet, “Update via NET” is   
					not displayed.   
					Note   
					• Make sure your AV receiver and TV are turned on and the   
					AV receiver is connected to the Internet.   
					• Never unplug or turn off the AV receiver while it is being   
					updated.   
					• Never plug or unplug an HDMI or Ethernet cable during the   
					update process.   
					• Do not attempt to access the AV receiver from your PC   
					while it is being updated.   
					• Never unplug the power cord during the update process.   
					• It takes up to 20 minutes to complete the firmware update.   
					• The AV receiver will retain all your settings after the update   
					is finished.   
					Select “Update” and press ENTER.   
					The update process will begin.   
					4 
					During the update process, the on-screen display   
					may disappear depending on the updated   
					program. When this occurs, you can still view the   
					update progress on the AV receiver’s display.   
					The on-screen display will reappear after the   
					update is complete, and upon turning the AV   
					receiver off and on again.   
					The message “Completed!” appears on the AV   
					receiver’s display, indicating that the update   
					has been completed.   
					5 
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-90   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					Case 2:   
					Troubleshooting   
					Press 8ON/STANDBY on the front panel.   
					6 
					If an error occurs during the update process,   
					disconnect then reconnect the AC power cord and try   
					again.   
					The AV receiver will enter standby mode.   
					Case 1:   
					Do not use 8RECEIVER on the remote   
					If an error occurs, “Error!! *-**” is displayed on the AV   
					receiver’s display. (Alpha-numeric characters on the   
					front display are denoted by asterisks.) Refer to the   
					following table and take appropriate action.   
					controller.   
					The AV receiver will enter standby mode   
					automatically in 3 minutes regardless of whether   
					8ON/STANDBY is pressed.   
					Case 3:   
					If you do not have an Internet connection to the   
					network, please contact Onkyo Support.   
					■ Errors during an update via network   
					Congratulations! You now have the latest   
					firmware installed on your Onkyo AV receiver.   
					Error Code   
					Description   
					Updating the Firmware via USB   
					*-01, *-10   
					The Ethernet cable was not detected.   
					Reconnect the cable properly.   
					The AV receiver allows you to update the firmware   
					using a USB device.   
					*-02, *-03,   
					*-04, *-05,   
					*-06, *-11,   
					*-13, *-14,   
					*-16, *-17,   
					*-18, *-20,   
					*-21   
					Internet connection error.   
					Check the following items:   
					• Make sure the IP address, subnet mask,   
					gateway address, and DNS server are   
					configured properly.   
					• Make sure the router is turned on.   
					• Make sure the AV receiver and the router   
					are connected with an Ethernet cable.   
					• Make sure your router is configured   
					properly. See the instruction manual of   
					the router.   
					Note   
					• Never unplug or turn off the AV receiver during the update   
					process.   
					• Never plug or unplug an HDMI cable or a USB device   
					during the update process.   
					• Never unplug the USB storage device containing the   
					firmware file or the AC power cord during the update   
					process.   
					• Do not attempt to access the AV receiver from your PC   
					while it is being updated.   
					• If your network allows only one client   
					connection and there is any other device   
					already connected, the AV receiver will   
					not be able to access the network.   
					Consult your Internet Service Provider   
					(ISP).   
					• If your modem does not function as a   
					router, you will need a router. Depending   
					on your network, you may need to   
					configure the proxy server if necessary.   
					See the document provided by your ISP.   
					If you are still unable to access the   
					Internet, the DNS or proxy server may be   
					temporarily down. Contact your ISP.   
					• It takes up to 20 minutes to complete the firmware update.   
					• The AV receiver will retain all your settings after the update   
					is finished.   
					Before Starting   
					• Set the “HDMI CEC (RIHD)” setting to “Off”   
					(➔ page 69).   
					• Turn off the controller device connected via network.   
					• Turn off Multi Zone if this function is present.   
					• Stop playback of contents from Internet Radio, USB   
					or servers, etc.   
					Others   
					Retry the update procedure from the   
					beginning. If the error persists, please   
					contact Onkyo Support and provide the   
					error code.   
					• If there is any data in the USB device, remove it first.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-91   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					Update Procedure   
					Troubleshooting   
					Case 1:   
					If an error occurs, “Error!! *-**” is displayed on the AV   
					receiver’s display. (Alpha-numeric characters on the   
					front display are denoted by asterisks.) Refer to the   
					following table and take appropriate action.   
					Select “Update” and press ENTER.   
					The update process will begin.   
					10   
					During the update process, the on-screen display   
					may disappear depending on the updated   
					program. When this occurs, you can still view the   
					update progress on the AV receiver’s display.   
					The on-screen display will reappear after the   
					update is complete, and upon turning the AV   
					receiver off and on again.   
					Do not turn off the AV receiver and do not   
					remove the USB device during the update   
					process.   
					Connect a USB device to your PC. If there is   
					any data in the USB device, remove it first.   
					1 
					Download the firmware file from the Onkyo   
					web site. The file name is as follows:   
					2 
					ONKAVR****_************.zip   
					
					Unzip the downloaded file. The numbers of   
					folders and files differ according to the model.   
					Error Code   
					Description   
					*-01, *-10   
					The USB device was not detected. Make   
					sure the USB flash memory or USB cable is   
					properly connected to the USB port. If the   
					USB storage device has its own power   
					supply, use it to power the USB device.   
					Copy all the extracted folders including all   
					folders and files to the root folder of the USB   
					device. Be careful not to copy the zip file.   
					3 
					The message “Completed!” appears on the AV   
					receiver’s display, indicating that the update   
					has been completed.   
					11   
					12   
					Remove the USB device from your PC and   
					connect it to the USB port on the AV receiver.   
					
					*-20, *-21   
					The firmware file was not found in the root   
					folder of the USB device, or the firmware   
					file is for another model. Retry and   
					download the file on the support page of   
					the web site, following the on-site   
					instructions. If the error persists, please   
					contact Onkyo Support and provide the   
					error code.   
					4 
					Remove the USB device.   
					Make sure the AV receiver and TV are turned   
					on.   
					5 
					Press 8ON/STANDBY on the front panel.   
					The AV receiver will enter standby mode.   
					If the AV receiver is in standby mode, press   
					8ON/STANDBY on the AV receiver to light up   
					the front display.   
					Do not use 8RECEIVER on the remote   
					controller.   
					Others   
					Retry the update procedure from the   
					beginning. If the error persists, please   
					contact Onkyo Support and provide the   
					error code.   
					The AV receiver will enter standby mode   
					automatically in 3 minutes regardless of whether   
					8ON/STANDBY is pressed.   
					Select the USB input source.   
					6 
					“Now Initializing...” appears on the AV receiver’s   
					display and then the name of the USB device is   
					displayed. It takes 20 to 30 seconds to recognize   
					the USB device.   
					Congratulations! You now have the latest   
					firmware installed on your Onkyo AV receiver.   
					Case 2:   
					If an error occurs during the update process,   
					disconnect then reconnect the AC power cord and try   
					again.   
					Press RECEIVER followed by HOME on the   
					remote controller.   
					7 
					The Home menu appears on the TV screen.   
					Select “Firmware Update” and press ENTER.   
					8 
					Select “Update via USB” and press ENTER.   
					9 
					Note that this option will not be available if there   
					is no firmware file newer than the currently   
					installed version. If the AV receiver is not   
					connected to the internet, “Update via USB” is   
					not displayed.   
					Operating   
					procedure   
					(➔ page 56)   
					En-92   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Appendix   
					Supported Audio Formats   
					About Copyright Protection   
					About HDMI   
					• 2-channel linear PCM (32–192 kHz, 16/20/24 bit)   
					• Multichannel linear PCM (up to 7.1 ch, 32–192 kHz,   
					16/20/24 bit)   
					• Bitstream (DSD, Dolby Digital, Dolby Digital Plus,   
					Dolby TrueHD, DTS, DTS-HD High Resolution   
					Audio, DTS-HD Master Audio)   
					The AV receiver supports HDCP (High-bandwidth   
					Designed to meet the increased demands of digital   
					TV, HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface) is a   
					new digital interface standard for connecting TVs,   
					projectors, Blu-ray Disc/DVD players, set-top boxes,   
					and other video components. Until now, several   
					separate video and audio cables have been required   
					to connect AV components. With HDMI, a single   
					cable can carry control signals, digital video, and up   
					to eight channels of digital audio (2-channel PCM,   
					multichannel digital audio, and multichannel PCM).   
					The HDMI video stream (i.e., video signal) is   
					*2   
					Digital Content Protection) , a copy-protection   
					system for digital video signals. Other devices   
					connected to the AV receiver via HDMI must also   
					support HDCP.   
					Your Blu-ray Disc/DVD player must also support   
					HDMI output of the above audio formats.   
					*1   
					DVI (Digital Visual Interface): The digital display interface   
					standard set by the DDWG*3 in 1999.   
					HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection): The   
					*2   
					video encryption technology developed by Intel for   
					HDMI/DVI. It’s designed to protect video content and   
					requires a HDCP-compatible device to display the   
					encrypted video.   
					*1   
					compatible with DVI (Digital Visual Interface) , so   
					TVs and displays with a DVI input can be connected   
					by using an HDMI-to-DVI adapter cable. (This may   
					not work with some TVs and displays, resulting in no   
					picture.)   
					*3   
					DDWG (Digital Display Working Group): Lead by Intel,   
					Compaq, Fujitsu, Hewlett Packard, IBM, NEC, and   
					Silicon Image, this open industry group’s objective is to   
					address the industry’s requirements for a digital   
					connectivity specification for high-performance PCs and   
					digital displays.   
					The AV receiver uses HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital   
					*2   
					Content Protection) , so only HDCP-compatible   
					components can display the picture.   
					The AV receiver’s HDMI interface is based on the   
					following:   
					Note   
					• The HDMI video stream is compatible with DVI (Digital   
					Visual Interface), so TVs and displays with a DVI input can   
					be connected by using an HDMI-to-DVI adapter cable.   
					(Note that DVI connections only carry video, so you’ll need   
					to make a separate connection for audio.) However,   
					reliable operation with such an adapter is not guaranteed.   
					In addition, video signals from a PC are not supported.   
					• The HDMI audio signal (sampling rate, bit length, etc.) may   
					be restricted by the connected source component. If the   
					picture is poor or there’s no sound from a component   
					connected via HDMI, check its setup. Refer to the   
					
					Sync, 4K (up-scaling and Passthrough), DTS-HD   
					Master Audio, DTS-HD High Resolution Audio, Dolby   
					TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DSD and Multichannel   
					PCM.   
					connected component’s instruction manual for details.   
					En-93   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					modem, etc.). Please consult your ISP or computer   
					dealer if you’re unsure.   
					The setting varies depending on the media server or   
					controller devices. Refer to your devices’ instruction   
					manual for details.   
					If the operating system of your personal computer is   
					Windows 8/Windows 7, Windows Media Player 12 is   
					already installed. For more information, see the   
					Microsoft web site.   
					Network/USB Features   
					Note   
					Network Requirements   
					• To receive Internet radio with the AV receiver, your   
					broadband Internet connection must be working and able to   
					access the Web. Consult your ISP if you have any problems   
					with your Internet connection.   
					• The AV receiver uses DHCP to configure its network   
					settings automatically. If you want to configure these   
					settings manually, see “Network” (➔ page 72).   
					• The AV receiver does not support PPPoE settings, so if you   
					have a PPPoE-type Internet connection, you must use a   
					PPPoE-compatible router.   
					■ Ethernet Network   
					For the best results, a 100Base-TX switched Ethernet   
					network is recommended. Although it’s possible to   
					
					network wirelessly, playback may be unreliable, so it   
					is recommended to use wired connections.   
					USB Device Requirements   
					• USB mass storage device class (but not always   
					guaranteed).   
					■ Ethernet Router   
					• FAT16 or FAT32 file system format.   
					• If the storage device has been partitioned, each   
					section will be treated as an independent device.   
					• Up to 20,000 folders can be displayed, and folders   
					may be nested up to 16 levels deep.   
					• USB hubs and USB devices with hub functions are   
					not supported.   
					A router manages the network, data-routing and   
					supplying of IP addresses. Your router must support   
					the following:   
					• Depending on your ISP, you may need to specify a proxy   
					server to use Internet radio. If your computer is configured   
					to use a proxy server, use the same settings for the AV   
					receiver (➔ page 72).   
					
					several networked computers to access the Internet   
					simultaneously via a single Internet connection. The   
					AV receiver needs Internet access for Internet radio.   
					• DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol).   
					DHCP supplies IP addresses to the network   
					devices, allowing them to configure themselves   
					automatically.   
					Server Requirements   
					■ Server playback   
					Note   
					The AV receiver can play digital music files stored on   
					a computer or media server and supports the   
					following technologies:   
					• Windows Media Player 11   
					• Windows Media Player 12   
					• If the media you connect is not supported, the message “No   
					Storage” will be displayed.   
					• If you connect a USB hard disk drive to the AV receiver’s   
					USB port, we recommend that you use its AC adapter to   
					power it.   
					• A router with a built-in 100Base-TX switch is   
					recommended.   
					• The AV receiver supports USB MP3 players that support   
					the USB Mass Storage Class standard, which allows USB   
					devices to be connected to computers without the need for   
					special drivers or software. Note that not all USB MP3   
					players support the USB Mass Storage Class standard.   
					Refer to your USB MP3 player’s instruction manual for   
					details.   
					• Protected WMA music files on an MP3 player cannot be   
					played.   
					• Onkyo accepts no responsibility whatsoever for the loss or   
					damage to data stored on a USB device when that device   
					is used with the AV receiver. We recommend that you back   
					up your important music files beforehand.   
					Some routers have a built-in modem, and some   
					Internet Service Providers (ISP) require you to use   
					specific routers. Please consult your ISP or computer   
					dealer if you’re unsure.   
					• DLNA-certified media server   
					• The computer or media server must be on the same   
					network as the AV receiver.   
					• Up to 20,000 folders can be displayed, and folders   
					may be nested up to 16 levels deep.   
					■ CAT5 Ethernet cable   
					Use a shielded CAT5 Ethernet cable (straight-type) to   
					connect the AV receiver to your home network.   
					Note   
					• Depending on the media server, the AV receiver may not   
					recognize it, or may not be able to play its music files.   
					■ Internet Access (for Internet radio)   
					■ Remote playback   
					To receive Internet radio, your Ethernet network must   
					have Internet access. A narrowband Internet   
					connection (e.g., 56K modem, ISDN) will not provide   
					satisfactory results, so a broadband connection is   
					strongly recommended (e.g., cable modem, xDSL   
					• Windows Media Player 12   
					• DLNA-certified (within DLNA Interoperability   
					Guidelines version 1.5) media server or controller   
					device.   
					• MP3 players containing music files that are managed with   
					special music software are not supported.   
					En-94   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					• Operation is not guaranteed for all USB devices, which   
					includes the ability to power them.   
					• Do not connect your USB device via a USB hub. The USB   
					device must be connected directly to the AV receiver’s USB   
					port.   
					• If the USB device contains a lot of data, the AV receiver   
					make take a while to read it.   
					• USB devices with security functions cannot be played.   
					■ WMA Lossless (.wma or .WMA)   
					• Sampling rates of 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 88.2 kHz,   
					96 kHz are supported.   
					■ LPCM (Linear PCM)   
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz and 96 kHz are   
					supported.   
					• Quantization bit: 16 bit, 24 bit   
					■ WAV (.wav or .WAV)   
					• Quantization bit: 8 bit, 16 bit, 24 bit   
					WAV files contain uncompressed PCM digital audio.   
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz, 96 kHz, 176.4 kHz and   
					192 kHz are supported.   
					* 
					Only for playback via network.   
					
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz and 96 kHz are   
					supported.   
					Supported Audio File Formats   
					For server playback and playback from a USB device,   
					the AV receiver supports the following music file   
					formats.   
					Variable bit-rate (VBR) files are supported. However,   
					playback times may not display correctly.   
					• Quantization bit: 8 bit, 16 bit, 24 bit   
					* 
					For playback from a USB device, sampling rates of   
					• Quantization bit: 16 bit, 24 bit   
					176.4 kHz and 192 kHz are not supported.   
					■ AAC   
					
					(.aac/.m4a/.mp4/.3gp/.3g2/.AAC/.M4A/.MP4/   
					.3GP or .3G2)   
					• The sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz is supported.   
					Note   
					• With remote playback, the AV receiver does not support the   
					following music file formats: FLAC, Ogg Vorbis, DSD and   
					Dolby TrueHD.   
					• In the case of server playback, the above-mentioned file   
					formats may not be played depending on the server type.   
					■ Dolby TrueHD (.vr/.mlp/.VR/.MLP)   
					• Sampling rates of 48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz,   
					96 kHz, 176.4 kHz and 192 kHz are supported.   
					AAC stands for MPEG-2/MPEG-4 Audio.   
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz, 96 kHz and bitrates of   
					between 8 kbps and 320 kbps are supported.   
					* 
					For playback from a USB device, sampling rates only of   
					48 kHz and 64 kHz are supported.   
					■ MP3 (.mp3 or .MP3)   
					• MP3 files must be MPEG-1/MPEG-2 Audio Layer 3   
					format with sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz,   
					12 kHz, 16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz,   
					44.1 kHz, 48 kHz and bitrates of between 8 kbps   
					and 320 kbps. Incompatible files cannot be played.   
					■ FLAC (.flac or .FLAC)   
					FLAC is a file format for lossless audio data   
					compression.   
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz, 96 kHz, 176.4 kHz and   
					192 kHz are supported.   
					About DLNA   
					The Digital Living Network Alliance is an international,   
					cross-industry collaboration. Members of DLNA   
					develop a concept of wired and wireless interoperable   
					networks where digital content such as photos,   
					music, and videos can be shared through consumer   
					electronics, personal computers, and mobile devices   
					in and beyond the home. The AV receiver complies   
					with the DLNA Interoperability Guidelines version 1.5.   
					■ WMA (.wma or .WMA)   
					WMA stands for Windows Media Audio and is an   
					audio compression technology developed by   
					Microsoft Corporation. Audio can be encoded in WMA   
					• Quantization bit: 8 bit, 16 bit, 24 bit   
					■ Ogg Vorbis (.ogg or .OGG)   
					® 
					format by using Windows Media Player.   
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz and bitrates of between 48 kbps and   
					500 kbps are supported. Incompatible files cannot   
					be played.   
					• WMA files must have the copyright option turned off.   
					• Sampling rates of 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz,   
					16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz, 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,   
					48 kHz, bitrates of between 5 kbps and 320 kbps,   
					and WMA DRM are supported.   
					• WMA Pro/Voice formats are not supported.   
					En-95   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					Windows and the Windows logo are trademarks of the   
					Microsoft group of companies.   
					License and Trademark   
					Information   
					THX and the THX logo are trademarks of THX Ltd. which   
					may be registered in some jurisdictions. All rights reserved.   
					Qdeo and QuietVideo are trademarks of Marvell or its   
					affiliates.   
					“x.v.Color” is a trademark of Sony Corporation.   
					THX Select2 Plus   
					Re-Equalization and the “Re-EQ” logo are trademarks of   
					THX Ltd.   
					Before any home theater component can be THX Select2   
					Plus certified, it must pass a rigorous series of quality and   
					performance tests. Only then can a product feature the   
					THX Select2 Plus logo, which is your guarantee that the   
					Home Theater products you purchase will give you superb   
					performance for many years to come. THX Select2 Plus   
					requirements define hundreds of parameters, including   
					power amplifier performance, and pre-amplifier   
					performance and operation for both digital and analog   
					domains. THX Select2 Plus receivers also feature   
					proprietary THX technologies (e.g., THX Mode) which   
					accurately translate movie soundtracks for home theater   
					playback.   
					Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent Nos:   
					5,956,674; 5,974,380; 6,226,616; 6,487,535; 7,212,872;   
					7,333,929; 7,392,195; 7,272,567 & other U.S. and   
					worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS-HD, the Symbol,   
					& DTS-HD and the Symbol together are registered   
					trademarks & DTS-HD Master Audio is a trademark of   
					DTS, Inc. Product includes software. © DTS, Inc. All Rights   
					Reserved.   
					“MHL, the MHL Logo, and Mobile High-Definition Link are   
					trademarks or registered trademarks of MHL LLC in the   
					United States and other counties.”   
					Apple, iPod and iPhone are trademarks of Apple Inc.,   
					registered in the U.S. and other countries.   
					Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.   
					Dolby, Pro Logic, Surround EX and the double-D symbol   
					are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.   
					The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED Logo is a certification mark of the   
					Wi-Fi Alliance.   
					Apple TV is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the   
					U.S. and other countries.   
					Wi-Fi certified logo shows international association   
					certifying interoperability “Wi-Fi Alliance” ensures the   
					product has passed the test for compatibility with other   
					Wi-Fi certified equipment.   
					Music Optimizer™ and “WRAT” are trademarks of Onkyo   
					Corporation.   
					Manufactured under license from   
					Audyssey Laboratories™,Inc. U.S. and foreign patents   
					pending. Audyssey MultEQ®, Audyssey Dynamic EQ®,   
					Audyssey Dynamic Volume® and Audyssey DSX® are   
					registered trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories,Inc.   
					“The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia   
					Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered   
					trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States   
					and other countries.”   
					The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered   
					trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of   
					such marks by Onkyo is under license. Other trademarks   
					and trade names are those of their respective owners.   
					“DLNA®, the DLNA Logo and DLNA CERTIFIED® are   
					trademarks, service marks, or certification marks of the   
					Digital Living Network Alliance.”   
					Onkyo does not guarantee Bluetooth compatibility between   
					the AV receiver and all Bluetooth-enabled devices.   
					For compatibility between the AV receiver and another   
					device with Bluetooth technology, consult the device’s   
					documentation and dealer. In some countries, there may   
					be restrictions on using Bluetooth devices. Check with your   
					local authorities.   
					MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from   
					Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson.   
					This product is protected by certain intellectual property   
					rights of Microsoft. Use or distribution of such technology   
					outside of this product is prohibited without a license from   
					Microsoft.   
					InstaPrevue and the InstaPrevue logo are trademarks or   
					registered trademarks of Silicon Image, Inc. in the United   
					States and other countries.   
					En-96   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					Video Section   
					Frequency band   
					2.4 GHz band (2.4000 GHz -   
					2.4835 GHz)   
					FHSS (Freq Hopping Spread Spectrum)   
					Specifications   
					Amplifier Section   
					Modulation method   
					Compatible Bluetooth profiles   
					Input Sensitivity/Output Level and Impedance   
					1 Vp-p/75 Ω (Component Y)   
					0.7 Vp-p/75 Ω (Component PB/CB,   
					PR/CR)   
					A2DP 1.2 (Advanced Audio Distribution   
					Profile)   
					AVRCP 1.3 (Audio Video Remote   
					Control Profile)   
					SBC   
					Rated Output Power   
					All channels:   
					1 Vp-p/75 Ω (Composite)   
					110 watts minimum continuous power   
					Component Video Frequency Response   
					5 Hz - 100 MHz/+0 dB, –3 dB   
					per channel, 8 ohm loads, 2 channels   
					driven from 20 Hz to 20 kHz, with a   
					maximum total harmonic distortion of   
					0.08% (FTC)   
					125 watts minimum continuous power   
					per channel, 6 ohm loads, 2 channels   
					driven at 1 kHz, with a maximum total   
					harmonic distortion of 0.7% (FTC)   
					(North American)   
					Supported Codecs   
					Transmission range (A2DP)   
					20 Hz - 20,000 Hz (Sampling frequency   
					44.1 kHz)   
					Tuner Section   
					FM Tuning Frequency Range   
					*1   
					The actual range will vary depending on factors such as   
					obstacles between devices, magnetic fields around a   
					microwave oven, static electricity, cordless phone,   
					reception sensitivity, antenna’s performance, operating   
					system, software application, etc.   
					87.5 MHz - 107.9 MHz (North American   
					and Taiwanese)   
					87.5 MHz - 108.0 MHz, RDS (Others)   
					7 ch × 170 W at 6 ohms, 1 kHz, 1 ch   
					driven of 1% (IEC)   
					(Others)   
					AM Tuning Frequency Range   
					522/530 kHz - 1611/1710 kHz   
					Preset Channel   
					Maximum Effective Output Power   
					7 ch × 185 W at 6 ohms, 1 kHz, 1 ch   
					40   
					General   
					driven (JEITA)   
					(Asian)   
					Network Section   
					Power Supply   
					AC 120 V, 60 Hz   
					(North American and Taiwanese)   
					AC 220 - 240 V, 50/60 Hz (Others)   
					* 
					Dynamic Power   
					* 
					IEC60268-Short-term maximum output power   
					Ethernet LAN   
					Wireless LAN   
					Compatible standards:   
					10BASE-T/100BASE-TX   
					250 W (3 Ω, Front)   
					220 W (4 Ω, Front)   
					130 W (8 Ω, Front)   
					Power Consumption 6.9 A (North American and Taiwanese)   
					690 W (Others)   
					No-sound Power Consumption   
					® 
					IEEE 802.11 b/g/n standard (Wi-Fi   
					standard)   
					WEP 64 bit, WEP 128 bit, WPA/WPA2-   
					PSK (AES), WPA/WPA2-PSK (TKIP)   
					THD+N (Total Harmonic Distortion+Noise)   
					80 W (North American and Taiwanese)   
					0.08% (20 Hz - 20 kHz, half power)   
					60 (Front, 1 kHz, 8 Ω)   
					Security:   
					75 W (230 V)   
					80 W (240 V)   
					(Others)   
					Damping Factor   
					Input Sensitivity and Impedance (Unbalance)   
					Transmission frequency   
					200 mV/47 kΩ (LINE)   
					Stand-by Power Consumption   
					1 - 11 ch (North American and   
					Taiwanese)   
					2.5 mV/47 kΩ (PHONO MM)   
					0.1 W (North American and Taiwanese)   
					0.2 W (Others)   
					Dimensions (W × H × D)   
					10 - 13 ch (France)   
					1 - 13 ch (Others)   
					Rated RCA Output Level and Impedance   
					200 mV/2.2 kΩ (LINE OUT)   
					Maximum RCA Output Level and Impedance   
					2 V/2.2 kΩ (LINE OUT)   
					70 mV (MM 1 kHz 0.5% Direct)   
					Frequency Response 5 Hz - 100 kHz/+1 dB, –3 dB (Direct   
					mode)   
					® 
					(Wi-Fi standard)   
					435 mm × 175 mm × 380 mm   
					17-1/8" × 6-7/8" × 14-15/16"   
					Radio frequency   
					2.4 GHz   
					Weight   
					11.2 kg (24.7 lbs.)   
					Phono Overload   
					Bluetooth Section   
					Communication system   
					Tone Control Characteristics   
					Bluetooth Specification version 2.1 +   
					EDR (Enhanced Data Rate)   
					Maximum communication range   
					10 dB, 30 Hz (BASS)   
					10 dB, 20 kHz (TREBLE)   
					Signal to Noise Ratio 106 dB (LINE, IHF-A)   
					80 dB (PHONO MM, IHF-A)   
					*1   
					Line of sight approx. 15 m   
					Speaker Impedance 4 Ω - 16 Ω   
					En-97   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Appendix   
					■ HDMI   
					Input   
					IN 1, IN 2, IN 3, IN 4, IN 5, IN 6, IN 7,   
					AUX INPUT   
					Output   
					Video Resolution   
					Audio Format   
					OUT MAIN, OUT SUB   
					4K   
					Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD Master Audio,   
					DVD-Audio, DSD   
					Supported   
					3D, Audio Return Channel, DeepColor,   
					x.v.Color, LipSync, CEC (RIHD), 4K (up-   
					scaling and Passthrough)   
					■ Video Inputs   
					Component   
					Composite   
					IN   
					BD/DVD, CBL/SAT, STB/DVR, GAME   
					■ Video Outputs   
					Component   
					Composite   
					OUT   
					MONITOR OUT   
					■ Audio Inputs   
					Digital   
					Optical: 1   
					Coaxial: 2   
					Analog   
					BD/DVD, CBL/SAT, STB/DVR, GAME,   
					PC, TV/CD, PHONO   
					■ Audio Outputs   
					Analog   
					Subwoofer Pre Outputs   
					ZONE2 LINE OUT, ZONE3 LINE OUT   
					2 
					Speaker Outputs   
					Main (L, R, C, SL, SR, SBL/FHL,   
					SBR/FHR) + ZONE2 (L, R)   
					Phones   
					1 (ø 6.3)   
					■ Others   
					Setup Mic   
					RI   
					1 
					1 
					USB   
					Ethernet   
					1 (Front)   
					1 
					Specifications and features are subject to change   
					without notice.   
					En-98   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				2-1, Nisshin-cho, Neyagawa-shi, OSAKA 572-8540, JAPAN   
					http://www.onkyo.com/   
					The Americas   
					18 Park Way, Upper Saddle River, N.J. 07458, U.S.A.   
					For Dealer, Service, Order and all other Business Inquiries:   
					Tel: 201-785-2600 Fax: 201-785-2650   
					http://www.us.onkyo.com/   
					For Product Support Team Only:   
					1-800-229-1687   
					http://www.us.onkyo.com/   
					Europe   
					Liegnitzerstrasse 6, 82194 Groebenzell, GERMANY   
					Tel: +49-8142-4401-0 Fax: +49-8142-4208-213   
					http://www.eu.onkyo.com/   
					Unit 19, Building 6, Croxley Green Business Park, Hatters Lane, Watford, WD18 8YH, UK   
					Tel: +44 (0)8712-00-19-96 Fax: +44 (0)8712-00-19-95   
					China   
					(Hong Kong)   
					Unit 1033, 10/F, Star House, No 3, Salisbury Road, Tsim Sha Tsui Kowloon, Hong Kong.   
					Tel: 852-2429-3118 Fax: 852-2428-9039   
					http://www.hk.onkyo.com/   
					(Mainland)   
					1301, 555 Tower, No.555 West NanJing Road, Jing’an District, Shanghai, China 200041,   
					Tel: 86-21-52131366 Fax: 86-21-52130396   
					http://www.cn.onkyo.com/   
					Asia, Oceania, Middle East, Africa   
					Please contact an Onkyo distributor referring to Onkyo SUPPORT site.   
					http://www.intl.onkyo.com/support/   
					The above-mentioned information is subject to change without prior notice.   
					Visit the Onkyo web site for the latest update.   
					Y1303-3   
					SN 29401427EN-B   
					(C) Copyright 2013 Onkyo Corporation Japan. All rights reserved.   
					* 2 9 4 0 1 4 2 7 E N - B *   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Using Internet Radio   
					Using Multiple Accounts   
					® 
					Using Internet Radio   
					Pandora internet radio   
					The AV receiver supports multiple user accounts,   
					which means you can freely switch between several   
					logins. After registering user accounts, login is   
					performed from the “Users” screen.   
					–Getting Started (U.S. only)..................... 2   
					Common Procedures in Internet Radio   
					Menu   
					Using Rhapsody (U.S. only).......................... 3   
					Note   
					Press MENU while the Users screen is   
					displayed.   
					The following menu items appear:   
					Add new user:   
					Remove this user:   
					1 
					• Available services may vary depending on the region.   
					• Certain network service or contents available through this   
					device may not be accessible in case the service provider   
					terminates its service.   
					Using the SiriusXM Internet Radio   
					(North American only)..............................4   
					You can either store a new user account, or   
					delete an existing one.   
					Press NET.   
					1 
					
					Using Slacker Personal Radio...................... 6   
					Using MP3tunes............................................. 7   
					A list of the network services appears, and the   
					NET indicator lights. If it flashes, verify that the   
					Ethernet cable is firmly connected to the AV   
					receiver.   
					Tip   
					• Some of the services don’t allow the use of multiple user   
					accounts.   
					• You can store up to 10 user accounts.   
					• To switch between accounts you must first log out from the   
					current account, and log in again on the “Users” screen.   
					Select the desired service and press ENTER.   
					The top page of the selected service appears.   
					2 
					En-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					 
				Using Internet Radio   
					Delete this station:   
					Pandora® internet radio   
					–Getting Started (U.S. only)   
					To play a station, use q/wto select the station   
					from your station list, and then press ENTER.   
					Playback starts and the playback screen   
					appears.   
					2 
					This will permanently delete a station from your   
					Pandora account. All of your thumbs feedback   
					will be lost should you choose to re-create the   
					station with the same track or artist.   
					Create station from this track:   
					Creates a radio station from this track.   
					Rename this station:   
					Lets you rename the current radio station.   
					Bookmark this artist:   
					Pandora will bookmark your favorite artist for   
					your profile on www.pandora.com.   
					Bookmark this track:   
					Pandora will bookmark the current track and   
					allow you to buy them all from Amazon or iTunes   
					in one step!   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Adds a station to My Favorites list.   
					Pandora is a free, personalized Internet radio service   
					that plays the music you know and helps you discover   
					music you’ll love.   
					Create a New Station:   
					Enter the name of a track, artist, or genre and   
					Pandora will create a unique radio station for you   
					based on the musical qualities of that track, artist,   
					or genre.   
					Use q/wto select “I have a Pandora Account”   
					1 
					or “I’m new to Pandora” and then press   
					ENTER.   
					■ Menu Items   
					I like this track:   
					Give a track “thumbs-up” and Pandora will play   
					more music like it.   
					I don’t like this track:   
					Give a track “thumbs-down” and Pandora will ban   
					that track from the current station.   
					Why is this track playing?:   
					Discover some of the musical attributes that   
					Pandora uses to create your personal radio   
					stations.   
					If you are new to Pandora select “I’m new to   
					Pandora”. You will see an activation code on   
					your TV screen. Please write down this code. Go   
					to an Internet connected computer and point your   
					browser to www.pandora.com/onkyo   
					Enter your activation code and then follow the   
					instructions to create your Pandora account and   
					your personalized Pandora Internet radio   
					stations. You can create your stations by entering   
					your favorite tracks and artists when prompted.   
					After you have created your account and stations   
					you can return to your Onkyo receiver and press   
					enter to begin listening to your personalized   
					Pandora Internet radio.   
					I’m tired of this track:   
					PANDORA, the PANDORA logo, and the Pandora   
					trade dress are trademarks or registered trademarks   
					of Pandora Media, Inc. Used with permission.   
					
					sleep and Pandora will not play it for one month.   
					Create station from this artist:   
					Creates a radio station from this artist.   
					If you have an existing Pandora account, you can   
					add your Pandora account to your Onkyo   
					receiver by selecting “I have a Pandora   
					Account” and logging in with your email and   
					password.   
					Tip   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					En-2   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Using Internet Radio   
					Use q/wto select the menu, then press   
					ENTER.   
					Use q/wto select a channel, and press ENTER   
					or 1to start playback.   
					Using Rhapsody (U.S. only)   
					2 
					3 
					Use q/wto select “Sign in to your account”   
					Search:   
					Playback starts and the playback screen   
					appears.   
					You can control the tracks with the buttons on the   
					remote control.   
					1 
					and then press ENTER.   
					You can search for music by Artist, Album, or   
					Track.   
					To use Rhapsody, you need an account. If you   
					don’t have one yet, you can create a new   
					account at   
					Music Guide:   
					You can play tracks from Genres, Top Artists,   
					Top Albums, Top Tracks, New Releases, and   
					Staff Picks.   
					Enabled buttons: 1, 3, 2, 5, 4, 7,   
					www.rhapsody.com/onkyo   
					6, RANDOM, REPEAT   
					If you have an existing Rhapsody account, select   
					“Sign in to your account” and press ENTER.   
					Enter your user name (usually your email) and   
					password in the next keyboard screen, or in Web   
					Setup.   
					Note   
					Rhapsody Channels:   
					• On Rhapsody Channels, some of the buttons don’t   
					work.   
					Listen to radio channels programmed by   
					Rhapsody’s top-notch editors.   
					Playlists:   
					■ Menu Items   
					Add track to My Library:   
					Bookmark currently-playing tracks.   
					Add album to My Library:   
					Bookmark currently-playing albums.   
					Add playlist to My Library:   
					Bookmark currently-playing playlists.   
					Add channel to My Channels:   
					Bookmark currently-playing Rhapsody radio   
					channels.   
					Play your own personal playlists.   
					My Library:   
					Bookmark your favorite albums and tracks from   
					the Rhapsody catalog using My Library.   
					Account Info:   
					Confirm your account information.   
					Sign Out:   
					Sign out from your Rhapsody account.   
					■ Using the keyboard screen   
					1. Use q/w/e/rand ENTER to enter your user   
					name and password.   
					2. Select “OK”.   
					3. Press ENTER. The “Confirm your entries”   
					screen appears.   
					4. Press ENTER.   
					Tip   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Adds a track, channel or playlist to My Favorites   
					list.   
					Tip   
					• You can remove bookmarked tracks, albums, and   
					Rhapsody Channels from My Library.   
					En-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Using Internet Radio   
					Use q/wto select “Sign In”, and then press   
					ENTER.   
					Use q/wto select the desired channel and then   
					press ENTER.   
					Using the SiriusXM Internet Radio   
					(North American only)   
					1 
					3 
					If you have an existing SIRIUS account, you can   
					sign in by selecting “Sign In”. Enter your user   
					name and password in the next keyboard screen,   
					or in Web Setup. If you don’t know your   
					username or password, call Sirius XM at (888)   
					539-7474 for assistance.   
					The playback screen for the selected channel   
					appears and you can listen to SiriusXM Internet   
					Radio.   
					Your Onkyo AV receiver includes a free trial of   
					SiriusXM Internet Radio. The “Account Info” screen   
					shows how many days are left in your trial. After the   
					trial period expires, if you want to continue listening to   
					the service, you must subscribe. To subscribe go to   
					www.siriusxm.com/internetradio with your   
					computer.   
					You can control the tracks with the buttons on the   
					remote control.   
					Enabled buttons: 2, 3, 7, 6   
					Tip   
					■ Menu Items   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Adds a channel to My Favorites list.   
					When you subscribe, you will be provided with a   
					username and password which has to be entered into   
					the AV receiver.   
					■ Using the keyboard screen   
					1. Use q/w/e/rand ENTER to enter your user   
					name and password.   
					2. Select “OK”.   
					3. Press ENTER. The “Confirm your entries”   
					screen appears.   
					
					AV receiver connected to the Internet. Using the   
					remote control, follow these steps:   
					SiriusXM Internet Radio subscriptions are sold   
					separately and are governed by the Sirius Terms and   
					Conditions (see www.sirius.com). Be sure to read this   
					agreement before you purchase your subscription.   
					Sirius, XM and all related marks and logos are   
					trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and its   
					subsidiaries. All rights reserved.   
					4. Press ENTER.   
					“Please wait...” appears and then “SiriusXM   
					Internet Radio” screen appears which displays   
					the category available for selection.   
					Use q/wto select the category and then press   
					2 
					ENTER.   
					The channel list screen for the selected category   
					appears.   
					En-4   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Using Internet Radio   
					Profile:   
					Use q/wto select “Sign in to your account”,   
					and then press ENTER.   
					Using Last.fm Internet Radio   
					1 
					You can play tracks from “Recently Listened   
					Tracks”, “Library” and “Neighbours”.   
					Account Info:   
					Confirm your account information.   
					Sign Out:   
					Last.fm is a music service that learns what you   
					love...   
					If you have the existing Last.fm account, you can   
					sign in to your account to select “Sign in to your   
					account”. Enter your user name and password in   
					the next keyboard screen.   
					Your new Onkyo AV receiver is very clever. If you   
					have a free Last.fm account, it will keep track of all   
					the songs you’ve just played. When you visit the   
					Last.fm website, you can see personal charts of the   
					music you’ve enjoyed, share them with friends and   
					see what they like, too.   
					It signs out from your account.   
					■ Using the keyboard screen   
					Use q/wto select a station, and press ENTER   
					1. Use q/w/e/rand the ENTER to enter your   
					user name and password.   
					2. Select “OK”.   
					
					or 1 to start playback.   
					Playback starts and the playback screen   
					appears.   
					3. Press ENTER. The “Confirm your entries”   
					screen appears.   
					With thousands of biographies, reviews and an   
					endless choice of personalised, ad-free radio   
					stations, Last.fm is a great way to discover music.   
					Pick up your free Last.fm account today at   
					www.last.fm/join   
					■ Menu Items   
					I Love this track:   
					4. Press ENTER.   
					“Please wait...” appears and then “Last.fm   
					Internet Radio” screen appears.   
					Track information is saved in Last.fm server, and   
					playback frequency increases.   
					Ban this track:   
					Track information is saved in Last.fm server, and   
					playback frequency reduces.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Tip   
					Get a subscription and you can enjoy the best of ad-   
					free Last.fm Radio on your Onkyo AV receiver without   
					a computer!   
					Recommended Radio:   
					Discover smart personalised recommendations that   
					adapt as your tastes change.   
					Artist Radio:   
					Pick any artist and we’ll play you a whole station of   
					music inspired by your choice.   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					Use q/wto select menu and then press   
					ENTER.   
					Adds a station to My Favorites list.   
					2 
					■ Using scrobbling control   
					Search Station:   
					You can search station by Artist, Tag, or User   
					Name.   
					Use q/wto select “Enable”, and then press ENTER.   
					* 
					Internet radio services provided by a third party may be   
					terminated with or without notice.   
					Top Artists Station:   
					You can play tracks of top-rated artists.   
					Top Tags Station:   
					You can play tracks of top-rated tags.   
					Personal Station:   
					• You can play tracks from personalized station   
					(“Your Library”, “Your Neighbourhood” and   
					“Your Recommendations”).   
					My Library:   
					Internet radio services may not be available in some areas.   
					Sit back and enjoy selections from all the music   
					you’ve heard since you joined Last.fm.   
					Tag Radio:   
					Polish funk? Death pop? Think of a style and we’ll   
					entertain you with it for hours.   
					Start your free trial straight away when you create   
					your account and see for yourself what it’s like to   
					have the world’s music at your fingertips. Latest   
					prices and full information are available at   
					www.last.fm/subscribe   
					En-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Using Internet Radio   
					You can control the tracks with the buttons on   
					the remote control.   
					Using Slacker Personal Radio   
					6 
					If you do not have an account, create one on   
					the Slacker website (www.slacker.com) with   
					your computer.   
					Enabled buttons: 1, 3, 2, 6   
					Stores information to server, making it more likely   
					that the song will be played again.   
					Ban Song:   
					Stores information to server, making it less likely   
					that the song will be played again.   
					Ban Artist:   
					Stores information to server, making it less likely   
					that the songs from this artist will be played   
					again.   
					Mark Favorite:   
					Adds the currently playing station to your   
					favorites.   
					Unmark Favorite:   
					Deletes the currently playing station from your   
					favorites.   
					1 
					■ Menu Items   
					Rate Song as Favorite:   
					If you already have a Slacker account, select   
					“Sign in to your account” and then press   
					ENTER.   
					The keyboard screen appears. You can enter   
					information from the remote control or the keys   
					on the main unit.   
					If there are no mistakes in the information you   
					have entered, use q/w/e/rto select “OK”   
					then press ENTER.   
					2 
					3 
					An account information confirmation screen   
					appears.   
					If you do not have an account, select “Access   
					without Sign In” and press ENTER to use a   
					restricted version of the service.   
					Note that use will be restricted.   
					Add song to Library:   
					Tip   
					Adds the currently playing track to your library.   
					Delete song from Library:   
					Deletes the currently playing track from your   
					library.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Adds a station or song to My Favorites list.   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					
					4 
					5 
					ENTER.   
					To sign out, use q/wto select “Sign out” from   
					this screen and then press ENTER.   
					Use q/wto select a station and then press   
					ENTER or 1to start playback from the   
					station.   
					The playback screen appears.   
					En-6   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Using Internet Radio   
					Playing Contents on the AV Receiver   
					The track at the top of the music list is automatically   
					played back.   
					Using MP3tunes   
					Tip   
					Listen to your music collection on your home stereo in   
					complete digital fidelity without a personal computer   
					plus safely backup all your songs. Here’s how:   
					Use q/wto select a track and press ENTER or   
					5 
					• Before proceeding, you need to select the MP3tunes   
					service as described in “Common Procedures in Internet   
					Radio Menu” (➔ page 1).   
					1to start playback.   
					A playback screen appears.   
					You can control the tracks with the buttons on the   
					remote control.   
					Creating an Account on your Computer   
					Use q/wto select “Sign in to your account”,   
					1 
					and then press ENTER.   
					Enabled buttons: 1, 3, 2, 7, 6   
					From your computer, open a web browser and   
					go to: www.mp3tunes.com/signup   
					1 
					Enter the e-mail address and password you   
					used when creating your account, select “OK”   
					and press ENTER.   
					■ Menu Items   
					2 
					Go to Menu:   
					Create an account.   
					2 
					3 
					Displays additional menu options.   
					The keyboard screen appears. You can enter   
					your user name and password from the remote   
					controller or the buttons on the AV receiver.   
					Click the Upload link   
					(www.mp3tunes.com/upload) to add files to   
					your Locker.   
					You can view or change your MP3tunes   
					account settings by going to   
					www.mp3tunes.com/account.   
					
					If there are no mistakes in the information you   
					3 
					View, edit and listen to your files by clicking   
					on Player (www.mp3tunes.com/player).   
					4 
					have entered, select “OK” and press ENTER.   
					An account information confirmation screen   
					appears.   
					Tip   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					Use q/wto select the menu, then press   
					4 
					ENTER.   
					Music:   
					The place to find your Artists, Albums, and   
					Playlists.   
					Shuffle:   
					Starts playing a random selection of tracks from   
					your Locker.   
					Search:   
					Find a specific Album, Artist, or Song.   
					Account Info:   
					Your MP3tunes account information.   
					Sign Out:   
					Log out of your MP3tunes account.   
					En-7   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Utilisation d’une webradio   
					Utilisation de plusieurs comptes   
					® 
					Pandora internet Radio   
					Utilisation d’une   
					webradio   
					L’ampli-tuner AV prend en charge plusieurs comptes   
					utilisateur, ce qui signifie que vous pouvez librement   
					commuter entre plusieurs connexions. Après avoir   
					enregistré des comptes utilisateur, l’identification est   
					réalisée à partir de l’écran « Users ».   
					–Pour commencer   
					(États-Unis uniquement).......................... 2   
					Utilisation de Rhapsody   
					Procédures courantes dans le menu de   
					webradio   
					(Etats-Unis uniquement).......................... 3   
					Appuyez sur MENU lorsque l’écran Users est   
					affiché.   
					1 
					Remarque   
					Utilisation de SiriusXM Internet Radio   
					(Amérique du Nord uniquement) ............ 4   
					Les éléments de menu suivants s’affichent :   
					Add new user :   
					• Les services disponibles peuvent varier en fonction de la   
					région.   
					• Certain services réseau ou contenus disponible via cet   
					appareil peuvent être inaccessibles au cas où le prestataire   
					de services terminerait son service.   
					Remove this user :   
					Vous pouvez soit stocker un nouveau compte   
					utilisateur, soit en supprimer un existant.   
					Utilisation de la webradio Last.fm................5   
					Utilisation de Slacker Personal Radio ......... 6   
					Appuyez sur NET.   
					1 
					Conseil   
					Une liste des services réseau s’affiche, et le   
					témoin NET s’allume. S’il clignote, vérifiez que le   
					câble Ethernet est fermement branché sur   
					l’ampli-tuner AV.   
					• Certains des services ne permettent pas l’utilisation de   
					plusieurs comptes utilisateur.   
					• Vous pouvez stocker jusqu’à 10 comptes utilisateur.   
					• Pour commuter entre les comptes, vous devez d’abord   
					vous déconnecter du compte actuel, puis vous reconnectez   
					depuis l’écran « Users ».   
					Sélectionnez le service désiré et appuyez sur   
					ENTER.   
					2 
					La page principale du service sélectionné   
					s’affiche.   
					Fr-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Utilisation d’une webradio   
					Delete this station :   
					Pandora® internet Radio   
					–Pour commencer (États-Unis   
					uniquement)   
					Pour lire une station, utilisez q/wpour   
					sélectionner la station dans votre liste de   
					stations, puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					2 
					Ceci supprimera de façon permanente la station   
					de votre compte Pandora. Au cas où vous   
					décideriez de récréer la station avec les mêmes   
					pistes ou les mêmes artistes, tous vos   
					acceptations/rejets précédents seront perdus.   
					Create station from this track :   
					Permet de créer une station radio à partir de   
					cette piste.   
					La lecture débute et l’écran de lecture s’affiche.   
					Create a New Station :   
					Pandora est un service de radio en ligne libre et   
					personnalisé vous permettant de lire la musique que   
					vous connaissez et de découvrir celle que vous   
					aimez.   
					Saisissez le nom d’une piste, d’un artiste ou d’un   
					genre et Pandora créera une station radio unique   
					pour vous en fonction des qualités musicales de   
					la piste, de l’artiste ou du genre choisi.   
					Rename this station :   
					Vous permet de renommer la station radio   
					actuelle.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner « I have a   
					1 
					■ Eléments du menu   
					I like this track :   
					Acceptez la piste et Pandora lira d’autres   
					musiques similaires.   
					I don’t like this track :   
					Rejetez la piste et Pandora éliminera cette piste   
					de la station écoutée.   
					Why is this track playing? :   
					Découvrez certains des attributs musicaux que   
					Pandora utilise pour créer vos stations radio   
					personnelles.   
					Pandora Account » ou « I’m new to Pandora »,   
					puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Si vous ne connaissez pas Pandora sélectionnez   
					« I’m new to Pandora ». Un code d’activation   
					apparaîtra sur l’écran de votre téléviseur. Notez   
					ce code. Utilisez un ordinateur branché sur   
					Internet et connectez le navigateur à   
					Bookmark this artist :   
					Pandora marquera votre artiste préféré pour   
					votre profil sur www.pandora.com.   
					Bookmark this track :   
					Pandora marquera la piste en cours et vous   
					permettra de toutes les acheter sur Amazon ou   
					iTunes en une étape !   
					Add to My Favorites :   
					Permet d’ajouter une station à la liste My   
					Favorites.   
					www.pandora.com/onkyo   
					Saisissez votre code d’activation puis suivez les   
					instructions pour créer votre compte Pandora et   
					vos stations webradio Pandora personnalisées.   
					Lorsque vous y êtes invités, vous pouvez créer   
					vos stations en saisissant vos pistes et vos   
					artistes préférés. Après la création de votre   
					compte et de vos stations, vous pouvez retourner   
					à votre récepteur Onkyo et appuyez sur entrée   
					pour écouter votre webradio Pandora   
					I’m tired of this track :   
					Si vous en avez assez d’une piste, vous pouvez   
					mettre la piste « au repos » et Pandora ne la lira   
					plus pendant un mois.   
					Create station from this artist :   
					Permet de créer une station radio à partir de cet   
					artiste.   
					PANDORA, le logo PANDORA, et l’habillage   
					commercial Pandora sont des marques   
					commerciales ou des marques déposées de la   
					société Pandora Media, Inc. Utilisées avec   
					autorisation.   
					personnalisée.   
					Si vous disposez d’un compte Pandora, vous   
					pouvez ajouter votre compte Pandora à votre   
					récepteur Onkyo en sélectionnant « I have a   
					Pandora Account » et y accéder en entrant   
					votre adresse e-mail et votre mot de passe.   
					Conseil   
					• Si vous souhaitez utiliser plusieurs comptes   
					utilisateur, consultez « Utilisation de plusieurs   
					comptes » (➔ page 1). L’identification peut être   
					réalisée à partir de l’écran « Users ».   
					Fr-2   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Utilisation d’une webradio   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner le menu, puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner un canal, puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER ou 1pour démarrer la   
					lecture.   
					Utilisation de Rhapsody (Etats-Unis   
					uniquement)   
					2 
					3 
					Search :   
					Vous pouvez rechercher des morceaux par   
					artiste, par album ou par piste.   
					Music Guide :   
					La lecture débute et l’écran de lecture s’affiche.   
					Vous pouvez contrôlez les pistes avec les   
					touches sur la télécommande.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner « Sign in to your   
					1 
					account », puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Vous devez posséder un compte pour utiliser   
					Rhapsody. Si vous ne disposez pas encore d’un   
					compte, vous pouvez en créer un à partir de   
					www.rhapsody.com/onkyo   
					Vous pouvez lire des pistes à partir des   
					genres,des meilleurs artistes, des meilleurs   
					albums, des meilleures pistes, des nouveautés et   
					des sélections du personnel.   
					Rhapsody Channels :   
					Écoutez les canaux de radio programmée par les   
					meilleurs éditeurs de Rhapsody.   
					Playlists :   
					Permet de jouer vos listes de lecture   
					personnelles.   
					My Library :   
					Marquez vos albums et vos pistes personnelles   
					dans le catalogue de Rhapsody à l’aide de My   
					Library.   
					Boutons activés : 1, 3, 2, 5, 4, 7,   
					6, RANDOM, REPEAT   
					Remarque   
					Si vous possédez déjà un compte Rhapsody,   
					sélectionnez « Sign in to your account », puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Saisissez votre nom utilisateur (en général votre   
					adresse électronique) et votre mot de passe dans   
					l’écran clavier suivant ou dans Configuration   
					Web.   
					• Sur les canaux Rhapsody, certaines touches ne   
					fonctionnent pas.   
					■ Eléments du menu   
					Add track to My Library :   
					Marquez les pistes en cours de lecture.   
					Add album to My Library :   
					Marquez les albums en cours de lecture.   
					Add playlist to My Library :   
					Marquez les listes de lecture en cours de lecture.   
					Add channel to My Channels :   
					Marquez les canaux de radio Rhapsody en cours   
					de lecture.   
					Add to My Favorites :   
					Permet d’ajouter une piste, un canal ou une liste   
					de lecture à la liste My Favorites.   
					■ Utilisation de l’écran clavier   
					1. Utilisez q/w/e/ret ENTER pour saisir votre   
					nom d’utilisateur et votre mot de passe.   
					2. Sélectionnez « OK ».   
					Account Info :   
					Vérifiez les informations de votre compte.   
					Sign Out :   
					3. Appuyez sur ENTER. L’écran « Confirm   
					your entries » s’affiche.   
					4. Appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Déconnectez-vous de votre compte Rhapsody.   
					Conseil   
					• Si vous souhaitez utiliser plusieurs comptes   
					utilisateur, consultez « Utilisation de plusieurs   
					comptes » (➔ page 1). L’identification peut être   
					réalisée à partir de l’écran « Users ».   
					Conseil   
					• Vous pouvez supprimer des pistes, des albums et des   
					canaux Rhapsody marqués de My Library.   
					Fr-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Utilisation d’une webradio   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner « Sign In », puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner le canal de   
					votre choix, puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					L’écran de lecture du canal sélectionné s’affiche   
					et vous pouvez écouter SiriusXM Internet Radio.   
					Vous pouvez contrôlez les pistes avec les   
					touches sur la télécommande.   
					Utilisation de SiriusXM Internet Radio   
					(Amérique du Nord uniquement)   
					1 
					3 
					Si vous possédez déjà un compte SIRIUS, vous   
					pouvez y accéder en sélectionnant « Sign In ».   
					Saisissez votre nom utilisateur et votre mot de   
					passe dans l’écran clavier suivant ou dans   
					Configuration Web. Si vous ne connaissez pas   
					votre nom d’utilisateur ou votre mot de passe,   
					appelez Sirius XM au (888) 539-7474 pour   
					obtenir une assistance.   
					Votre ampli-tuner AV Onkyo comprend un essai   
					gratuit de SiriusXM Internet Radio. L’écran « Account   
					Info » affiche le nombre de jours restants dans votre   
					
					souhaitez continuer à écouter le service, vous devez   
					vous abonner. Pour vous inscrire, accédez à   
					l’adresse   
					Boutons activés : 2, 3, 7, 6   
					■ Eléments du menu   
					Add to My Favorites :   
					www.siriusxm.com/internetradio à l’aide de votre   
					ordinateur.   
					Permet d’ajouter un canal à la liste My Favorites.   
					Conseil   
					• Si vous souhaitez utiliser plusieurs comptes   
					utilisateur, consultez « Utilisation de plusieurs   
					comptes » (➔ page 1). L’identification peut être   
					réalisée à partir de l’écran « Users ».   
					
					nom est un mot de passe utilisateur qui doivent être   
					saisis dans l’ampli-tuner AV.   
					Les abonnements SiriusXM Internet Radio sont   
					vendus séparément et sont subordonnés par les   
					conditions Sirius (voir www.sirius.com). Assurez-vous   
					de lire cet accord avant d’acquérir votre abonnement.   
					Sirius, XM et tous les logos et marques afférents sont   
					des marques déposées de Sirius XM Radio Inc. et de   
					ses filiales. Tous droits réservés.   
					■ Utilisation de l’écran clavier   
					1. Utilisez q/w/e/ret ENTER pour saisir votre   
					nom d’utilisateur et votre mot de passe.   
					2. Sélectionnez « OK ».   
					
					doit être connecté à Internet. Suivez les étapes ci-   
					dessous à l’aide de la télécommande :   
					3. Appuyez sur ENTER. L’écran « Confirm   
					your entries » s’affiche.   
					4. Appuyez sur ENTER.   
					« Please wait... » s’affiche, puis l’écran   
					« SiriusXM Internet Radio » affiche la catégorie   
					que vous pouvez sélectionner.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner la catégorie,   
					puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					2 
					L’écran de la liste des canaux de la catégorie   
					sélectionnée s’affiche.   
					Fr-4   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Utilisation d’une webradio   
					Profile :   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner « Sign in to   
					your account », puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Vous possédez déjà un compte Last.fm, vous   
					pouvez vous y connecter pour sélectionner   
					« Sign in to your account ». Saisissez votre   
					nom utilisateur et votre mot de passe dans   
					l’écran clavier suivant.   
					Utilisation de la webradio Last.fm   
					1 
					Vous pouvez lire des pistes de « Recently   
					Listened Tracks », « Library » et   
					« Neighbours ».   
					Account Info :   
					Vérifiez les informations de votre compte.   
					Sign Out :   
					Last.fm un service de musique qui apprend ce que   
					vous aimez…   
					Votre nouvel ampli-tuner AV Onkyo est très intelligent.   
					Si vous avez un compte Last.fm gratuit, il garde une   
					trace de toutes les chansons que vous avez juste   
					jouées. Quand vous vous rendez sur le site Web de   
					Last.fm, vous pouvez voir les graphiques personnels   
					de la musique que vous avez appréciée, les partagez   
					avec vos amis et également voir ce qu’ils aiment.   
					Pour vous déconnecter de votre compte.   
					■ Utilisation de l’écran clavier   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner une station, puis   
					1. Utilisez q/w/e/ret le bouton ENTER pour   
					saisir votre nom d’utilisateur et votre mot de   
					passe.   
					3 
					appuyez sur ENTER ou   
					lecture.   
					1 
					pour démarrer la   
					2. Sélectionnez « OK ».   
					La lecture débute et l’écran de lecture s’affiche.   
					Avec des milliers de biographies, de revues et un   
					choix infini de stations de radio personnalisées et   
					sans pub, Last.fm est excellent moyen de découvrir   
					de la musique. Créez aujourd’hui votre compte   
					Last.fm gratuit sur www.last.fm/join   
					3. Appuyez sur ENTER. L’écran « Confirm   
					your entries » s’affiche.   
					4. Appuyez sur ENTER.   
					« Please wait... » apparait puis l’écran « Last.fm   
					Internet Radio » apparait.   
					■ Eléments du menu   
					I Love this track :   
					L’information de la piste est sauvegardée dans le   
					serveur Last.fm, et la fréquence de lecture   
					augmente.   
					Inscrivez-vous et vous pourrez apprécier le meilleur   
					de la radio sans pub Last.fm sur votre ampli-tuner AV   
					Onkyo sans ordinateur !   
					Conseil   
					Ban this track :   
					• Si vous souhaitez utiliser plusieurs comptes   
					utilisateur, consultez « Utilisation de plusieurs   
					comptes » (➔ page 1). L’identification peut être   
					réalisée à partir de l’écran « Users ».   
					L’information de la piste est sauvegardée dans le   
					serveur Last.fm, et la fréquence de lecture   
					diminue.   
					Add to My Favorites :   
					Permet d’ajouter une station à la liste My   
					Favorites.   
					Recommended Radio :   
					Découvrez les recommandations personnalisées   
					futées qui changent en même temps que vos goûts.   
					Artist Radio :   
					Sélectionnez n’importe quel artiste et nous vous   
					jouerons une station entière de musique inspirée par   
					votre choix.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner un menu puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					2 
					Search Station :   
					■ Utilisation du contrôle Scrobbling   
					Vous pouvez rechercher une station par artiste,   
					par tag ou par nom d’utilisateur.   
					Top Artists Station :   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner « Enable », puis   
					My Library :   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Reposez-vous de retour et appréciez les sélections à   
					partir de toute la musique que vous avez entendue   
					depuis que vous avez joint Last.fm.   
					Tag Radio :   
					Funk polonaise ? Death pop ? Pensez à un style et   
					nous vous divertirons avec pendant des heures.   
					Vous pouvez lire des pistes des artistes les mieux   
					évalués.   
					Top Tags Station :   
					Vous pouvez lire des pistes des tags les mieux   
					évalués.   
					Personal Station :   
					* 
					Les services de webradio fournis par un tiers peuvent être   
					résiliés avec ou sans préavis.   
					Les services de webradio peuvent ne pas être accessibles   
					dans certaines zones.   
					Vous pouvez lire des pistes de votre station   
					personnalisée (« Your Library », « Your   
					Neighbourhood » et « Your   
					Recommendations »).   
					Commencez votre essai gratuit immédiatement à la   
					création votre compte et découvrez par vous-même   
					ce que cela fait d’avoir la musique du monde au bouts   
					des doigts. Les derniers prix et les informations   
					complètes sont disponibles sur www.last.fm/subscribe   
					Fr-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Utilisation d’une webradio   
					Vous pouvez contrôlez les pistes avec les   
					touches sur la télécommande.   
					Utilisation de Slacker Personal Radio   
					6 
					Si vous ne possédez pas de compte, créez-en   
					Boutons activés : 1, 3, 2, 6   
					1 
					un à partir du site Web de Slacker   
					(www.slacker.com) à l’aide de votre   
					ordinateur.   
					■ Eléments du menu   
					Rate Song as Favorite :   
					Permet de stocker des informations sur le   
					serveur, et d’augmenter la probabilité que le   
					morceau soit lu de nouveau.   
					Si vous possédez déjà un compte Slacker,   
					sélectionnez « Sign in to your account », puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					L’écran clavier s’affiche. Pouvez saisir des   
					informations à partir de la télécommande ou des   
					touches sur l’appareil principal.   
					Ban Song :   
					Permet de stocker des informations sur le   
					serveur, et de diminuer la probabilité que le   
					morceau soit lu de nouveau.   
					Si les informations que vous avez saisies ne   
					comportent pas d’erreur, utilisezq/w/e/r   
					pour sélectionner « OK », puis appuyez sur   
					ENTER.   
					Ban Artist :   
					2 
					3 
					Permet de stocker des informations sur le   
					serveur, et de diminuer la probabilité que les   
					morceaux de cet artiste soient lus de nouveau.   
					Mark Favorite :   
					Permet d’ajouter la station en cours de lecture à   
					vos favoris.   
					Unmark Favorite :   
					Permet de supprimer la station en cours de   
					lecture de vos favoris.   
					L’écran de confirmation des informations du   
					compte s’affiche.   
					Si vous ne possédez pas de compte,   
					sélectionnez « Access without Sign In », puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER pour utiliser une version   
					restreinte du service.   
					Veuillez noter que l’utilisation est restreinte.   
					Add song to Library :   
					Permet d’ajouter la piste en cours de lecture à   
					votre bibliothèque.   
					Delete song from Library :   
					
					de votre bibliothèque.   
					Conseil   
					• Si vous souhaitez utiliser plusieurs comptes   
					utilisateur, consultez « Utilisation de plusieurs   
					comptes » (➔ page 1). L’identification peut être   
					réalisée à partir de l’écran « Users ».   
					Add to My Favorites :   
					Permet d’ajouter une station ou un morceau à la   
					liste My Favorites.   
					Utilisez q/wpour sélectionner un élément du   
					4 
					5 
					menu, puis appuyez sur ENTER.   
					Pour vous déconnecter, utilisez q/wpour   
					sélectionner « Sign out » depuis cet écran, puis   
					appuyez sur ENTER.   
					
					
					la lecture depuis cette station.   
					L’écran de lecture apparaît.   
					Fr-6   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Uso de Internet Radio   
					Uso de múltiples cuentas   
					® 
					Uso de Internet Radio   
					Pandora Internet Radio   
					El receptor de AV permite múltiples cuentas de   
					usuario, lo que quiere decir que se puede cambiar   
					libremente entre varios usuarios. Después de   
					registrar las cuentas de usuario, el acceso se realiza   
					desde la pantalla “Users”.   
					–Primeros pasos (solo EE.UU.)............... 2   
					Procedimientos comunes en el menú   
					Internet Radio   
					Uso de Rhapsody (sólo EE.UU.)................... 3   
					Nota   
					Pulse MENU cuando aparezca la pantalla de   
					usuarios.   
					Aparecerán los siguientes elementos del menú:   
					Add new user:   
					Remove this user:   
					1 
					• Los servicios disponibles pueden variar de una región a   
					otra.   
					• Es posible que determinados servicios de red o contenidos   
					disponibles a través de este dispositivo no sean accesibles   
					si el proveedor del servicio da por finalizado el servicio.   
					Uso de SiriusXM Internet Radio   
					(solo Norteamérica).................................. 4   
					Puede guardar una nueva cuenta de usuario o   
					borrar una existente.   
					Uso de Last.fm Internet Radio...................... 5   
					Uso de Slacker Personal Radio.................... 6   
					Pulse NET.   
					1 
					Aparecerá una lista de los servicios de red y se   
					iluminará el indicador NET. Si parpadea,   
					verifique que el cable Ethernet esté firmemente   
					conectado al receptor de AV.   
					Consejo   
					• Algunos de los servicios no permiten el uso de múltiples   
					cuentas de usuario.   
					• Puede guardar hasta 10 cuentas de usuario.   
					• Para cambiar entre cuentas debe antes cerrar sesión en la   
					cuenta actual y acceder de nuevo en la pantalla “Users”.   
					Seleccione el servicio deseado y pulse   
					ENTER.   
					Aparecerá la página principal del servicio   
					seleccionado.   
					2 
					Es-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Uso de Internet Radio   
					Delete this station:   
					Pandora® Internet Radio   
					–Primeros pasos (solo EE.UU.)   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar la emisora en la   
					lista de emisoras y luego pulse ENTER.   
					Se inicia la reproducción y aparece la pantalla de   
					reproducción.   
					2 
					Esto eliminará de forma permanente una   
					emisora de su cuenta de Pandora. Toda la   
					información sobre sus aprobaciones/   
					desaprobaciones se perderá si quiere volver a   
					crear la emisora con el mismo tema o artista.   
					Create station from this track:   
					Crea una emisora de radio a partir de este tema.   
					Rename this station:   
					Le permite renombrar la emisora de radio actual.   
					Bookmark this artist:   
					Pandora marcará su artista favorito para su perfil   
					en www.pandora.com.   
					Bookmark this track:   
					Pandora marcará el tema actual y le permitirá   
					comprarlos todos en Amazon o iTunes ¡con un   
					solo paso!   
					Pandora es un servicio de radio por Internet gratuito y   
					personalizado que reproduce la música que usted   
					conoce y le ayudará a descubrir música que le   
					encantará.   
					Create a New Station:   
					Introduzca el nombre de un tema, artista o   
					género; Pandora creará una emisora de radio   
					exclusiva para usted basada en las cualidades   
					musicales de ese tema, de ese artista o de ese   
					género.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar “I have a Pandora   
					1 
					Account” o “I’m new to Pandora” y luego   
					pulse ENTER.   
					■ Elementos del menú   
					I like this track:   
					Si no conoce Pandora seleccione “I’m new to   
					Pandora”. Verá un código de activación en la   
					pantalla del televisor. Tome nota de este código.   
					Vaya a un ordenador conectado a Internet y dirija   
					el navegador a www.pandora.com/onkyo   
					Introduzca su código de activación y siga las   
					instrucciones para crear su cuenta de Pandora y   
					sus emisoras de radio por Internet   
					Si aprueba (pulgar arriba) un tema, Pandora   
					reproducirá más música parecida.   
					I don’t like this track:   
					Si no aprueba (pulgar abajo) el tema, Pandora   
					eliminará dicho tema de la emisora actual.   
					Why is this track playing?:   
					Descubra algunos de los atributos musicales que   
					Pandora utiliza para crear sus emisoras de radio   
					personalizadas.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Añade una emisora a la lista Mis favoritos.   
					personalizadas de Pandora. Puede crear sus   
					propias emisoras introduciendo sus temas y   
					artistas favoritos cuando aparezca la solicitud   
					correspondiente. Una vez creada su cuenta y sus   
					emisoras, puede regresar al receptor Onkyo y   
					pulsar Enter para empezar a escuchar su radio   
					por Internet personalizada de Pandora.   
					Si ya dispone de una cuenta de Pandora, puede   
					añadirla al receptor Onkyo seleccionando “I have   
					a Pandora Account” e iniciando la sesión con su   
					dirección de correo electrónico y contraseña.   
					I’m tired of this track:   
					PANDORA, el logotipo de PANDORA logo, y la   
					imagen corporativa de Pandora son marcas   
					comerciales o marcas comerciales registradas de   
					Pandora Media, Inc. Uso con permiso.   
					Si se cansa de un tema, puede “silenciarlo” de   
					modo que Pandora no lo reproduzca durante un   
					mes.   
					Create station from this artist:   
					Crea una emisora de radio a partir de este   
					artista.   
					Consejo   
					• Si desea utilizar múltiples cuentas de usuario,   
					consulte “Uso de múltiples cuentas” (➔ página 1). Se   
					puede iniciar sesión desde la pantalla “Users”.   
					Es-2   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Uso de Internet Radio   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar el menú y luego   
					pulse ENTER.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar una emisora y   
					luego pulse ENTER o 1para iniciar la   
					reproducción.   
					Uso de Rhapsody (sólo EE.UU.)   
					2 
					3 
					Search:   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar “Sign in to your   
					1 
					account” y luego pulse ENTER.   
					Puede buscar música por artista, álbum o   
					canción.   
					Se inicia la reproducción y aparece la pantalla de   
					reproducción.   
					Para utilizar Rhapsody, necesitará una cuenta. Si   
					todavía no tiene una, puede crear una nueva en   
					www.rhapsody.com/onkyo   
					Music Guide:   
					Puede controlar las pistas con los botones del   
					mando a distancia.   
					Puede reproducir canciones por géneros, artistas   
					principales, álbumes principales o canciones   
					principales, novedades, selección del sitio.   
					Rhapsody Channels:   
					Escuche las emisoras de radio programadas por   
					los principales redactores de Rhapsody.   
					Playlists:   
					Si ya tiene una cuenta Rhapsody, seleccione   
					“Sign in to your account” y pulse ENTER.   
					Escriba su nombre de usuario (normalmente el   
					correo electrónico) y contraseña en la pantalla de   
					teclado que aparece a continuación o en la   
					configuración web.   
					Botones activados: 1, 3, 2, 5, 4, 7,   
					6, RANDOM, REPEAT   
					Nota   
					• En Rhapsody Channels, algunos de los botones no   
					funcionan.   
					■ Elementos del menú   
					Add track to My Library:   
					Marca las canciones que se están reproduciendo   
					actualmente.   
					Add album to My Library:   
					Marca los álbumes que se están reproduciendo   
					actualmente.   
					Add playlist to My Library:   
					Marca las listas de reproducción que se están   
					reproduciendo actualmente.   
					Add channel to My Channels:   
					Marca las emisoras de Rhapsody que se están   
					reproduciendo actualmente.   
					Reproduzca sus listas personales.   
					My Library:   
					Marque sus álbumes y canciones preferidas en   
					el catálogo de Rhapsody, usando Mi biblioteca.   
					Account Info:   
					Confirme los datos de su cuenta.   
					Sign Out:   
					Salga de su cuenta Rhapsody.   
					■ Utilización de la pantalla de teclado   
					1. Utilice q/w/e/ry ENTER para introducir su   
					nombre de usuario y su contraseña.   
					2. Seleccione “OK”.   
					3. Pulse ENTER. Aparecerá la pantalla   
					“Confirm your entries”.   
					4. Pulse ENTER.   
					Consejo   
					• Si desea utilizar múltiples cuentas de usuario,   
					consulte “Uso de múltiples cuentas” (➔ página 1). Se   
					puede iniciar sesión desde la pantalla “Users”.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Añade una canción, emisora o lista de   
					reproducción a la lista Mis favoritos.   
					Consejo   
					• Puede eliminar las canciones, los álbumes y las   
					emisoras de Rhapsody marcados de Mi biblioteca.   
					Es-3   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Uso de Internet Radio   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar “Sign In”, y luego   
					pulse ENTER.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar la emisora   
					Uso de SiriusXM Internet Radio (solo   
					Norteamérica)   
					1 
					3 
					deseada y luego pulse ENTER.   
					Si ya tiene una cuenta SIRIUS, puede acceder   
					seleccionando “Sign In”. Escriba su nombre de   
					usuario y contraseña en la pantalla de teclado   
					que aparece a continuación o en la configuración   
					web. Si no sabe su nombre de usuario o la   
					contraseña, llame a Sirius XM al número (888)   
					539-7474 para solicitar asistencia.   
					Aparecerá la pantalla de reproducción de la   
					emisora seleccionada y ahora usted podrá   
					escuchar SiriusXM Internet Radio.   
					Puede controlar las pistas con los botones del   
					mando a distancia.   
					Su receptor de AV Onkyo incluye una prueba gratuita   
					de SiriusXM Internet Radio. La pantalla “Account   
					
					vez que termine el periodo de prueba, si desea seguir   
					escuchando este servicio, deberá contratarlo. para   
					suscribirse vaya a   
					Botones activados: 2, 3, 7, 6   
					■ Elementos del menú   
					www.siriusxm.com/internetradio con su   
					ordenador.   
					Consejo   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					• Si desea utilizar múltiples cuentas de usuario,   
					consulte “Uso de múltiples cuentas” (➔ página 1). Se   
					puede iniciar sesión desde la pantalla “Users”.   
					Añade una emisora a la lista Mis favoritos.   
					Cuando se suscriba, recibirá un nombre de usuario y   
					una contraseña que deberá introducir en el receptor   
					de AV.   
					■ Utilización de la pantalla de teclado   
					1. Utilice q/w/e/ry ENTER para introducir su   
					nombre de usuario y su contraseña.   
					2. Seleccione “OK”.   
					Las suscripciones a SiriusXM Internet Radio se   
					venden por separado y se rigen por las condiciones   
					de Sirius (consulte www.sirius.com). Lea   
					atentamente este acuerdo antes de comprar la   
					suscripción. Sirius, XM y todas las marcas y logotipos   
					relacionados son marcas comerciales de Sirius XM   
					Radio Inc. y sus filiales. Todos los derechos   
					reservados.   
					Para poder utilizar SiriusXM Internet Radio, el   
					receptor de AV debe estar conectado a internet. Para   
					usar el mando a distancia, siga este procedimiento:   
					3. Pulse ENTER. Aparecerá la pantalla   
					“Confirm your entries”.   
					4. Pulse ENTER.   
					Aparecerá “Please wait...” y después la pantalla   
					“SiriusXM Internet Radio”, que muestra la   
					categoría disponible para la selección.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar la categoría y   
					luego pulse ENTER.   
					2 
					Aparece una pantalla con una lista de emisoras   
					de la categoría seleccionada.   
					Es-4   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Uso de Internet Radio   
					Profile:   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar “Sign in to your   
					account”, y luego pulse ENTER.   
					Uso de Last.fm Internet Radio   
					1 
					Puede reproducir pistas de “Recently Listened   
					Tracks”, “Library” y “Neighbours”.   
					Account Info:   
					Confirme los datos de su cuenta.   
					Sign Out:   
					Last.fm es un servicio musical que sabe lo que le   
					gusta...   
					Si ya tiene una cuenta de Last.fm, puede   
					acceder a ella para seleccionar “Sign in to your   
					account”. Introduzca su nombre de usuario y   
					contraseña en la siguiente pantalla de teclado.   
					Su nuevo receptor de AV Onkyo es muy inteligente.   
					Si tiene una cuenta gratuita de Last.fm, hará un   
					seguimiento de todas las canciones que acaba de   
					escuchar. Cuando visite el sitio web de Last.fm,   
					podrá ver listas personales de la música que ha   
					disfrutado, compartirlas con sus amigos y también   
					ver lo que les gusta a ellos.   
					Se desconecta de su cuenta.   
					■ Utilización de la pantalla de teclado   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar una emisora y   
					luego pulse ENTER o 1 para iniciar la   
					reproducción.   
					1. Utilice q/w/e/ry ENTER para introducir su   
					nombre de usuario y su contraseña.   
					2. Seleccione “OK”.   
					
					3. Pulse ENTER. Aparecerá la pantalla   
					“Confirm your entries”.   
					Se inicia la reproducción y aparece la pantalla de   
					reproducción.   
					Con sus miles de biografías, críticas y una infinita   
					variedad de emisoras de radio personalizadas y sin   
					publicidad, Last.fm es una forma excelente de   
					descubrir música. Cree hoy mismo una cuenta   
					gratuita de Last.fm en www.last.fm/join   
					4. Pulse ENTER.   
					Aparecerá “Please wait...” y después la pantalla   
					“Last.fm Internet Radio”.   
					■ Elementos del menú   
					I Love this track:   
					Se guarda la información sobre la canción en el   
					servidor de Last.fm y aumenta la frecuencia con   
					la que se reproduce.   
					Consejo   
					• Si desea utilizar múltiples cuentas de usuario,   
					consulte “Uso de múltiples cuentas” (➔ página 1). Se   
					puede iniciar sesión desde la pantalla “Users”.   
					Si se suscribe podrá disfrutar de lo mejor de Last.fm   
					Radio sin anuncios en su receptor de AV Onkyo sin   
					necesidad de un ordenador.   
					Ban this track:   
					Se guarda la información sobre la canción en el   
					servidor de Last.fm y se reduce la frecuencia con   
					la que se reproduce.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Añade una emisora a la lista Mis favoritos.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar un menú y luego   
					pulse ENTER.   
					Recommended Radio:   
					2 
					Descubra nuestras interesantes recomendaciones   
					personalizadas que se adaptan a sus gustos en cada   
					momento.   
					Search Station:   
					Puede buscar emisoras por artista, etiquetas o   
					nombre de usuario.   
					Artist Radio:   
					■ Uso del control de scrobbling   
					Top Artists Station:   
					Puede reproducir canciones de los artistas mejor   
					clasificados.   
					Top Tags Station:   
					Puede reproducir canciones con las etiquetas   
					mejor clasificadas.   
					Escoja cualquier artista y podrá escuchar una   
					emisora de radio inspirada exclusivamente en su   
					elección.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar “Enable”, y luego pulse   
					ENTER.   
					My Library:   
					* 
					Los servicios de radio por Internet suministrados por   
					Relájese y disfrute de selecciones de toda la música   
					que ha escuchado desde que se registró en Last.fm.   
					Tag Radio:   
					terceros pueden cancelarse con o sin aviso previo.   
					Es posible que los servicios de radio por Internet no estén   
					disponibles en algunas zonas.   
					Personal Station:   
					Puede reproducir pistas de una emisora   
					personalizada (“Your Library”, “Your   
					Neighbourhood” y “Your Recommendations”).   
					¿Polish funk? ¿Death pop? Piense en un estilo y   
					podrá escucharlo durante horas.   
					Pruébelo gratis ahora mismo. Cree una cuenta y verá   
					por sí mismo lo que significa tener toda la música del   
					mundo al alcance de sus oídos. Puede consultar los   
					precios actualizados y toda la información que desee   
					en www.last.fm/subscribe   
					Es-5   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Uso de Internet Radio   
					Puede controlar las pistas con los botones del   
					mando a distancia.   
					Uso de Slacker Personal Radio   
					6 
					Si no tiene una cuenta, cree una en el sitio web   
					de Slacker (www.slacker.com) con su   
					ordenador.   
					Botones activados: 1, 3, 2, 6   
					1 
					■ Elementos del menú   
					Rate Song as Favorite:   
					Guarda información en el servidor, haciendo que   
					sea más probable que la canción se vuelva a   
					reproducir.   
					Si ya tiene una cuenta de Slacker, seleccione   
					“Sign in to your account” y pulse ENTER.   
					Aparecerá la pantalla de teclado. Puede   
					introducir información desde el mando a   
					distancia o desde el teclado de la unidad   
					principal.   
					Ban Song:   
					Guarda información en el servidor, haciendo que   
					sea menos probable que la canción se vuelva a   
					reproducir.   
					Si no hay errores en la información que ha   
					introducido, utilice q/w/e/rpara seleccionar   
					“OK” y luego pulse ENTER.   
					2 
					3 
					Ban Artist:   
					Guarda información en el servidor, haciendo que   
					sea menos probable que las canciones de este   
					artista se vuelvan a reproducir.   
					Mark Favorite:   
					Añade la emisora que se está reproduciendo   
					actualmente a los favoritos.   
					Aparecerá una pantalla de confirmación de la   
					información de la cuenta.   
					Si no tiene una cuenta, seleccione “Access   
					without Sign In” y pulse ENTER para utilizar   
					una versión restringida del servicio.   
					Unmark Favorite:   
					Tenga en cuenta que el uso estará restringido.   
					Elimina la emisora que se está reproduciendo   
					actualmente de los favoritos.   
					Add song to Library:   
					Añade la canción que se está reproduciendo   
					actualmente a su biblioteca.   
					Consejo   
					• Si desea utilizar múltiples cuentas de usuario,   
					consulte “Uso de múltiples cuentas” (➔ página 1). Se   
					puede iniciar sesión desde la pantalla “Users”.   
					Utilice q/wpara seleccionar un menú y luego   
					Delete song from Library:   
					4 
					5 
					pulse ENTER.   
					Elimina la canción que se está reproduciendo   
					actualmente de la biblioteca.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Añade una emisora o canción a la lista Mis   
					favoritos.   
					Para salir, utilice q/wpara seleccionar “Sign out”   
					en esta pantalla y luego pulse ENTER.   
					
					
					reproducción de la emisora.   
					Aparecerá la pantalla de reproducción.   
					Es-6   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Using Internet Radio   
					Using Multiple Accounts   
					Using Internet Radio   
					The AV receiver supports multiple user accounts,   
					which means you can freely switch between several   
					logins. After registering user accounts, login is   
					performed from the “Users” screen.   
					Using Last.fm Internet Radio........................ 2   
					Common Procedures in Internet Radio   
					Menu   
					Note   
					Press MENU while the Users screen is   
					displayed.   
					The following menu items appear:   
					Add new user:   
					Remove this user:   
					1 
					• Available services may vary depending on the region.   
					• Certain network service or contents available through this   
					device may not be accessible in case the service provider   
					terminates its service.   
					You can either store a new user account, or   
					delete an existing one.   
					Press NET.   
					1 
					A list of the network services appears, and the   
					NET indicator lights. If it flashes, verify that the   
					Ethernet cable is firmly connected to the AV   
					receiver.   
					Tip   
					• Some of the services don’t allow the use of multiple user   
					accounts.   
					• You can store up to 10 user accounts.   
					• To switch between accounts you must first log out from the   
					current account, and log in again on the “Users” screen.   
					Select the desired service and press ENTER.   
					The top page of the selected service appears.   
					2 
					En-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Using Internet Radio   
					Profile:   
					Use q/wto select “Sign in to your account”,   
					and then press ENTER.   
					Using Last.fm Internet Radio   
					1 
					You can play tracks from “Recently Listened   
					Tracks”, “Library” and “Neighbours”.   
					Account Info:   
					Confirm your account information.   
					Sign Out:   
					Last.fm is a music service that learns what you   
					love...   
					If you have the existing Last.fm account, you can   
					sign in to your account to select “Sign in to your   
					account”. Enter your user name and password in   
					the next keyboard screen.   
					Your new Onkyo AV receiver is very clever. If you   
					have a free Last.fm account, it will keep track of all   
					the songs you’ve just played. When you visit the   
					Last.fm website, you can see personal charts of the   
					music you’ve enjoyed, share them with friends and   
					see what they like, too.   
					It signs out from your account.   
					■ Using the keyboard screen   
					Use q/wto select a station, and press ENTER   
					1. Use q/w/e/rand the ENTER to enter your   
					user name and password.   
					2. Select “OK”.   
					
					or 1 to start playback.   
					Playback starts and the playback screen   
					appears.   
					3. Press ENTER. The “Confirm your entries”   
					screen appears.   
					With thousands of biographies, reviews and an   
					endless choice of personalised, ad-free radio   
					stations, Last.fm is a great way to discover music.   
					Pick up your free Last.fm account today at   
					www.last.fm/join   
					Enabled buttons: 1, 2, 6   
					4. Press ENTER.   
					“Please wait...” appears and then “Last.fm   
					Internet Radio” screen appears.   
					■ Menu Items   
					I Love this track:   
					Track information is saved in Last.fm server, and   
					playback frequency increases.   
					Ban this track:   
					Track information is saved in Last.fm server, and   
					playback frequency reduces.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Tip   
					UK and Germany only:   
					• If you want to use multiple user accounts, see “Using   
					Multiple Accounts” (➔ page 1). Login can be made   
					from the “Users” screen.   
					Get a subscription and you can enjoy the best of ad-   
					free Last.fm Radio on your Onkyo AV receiver without   
					a computer!   
					Recommended Radio:   
					Discover smart personalised recommendations that   
					adapt as your tastes change.   
					Use q/wto select menu and then press   
					ENTER.   
					2 
					Adds a station to My Favorites list.   
					Search Station:   
					You can search station by Artist, Tag, or User   
					Name.   
					■ Using scrobbling control   
					Artist Radio:   
					Use q/wto select “Enable”, and then press ENTER.   
					Pick any artist and we’ll play you a whole station of   
					music inspired by your choice.   
					My Library:   
					Sit back and enjoy selections from all the music   
					you’ve heard since you joined Last.fm.   
					Tag Radio:   
					Top Artists Station:   
					You can play tracks of top-rated artists.   
					Top Tags Station:   
					You can play tracks of top-rated tags.   
					Personal Station:   
					You can play tracks from personalized station   
					(“Your Library”, “Your Neighbourhood” and   
					“Your Recommendations”).   
					* 
					Internet radio services provided by a third party may be   
					terminated with or without notice.   
					Internet radio services may not be available in some areas.   
					Polish funk? Death pop? Think of a style and we’ll   
					entertain you with it for hours.   
					Start your free trial straight away when you create   
					your account and see for yourself what it’s like to   
					have the world’s music at your fingertips. Latest   
					prices and full information are available at   
					www.last.fm/subscribe   
					En-2   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
					
				Internetradio verwenden   
					Verwendung mehrerer Konten   
					Internetradio verwenden   
					Der AV-Receiver unterstützt mehrere Nutzerkonten,   
					was bedeutet, dass Sie frei zwischen mehreren   
					Logins umschalten können. Nach der Anmeldung der   
					Nutzerkonten wird das Login vom „Users“ Bildschirm   
					aus vorgenommen.   
					Verwendung von Last.fm Internet Radio..... 2   
					Allgemeine Verfahren bei den   
					Internetradio-Menüs   
					Anmerkung   
					Drücken Sie MENU während der Bildschirm   
					• Die verfügbaren Dienste sind länderabhängig verschieden.   
					• Bestimmte Netzwerkdienste oder über dieses Gerät zur   
					Verfügung stehende Inhalte stehen eventuell nicht zur   
					Verfügung, falls der Service-Anbieter seine Dienstleistung   
					beendet.   
					1 
					des Nutzers angezeigt wird.   
					Das folgende Menü erscheint:   
					Add new user:   
					Remove this user:   
					Sie können entweder ein neues Nutzerkonto   
					abspeichern oder ein bestehendes löschen.   
					Drücken Sie NET.   
					1 
					Es erscheint eine Liste der Netzwerkdienste und   
					die NET-Anzeige leuchtet. Wenn sie blinkt,   
					überprüfen Sie ob das Ethernet-Kabel fest im AV-   
					Receiver eingesteckt ist.   
					Tipp   
					• Einige dieser Dienstleistungen lassen keine mehrfachen   
					Nutzerkonten zu.   
					• Sie können bis zu 10 Nutzerkonten speichern.   
					• Um zwischen den Konten umzuschalten, müssen Sie sich   
					zuerst aus Ihrem aktuellen Konto ausloggen und sich dann   
					wieder auf dem „Users“ Bildschirm einloggen.   
					Wählen Sie den gewünschten Service aus und   
					drücken Sie ENTER.   
					Die oberste Seite des ausgewählten Services   
					erscheint.   
					2 
					De-1   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Internetradio verwenden   
					können. Die aktuellen Nutzungspreise und umfassende   
					Infos sind unter www.last.fm/subscribe erhältlich   
					Personal Station:   
					Verwendung von Last.fm Internet Radio   
					Sie können Titel aus einem persönlich   
					angepassten Sender wiedergeben („Your   
					Library“, „Your Neighbourhood“ und „Your   
					Recommendations“).   
					Last.fm ist ein Musikdienst, der sich Ihre   
					Lieblingsmusik merkt...   
					Verwenden Sie q/w, um „Sign in to your   
					1 
					account“ auszuwählen und dann drücken Sie   
					ENTER.   
					Wenn Sie über einen bestehenden Last.fm Konto   
					verfügen, können Sie sich anmelden und „Sign   
					in to your account“ wählen. Geben Sie Ihre Ihre   
					Benutzernamen und das Kennwort in der   
					folgenden Tastaturanzeige ein.   
					Ihr neuer Onkyo AV-Receiver ist äußerst clever. Wenn Sie   
					ein kostenloses Last.fm-Konto eingerichtet haben, werden   
					darin alle kürzlich abgespielten Titel gespeichert. Wenn Sie   
					die Last.fm-Website besuchen, können Sie Ihre   
					persönlichen Charts der von Ihnen abgespielten Musik   
					anzeigen; teilen Sie diese mit Freunden und sehen Sie   
					auch, welche Musik Ihre Freunde mögen.   
					Profile:   
					Sie können Titel aus „Recently Listened Tracks“,   
					„Library“ und „Neighbours“ wiedergeben.   
					Account Info:   
					Bestätigen Sie Ihre Kontoinformation.   
					Sign Out:   
					■ Verwendung der Tastaturanzeige   
					
					schier endlosen Auswahl an persönlich angepassten,   
					werbefreien Radiosendern ist Last.fm eine großartige   
					Gelegenheit, um Musik zu entdecken. Holen Sie sich   
					Ihr kostenloses Last.fm-Konto noch heute unter   
					www.last.fm/join   
					Zur Abmeldung aus Ihrem Konto.   
					1. Verwenden Sie   
					Ihren Nutzernamen und Passwort einzugeben.   
					2. Wählen Sie „OK“.   
					3. Drücken Sie ENTER. Die Anzeige „Confirm   
					your entries“ erscheint.   
					q 
					/ 
					w 
					/ 
					e 
					/ 
					r 
					und den ENTER, um   
					Verwenden Sie q/w, um einen Sender   
					auszuwählen und dann drücken Sie ENTER   
					oder 1 , um die Wiedergabe zu starten.   
					Die Wiedergabe wird gestartet und die   
					Wiedergabeanzeige erscheint.   
					3 
					4. Drücken Sie ENTER.   
					
					erscheint die „Last.fm Internet Radio“-Anzeige.   
					Nur für Großbritannien und Deutschland:   
					Holen Sie sich ein Abonnement und Sie können auch   
					ohne Computer die besten werbefreien Last.fm-   
					Radiosender auf Ihrem Onkyo AV-Receiver hören!   
					Recommended Radio:   
					Entdecken Sie smarte, persönlich angepasste   
					Empfehlungen, die sich mit Ihrem Musikgeschmack   
					verändern.   
					Aktivierte Tasten: 1, 2, 6   
					■ Menüsymbole   
					I Love this track:   
					Tipp   
					Titel-Informationen werden auf dem Last.fm-   
					Server gespeichert und die Häufigkeit der   
					Wiedergabe wird erhöht.   
					• Falls Sie mehrere Nutzerkonten verwenden möchten,   
					schlagen Sie bitte unter „Verwendung mehrerer   
					Konten“ nach (➔ Seite 1). Das Login kann vom   
					„Users“-Bildschirm aus erfolgen.   
					Ban this track:   
					Titel-Informationen werden auf dem Last.fm-   
					Server gespeichert und die Häufigkeit der   
					Wiedergabe wird verringert.   
					Add to My Favorites:   
					Fügt einen Sender zu meiner My Favorites Liste hinzu.   
					Artist Radio:   
					Verwenden Sie q/w, um das Menü   
					auszuwählen und dann drücken Sie ENTER.   
					Search Station:   
					2 
					Wählen Sie einen beliebigen Interpreten und wir   
					spielen für Sie einen ganzen Radiosender mit durch   
					Ihre Wahl inspirierter Musik.   
					Sie können einen Sender anhand Interpreten,   
					Tags oder Benutzernamen suchen.   
					Top Artists Station:   
					My Library:   
					Lehnen Sie sich zurück und erfreuen Sie sich an   
					einer Auswahl aller Musik, die Sie seit Ihrer   
					Mitgliedschaft bei Last.fm gehört haben.   
					Tag Radio:   
					Polish Funk? Death Pop? Denken Sie an einen   
					Musikstil und wir unterhalten Sie stundenlang damit.   
					■ Scrobbling-Steuerung verwenden   
					Sie können Titel der am besten bewerteten   
					Interpreten wiedergeben.   
					Top Tags Station:   
					Sie können Titel der am besten bewerteten Tags   
					wiedergeben.   
					Verwenden Sie q/w, um „Enable“ auszuwählen und   
					dann drücken Sie ENTER.   
					* 
					Von Drittparteien zur Verfügung gestellte Internetradio-   
					Dienste können unter Umständen ohne Vorankündigung   
					eingestellt werden.   
					Starten Sie Ihr kostenloses Probeabo direkt wenn Sie   
					Ihr Konto erstellen und finden Sie selbst heraus wie es   
					ist, jederzeit die Musik der ganzen Welt abrufen zu   
					In bestimmten Gebieten sind Internetradio-Dienste   
					eventuell nicht verfügbar.   
					Y1212-1   
					SN 29401479IREU   
					* 2 9 4 0 1 4 7 9 I R E U *   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					While holding down the REMOTE MODE button to which you want to assign a   
					code, press and hold down [DISPLAY] (about 3 seconds).   
					The REMOTE MODE button/Remote indicator lights.   
					On Integra products, button names are capitalized. For example, “Remote Mode”   
					button and “Display” button.   
					Remote Control Codes   
					/ 
					1 
					2 
					Notes:   
					• Remote control codes cannot be entered for [RECEIVER] and the multi zone button.   
					
					• Except for [RECEIVER], [TV], and the multi zone button, remote control codes from any   
					category can be assigned for the REMOTE MODE buttons. However, these buttons also work   
					as input selector buttons, so choose a REMOTE MODE button that corresponds with the input   
					to which you connect your component. For example, if you connect your CD player to the CD   
					input, choose [TV/CD] when entering its remote control code.   
					Within 30 seconds, use the number buttons to enter the 5-digit remote control   
					code.   
					The REMOTE MODE button/Remote indicator flashes twice.   
					If the remote control code is not entered successfully, the REMOTE MODE   
					button/Remote indicator will flash once slowly.   
					Notes:   
					• The flashing element of the remote controller will differ according to your AV receiver’s model.   
					• The remote controller is preconfigured with remote controller presets of different components.   
					By entering a code from the Remote Control Code list, you can activate the relevant preset for   
					that component.   
					• When there are multiple codes related to one manufacturer, try and enter them one-by-one until   
					it matches your component.   
					• Depending on the model and year of your component, compatibility is not guaranteed.   
					• With some models, the remote controller may not not work or its compatibility may be limited   
					to part of the component’s functionality.   
					• Besides, it is not possible to add new codes to the existing remote controller presets.   
					• Though the provided remote control codes are correct at the time of printing, they are subject to   
					change by the manufacturer.   
					1 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Codes de télécommande   
					Códigos de control remoto   
					Tout en maintenant enfoncé le bouton REMOTE MODE auquel vous souhaitez   
					associer un code, pressez et maintenez enfoncé le bouton [DISPLAY] (pendant   
					environ 3 secondes).   
					Manteniendo pulsado el botón REMOTE MODE para el cual desea introducir un   
					código, pulse y mantenga presionado el botón [DISPLAY] (aproximadamente 3   
					segundos).   
					1 
					1 
					Le bouton REMOTE MODE/le témoin Remote s’allume.   
					Les noms de boutons sont en manjuscules sur les produits Integra. Par exemple, le   
					bouton « Remote Mode » et le bouton « Display ».   
					Remarques :   
					Se iluminará el botón REMOTE MODE/indicador Remote.   
					En los productos Integra, los nombres de los botones aparecen con mayúsculas. Por   
					ejemplo, el botón “Remote Mode” y el botón “Display”.   
					Notas:   
					• Les codes de télécommande ne peuvent pas être entrés pour [RECEIVER] et le bouton multi   
					zone.   
					• No podrán introducirse códigos de mando a distancia para [RECEIVER] y el botón multizona.   
					• Únicamente podrán introducirse códigos de mando a distancia de televisor para el botón [TV].   
					• Con la excepción de [RECEIVER], [TV] y el botón multizona, se pueden asignar códigos de   
					mando a distancia de cualquier categoría a los botones de REMOTE MODE. No obstante, estos   
					botones también pueden funcionar como botones de selector de entrada; por tanto, seleccione   
					
					componente. Por ejemplo, si conecta un reproductor de CD a la entrada de CD, seleccione   
					[TV/CD] cuando introduzca su código de mando a distancia.   
					• Seul les code de télécommande de téléviseurs peuvent être entrés pour [TV].   
					• À l’exception de [RECEIVER], [TV] et du bouton multi zone, vous pouvez affecter des codes   
					de télécommande de n’importe quelle catégorie pour les boutons REMOTE MODE. Cependant,   
					ces boutons font également office de bouton de sélecteur d’entrée : par conséquent, choisissez   
					un bouton REMOTE MODE correspondant à l’entrée à laquelle vous souhaitez raccorder votre   
					appareil. Par exemple, si vous raccordez votre lecteur CD à l’entrée CD, choisissez [TV/CD]   
					lorsque vous saisissez le code de télécommande.   
					Antes de que transcurran 30 segundos, utilice los botones numéricos para   
					introducir el código de mando a distancia de 5 dígitos.   
					El botón REMOTE MODE/indicador Remote parpadeará dos veces.   
					Si el código de mando a distancia no se introduce correctamente, el botón REMOTE   
					MODE/indicador Remote parpadeará una vez despacio.   
					Notas:   
					• El parpadeo del mando distancia será distinto según el modelo de receptor de AV.   
					• El mando a distancia está preconfigurado con los ajustes predeterminados de los distintos   
					componentes. Al introducir un código de la lista de códigos del mando a distancia se puede   
					activar el ajuste predeterminado de ese componente.   
					• Cuando hay múltiples códigos relacionados con un fabricante, pruebe a introducirlos uno a uno   
					hasta que coincida con su componente.   
					• Dependiendo del modelo y el año de su componente, la compatibilidad no está garantizada.   
					• Con algunos modelos, es posible que el mando a distancia no funcione o que su compatibilidad   
					esté limitada a una parte de las funciones del componente.   
					2 
					Vous disposez de 30 secondes pour saisir le code de télécommande à cinq chiffres   
					à l’aide des boutons numérotés.   
					2 
					Le bouton REMOTE MODE/le témoin Remote clignote deux fois.   
					Si le code de télécommande n’a pas été saisi correctement le bouton REMOTE   
					MODE/l’indicateur Remote ne clignote qu’une seule fois.   
					Remarques :   
					• L’élément clignotant de la télécommande différera selon le modèle de votre ampli-tuner AV.   
					• La télécommande est préconfigurée avec des préréglages de télécommande de différents   
					appareils. En entrant un code de la liste des codes de télécommandes, vous pouvez activer le   
					préréglage approprié pour cet appreil.   
					• Quand il y a de multiples codes liés à un fabricant, essayez-les et entrez-les un par un jusqu’à ce   
					que cela corresponde à votre appareil.   
					• Selon le modèle et l’année de votre appareil, la compatibilité n’est pas garantie.   
					• Avec certains modèles, la télécommande peut ne pas fonctionner ou sa compatibilité peut être   
					limitée à une partie de la fonctionnalité de l’appareil.   
					• Además, no es posible añadir nuevos códigos a los ajustes predeterminados existentes del   
					mando a distancia.   
					• Los códigos de mando a distancia suministrados son correctos en el momento de la impresión,   
					pero el fabricante puede realizar cambios.   
					• En outre, il n’est pas possible d’ajouter de nouveaux codes aux préréglages de télécommande   
					existants.   
					• Bien que les codes de télécommande fournis soient corrects au moment de l’impression de la   
					liste, ils sont susceptibles d’être modifiés par le fabricant.   
					2 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Codici del telecomando   
					Fernbedienungscodes   
					Tenendo premuto il tasto REMOTE MODE al quale si desidera assegnare il   
					Halten Sie die REMOTE MODE-Taste gedruckt, fur die Sie den Code eingeben   
					mochten, und drucken Sie (ca. 3 Sekunden lang) die [DISPLAY]-Taste.   
					Die REMOTE MODE-Taste/Remote-Anzeige leuchtet.   
					Bei den Integra-Produkten werden die Namen der Tasten groß geschrieben. Zum   
					Beispiel „Remote Mode“ (Fernbedienungsmodus)-Taste und „Display“-Taste.   
					Hinweise:   
					1 
					1 
					codice, premere e tenere premuto [DISPLAY] (per circa 3 secondi).   
					Il tasto REMOTE MODE/l'indicatore Remote si accende.   
					Sui prodotti Integra, i nomi dei tasti sono scritti con l'iniziale maiuscola. Ad esempio,   
					tasto “Remote Mode” e tasto “Display”.   
					Note:   
					• I codici di controllo del telecomando non possono essere inseriti per [RECEIVER] e i tasti multi   
					zona.   
					• Der Fernbedienungscode kann nicht [RECEIVER] und der Multi-Zonen-Taste zugeordnet   
					werden.   
					• Der Taste [TV] können nur Fernbedienungscodes für einen Fernseher zugeordnet werden.   
					• Abgesehen von [RECEIVER], [TV] und der Multi-Zone-Taste, können die   
					Fernbedienungscodes jeder Kategorie den REMOTE MODE-Tasten zugewiesen werden.   
					Allerdings dienen diese Tasten auch als Quellenwahltasten. Wählen Sie also nach Möglichkeit   
					eine REMOTE MODE-Taste, die dem Eingang zugeordnet ist, an den Sie die betreffende Quelle   
					angeschlossen haben. Wenn Sie z.B. einen CD-Player an den CD-Eingang anschließen, sollten   
					Sie [TV/CD] wenn Sie den Fernbedienungscode eingeben.   
					• Per [TV] è possibile immettere solo codici telecomando del televisore.   
					• Tranne che per [RECEIVER], [TV], e per il tasto multi zona, è possibile assegnare codici di   
					controllo di ogni categoria per i tasti REMOTE MODE. Tuttavia, tali tasti fungono anche da   
					tasti del selettore d'ingresso, quindi scegliere un tasto REMOTE MODE che corrisponda   
					all'ingresso al quale viene collegato il dispositivo. Per esempio, se si collega il lettore CD   
					all'ingresso CD, scegliere il [TV/CD] quando si immette il relativo codice telecomando.   
					Entro 30 secondi utilizzare i tasti numerici per inserire il codice telecomando a 5   
					cifre.   
					2 
					Geben Sie mit den Zifferntasten innerhalb von 30 Sekunden den 5-stelligen   
					Herstellercode ein.   
					Die REMOTE MODE-Taste/Remote-Anzeige blinkt zwei Mal.   
					Wenn der Fernbedienungscode nicht ordnungsgemäß eingegeben wurde, blinkt die   
					REMOTE MODE-Taste/Remote-Anzeige einmal langsam.   
					Hinweise:   
					• Das blinkende Element auf der Fernbedienung unterscheidet sich je nach AV-Receiver-Modell.   
					• Die Fernbedienung ist mit den Voreinstellungen der Fernbedienung der verschiedenen   
					Komponenten vorkonfiguriert. Indem ein Code aus der Liste der Fernbedienungscodes   
					eingegeben wird, können Sie die entsprechende Voreinstellung für die Komponente aktivieren.   
					• Wenn es mehrere Codes gibt, die sich auf einen Hersteller beziehen, versuchen Sie sie einzeln   
					einzugeben, bis einer mit Ihrer Komponente übereinstimmt.   
					2 
					Il tasto REMOTE MODE/l'indicatore Remote lampeggia due volte.   
					Se il codice telecomando non viene inserito correttamente, il tasto REMOTE   
					MODE/l'indicatore Remote lampeggia lentamente una volta.   
					Note:   
					• L'elemento lampeggiante del telecomando varia a seconda del modello del ricevitore AV.   
					• Il telecomando è preconfigurato con preselezioni per diversi apparecchi. Inserendo un codice   
					dall'elenco dei codici telecomando, è possibile attivare la relativa preselezione per tale   
					apparecchio.   
					• Se sono presenti più codici relativi allo stesso produttore, provare a inserirli uno a uno finché   
					non si arrivi al codice corrispondente dell'apparecchio.   
					• A seconda del modello e dell'anno dell'apparecchio, la compatibilità non è garantita.   
					• Con alcuni modelli, il telecomando può non funzionare o la sua compatibilità può essere limitata   
					a una parte della funzionalità dell'apparecchio.   
					• Dies hängt vom Modell und Herstellungsjahr Ihrer Komponente ab und die Kompatibilität ist   
					nicht garantiert.   
					• Es kann sein, dass bei einigen Modellen die Fernbedienung nicht funktioniert oder ihre   
					Kompatibilität sich auf nur auf Teile der Funktionalität der Komponente beschränkt.   
					• Abgesehen davon ist es nicht möglich, den bestehenden Voreinstellungen der Fernbedienung   
					neue Codes hinzuzufügen.   
					• Inoltre, non è possibile aggiungere nuovi codici alle preselezioni esistenti del telecomando.   
					• I codici telecomando specificati sono validi alla data della stampa del presente documento, ma   
					sono soggetti a variazioni da parte del produttore.   
					• Obwohl die angegebenen Fernbedienungscodes dem Stand bei Drucklegung entsprechen, sind   
					Änderungen durch den Hersteller vorbehalten.   
					3 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Afstandsbedieningscodes   
					Fjärrstyrningskoder   
					Houd terwijl u de REMOTE MODE toets ingedrukt houdt waarvoor u een code   
					Håll ned knappen för det REMOTE MODE som du vill tilldela en kod samtidigt   
					som du trycker och håller ned [DISPLAY] (i cirka 3 sekunder).   
					REMOTE MODE-knapp/Fjärrindikatorlampa.   
					På Integra-produkter, är knappnamnens begynnelsebokstav en versal. Till exempel,   
					”Fjärrläge”-knapp och ”Display”-knapp.   
					1 
					1 
					wilt toewijzen de [DISPLAY] toets ingedrukt (ongeveer 3 seconden).   
					De toets REMOTE MODE (afstandsbedieningsmodus) / Het indicatielampje   
					afstandsbediening gaat branden.   
					Op producten van Integra staan de namen van de toetesn in hoofdletters. Bijvoorbeeld,   
					de toetsen “Remote Mode” en “Display”.   
					Anmärkningar:   
					Opmerkingen:   
					• Fjärrkontrollkoder kan inte anges för knapparna [RECEIVER] och flerzonsknappen.   
					• Endast fjärrkontrollkoder för tv kan anges för [TV].   
					• Er kunnen geen afstandsbedieningscodes worden ingevoerd voor [RECEIVER] en de multi   
					zone-toets.   
					• Förutom [RECEIVER], [TV] och flerzonsknappen, kan fjärrkontrollkoder för vilken som helst   
					kategori tilldelas för knapparna REMOTE MODE. Dessa knappar fungerar dock även som   
					ingångväljarknappar, så använd en knapp för REMOTE MODE som motsvarar ingången som   
					du ansluter utrustningen till. Till exempel, om du ansluter din CD-spelare till CD-ingången ska   
					
					• Alleen TV afstandsbedieningscodes kunnen worden ingevoerd voor [TV].   
					• Behalve voor [RECEIVER], [TV] en de multi zone-toets, kunnen afstandsbedieningscodes   
					vanuit elke categorie worden toegewezen aan de REMOTE MODE toetsen. Deze toetsen   
					werken overigens ook als ingangsselectortoetsen, kies dus een REMOTE MODE toets die   
					overeenkomt met de ingang waarop u uw component wilt aansluiten. Kies indien u bijvoorbeeld   
					uw CD-speler aansluit op de CD-ingang de [TV/CD] toets bij het invoeren van de   
					afstandsbedieningscode.   
					Använd sifferknapparna för att ange den femsiffriga koden inom 30 sekunder.   
					REMOTE MODE-knapp/Fjärrindikatorlampa blinkar två gånger.   
					Om fjärrkontrollkoden inte ställdes in, blinkar REMOTE MODE-   
					knappen/fjärrindikatorn långsamt en gång.   
					2 
					Gebruik binnen 30 seconden de cijfertoetsen om de 5-cijferige   
					afstandsbedieningscode in te voeren.   
					2 
					Anmärkningar:   
					De toets REMOTE MODE (afstandsbedieningsmodus) / Het indicatielampje   
					afstandsbediening knippert tweemaal.   
					Indien de afstandsbedieningscode niet met succes wordt ingevoerd, zal de toets   
					REMOTE MODE/Remote-indicator eenmaal traag knipperen.   
					Opmerkingen:   
					• Het knippergedeelte van de afstandsbediening zal verschillen ten opzichte van het model van   
					uw AV-receiver.   
					• De afstandsbediening is voorgeprogrammeerd met voorkeuzetoetsen van verschillende   
					componenten. Door het invullen van een code uit de afstandsbediening codelijst kunt u de   
					voorkeuzetoets voor die component activeren.   
					• Det blinkande elementet på fjärrkontrollen skiljer sig åt beroende på din modell av AV-receiver.   
					• Fjärrkontrollen har förkonfigurerats med förvalda kanaler på fjärrkontrollen för olika   
					komponenter. Genom att ange en kod från fjärrkontrollkodlistan, kan du aktivera relevanta   
					förvalda kanaler för den utrustningen.   
					• När det finns flera olika koder för en tillverkare ska du försöka att ange dem en och en tills de   
					stämmer överens med din utrustning.   
					• Beroende på utrustningens modell och årgång, går det inte att garantera kompatibilitet.   
					• På vissa modeller kan det hända att fjärrkontrollen inte fungerar eller så kan dess kompatibilitet   
					vara begränsad till en del av utrustningens funktion.   
					• Dessutom går det inte att lägga till nya koder till fjärrkontrollens existerande förvalda kanaler.   
					• Även om erhållna fjärrkontrollkoder är korrekta vid tryckningen, kan de ändras av tillverkaren.   
					• Wanneer er meerdere codes gerelateerd zijn aan één fabrikant, probeer deze dan een voor een   
					totdat de juiste code overeenkomt met uw component.   
					• Afhankelijk van het model en het bouwjaar van uw component is de compatibiliteit niet   
					gegarandeerd.   
					• Bij sommige modellen werkt de afstandsbediening mogelijk niet of is de compatibiliteit ervan   
					beperkt tot een deel van de functionaliteit van de component.   
					• 
					Daarnaast is het niet mogelijk om nieuwe codes aan de bestaande voorkeuzetoetsen van de   
					afstandsbediening toe te voegen.   
					• Hoewel de gegeven afstandsbedieningscodes correct zijn op het moment van afdrukken, kunnen   
					deze door de fabrikant gewijzigd worden.   
					4 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					遙控代碼   
					在按住想指定編碼的 REMOTE MODE (遙控模式)按鈕時,同時按住   
					遥控代码   
					按住想指定编码的 REMOTE MODE(遥控模式)按钮的同时,按住[DISPLAY   
					(显示)](大约 3 秒钟)。   
					1 
					1 
					[DISPLAY] (顯示)(約 3 秒)。   
					REMOTE MODE (遙控模式)按鈕 / 遙控指示燈亮起。   
					在 Integra 系列產品上,按鈕名稱為大寫。例如,「Remote Mode」(遙控模式)   
					按鈕和 「Display」(顯示)按鈕。   
					REMOTE MODE(遥控模式)按钮/遥控指示灯亮起。   
					Integra 产品上的按钮名称单词首字母大写。例如,“Remote Mode(遥控模   
					式)”按钮和“Display(显示)”按钮。   
					注意:   
					注意:   
					• [RECEIVER(接收机)]和多区域按钮不能输入遥控编码。   
					• 只能为[TV(电视)]输入电视遥控编码。   
					• [RECEIER] (接收機)和多區域按鈕不能輸入遙控編碼。   
					• 您只能為 [TV] (電視)輸入電視遙控編碼。   
					• 除 [RECEIVER] (接收機)、[TV] (電視)和多區域按鈕外,您可針對 REMOTE MODE   
					(遙控模式)按鈕指定任何類別的遙控編碼。但是,這些按鈕仍可用作為輸入選擇器按   
					鈕,因此,請選擇與您設備所連接輸入接口對應的 REMOTE MODE 按鈕。例如,如果   
					要將 CD 播放機連接到 CD 輸入源上,則需在輸入遙控編碼時選擇 [TV/CD]。   
					• 
					除[RECEIVER(接收机)]、[TV(电视)]和多区域按钮外,不能为 REMOTE MODE(遥   
					控模式)按钮指定任何类别的遥控编码。但是,这些按钮仍可用作输入选择器按钮,因   
					此,选择与设备所要连接的输入端对应的 REMOTE MODE(遥控模式)按钮。例如,如果   
					要将 CD 播放机连接到 CD 输入端,应在输入遥控编码时选择[TV/CD(电视/CD)]。   
					在 30 秒內,使用數字按鈕輸入 5 位數的遙控編碼。   
					REMOTE MODE (遙控模式)按鈕 / 遙控指示燈閃爍兩次。   
					如果無法成功輸入遙控編碼,REMOTE MODE (遙控模式)按鈕 / 遙控指示燈   
					會慢慢地閃爍一次。   
					
					REMOTE MODE(遥控模式)按钮/遥控指示灯闪烁两次。   
					如果不能顺利输入遥控编码,REMOTE MODE(遥控模式)按钮/遥控指示灯会   
					缓慢闪烁一次。   
					2 
					2 
					注意:   
					注意:   
					• 視您的 AV 接收機型號而定,遙控器的閃爍元件會有不同。   
					• 遙控器已預先設定有不同設備的遙控器預設值。透過輸入遙控編碼清單中的編碼,您   
					可啟用該設備的相關預設值。   
					• 根据 AV 接收机产品类型的不同,遥控器闪烁元素将会不同。   
					• 遥控器采用不同设备的遥控器预设进行预配置。通过从遥控器编码列表输入编码,便   
					可激活相应设备的相关预设。   
					• 當有多個編碼與單一製造商相關時,請嘗試一個接著一個輸入,直到與您的設備對應   
					為止。   
					• 单个制造商关联多个编码时,请尝试逐个输入,直至符合当前设备。   
					• 根据设备的产品类型和年份的不同,无法保证兼容性。   
					• 視設備的型號和年份而定,並不保證與本公司產品相容。   
					• 在某些型號上,遙控器可能無法作用,或是其相容性限於部份設備功能。   
					• 除此之外,您無法新增編碼至現有的遙控器預設值。   
					• 对于某些产品类型,遥控器可能无法工作或其兼容性可能受到部分设备功能性的限制。   
					• 此外,可能无法将新的编码追加到现有的遥控器预设。   
					• 尽管付印时所提供的遥控编码是正确的,但制造商会随时更改。   
					• 雖然所提供之遙控編碼在本文件列印時為正確,製造商仍可能會對其作出修改。   
					5 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Cable/PVR Combination   
					Cable Set Top Box   
					ADB   
					Cable Set Top Box   
					Neuf TV   
					Noos   
					Cable Set Top Box   
					Visiopass   
					02254, 02769   
					02769   
					03107   
					00817   
					01376   
					01877   
					Time Warner   
					UPC   
					01376, 01877, 02187   
					01582   
					Aon   
					00817   
					VTR   
					Arris   
					02187   
					NTL   
					01068, 01060   
					02767   
					WideOpenWest   
					Ziggo   
					Videotron   
					VTR   
					01877   
					AT&T   
					00858   
					Numericable   
					Ono   
					00660, 01666, 02015,   
					02142, 02447, 02774   
					01376   
					Bright House   
					BT Vision   
					Cable & Wireless   
					Cable One   
					Cablecom   
					Cablevision   
					Charter   
					01376, 01877   
					02294   
					01068, 01562   
					01060   
					WideOpenWest   
					Ziggo   
					01877   
					Optus   
					02142   
					Cable/PVR Combination   
					01068   
					Orange   
					Pace   
					00817   
					Arris   
					02187   
					IPTV   
					01376, 01877   
					01582   
					01376, 01877, 01068,   
					01060, 01982   
					Bright House   
					Cable One   
					Cablevision   
					Charter   
					01376, 01877   
					01376, 01877   
					01376, 01877   
					01376, 01877, 02187   
					01877, 01982   
					ADB   
					02254, 02769   
					02769   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					01488, 01982   
					Aon   
					01376, 01877   
					01376, 01877, 02187   
					00817, 01582, 02294,   
					02767   
					AT&T   
					BT Vision   
					Canal+   
					Cisco   
					00858   
					02294   
					Cisco   
					01877, 00858, 01982,   
					02345, 02378   
					Pioneer   
					RCN   
					01877, 01500   
					01376   
					Cisco   
					02657   
					Comcast   
					01376, 01877, 01982,   
					02187   
					Com Hem   
					Comcast   
					00817, 00660, 01666,   
					02015, 02447   
					00858, 02345, 02378   
					01385   
					Rogers   
					Sagem   
					Samsung   
					01877   
					Kreatel   
					mio TV   
					Motorola   
					Cox   
					01376, 01877   
					02187   
					01376, 01877, 01982,   
					02187   
					00817   
					02802   
					Digeo   
					01877, 01060, 01666,   
					02015, 02774   
					01376, 00858, 01998,   
					02378   
					Cox   
					01376, 01877   
					01877   
					Freebox   
					Humax   
					01482   
					Daeryung   
					Digeo   
					Scientific Atlanta   
					01877, 00858, 01982,   
					02345   
					02142, 03051, 03053   
					01376, 01877   
					03051, 03053   
					01877   
					Neuf TV   
					Pace   
					03107   
					02187   
					Insight   
					02657   
					SFR   
					03107   
					DX Antenna   
					France Telecom   
					Freebox   
					Fujitsu   
					01500   
					J:COM   
					Scientific Atlanta   
					SFR   
					00858, 02345   
					03107   
					Shaw   
					01376   
					00817   
					Knology   
					Mediacom   
					Motorola   
					Moxi   
					SingTel   
					Sony   
					01998, 02802   
					01460   
					01482   
					01376, 01877   
					01376   
					SingTel   
					01998, 02802   
					01385   
					01497   
					TeliaSonera   
					Telus   
					Stofa   
					02015   
					Humax   
					00660, 02142, 02447,   
					03051, 03053   
					02187   
					02345   
					Suddenlink   
					Sumitomo   
					Telewest   
					TeliaSonera   
					Telus   
					01376, 01877   
					01500   
					Numericable   
					Pace   
					02767   
					Thomson   
					Verizon   
					02769   
					Insight   
					01376, 01877   
					03051, 03053   
					01877   
					01877   
					02378   
					J:COM   
					01068   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					01982   
					Knology   
					Kreatel   
					01385   
					01582, 02767   
					01877   
					IPTV/PVR Combination   
					01385   
					02345   
					Pioneer   
					ADB   
					02769   
					Macab   
					00817   
					Thomson   
					Time Warner   
					Toshiba   
					UPC   
					01582, 01982, 02769   
					01376, 01877, 02187   
					01509   
					Rogers   
					01877   
					Aon   
					02769   
					Mediacom   
					mio TV   
					Motorola   
					01376, 01877   
					02802   
					Samsung   
					Scientific Atlanta   
					Shaw   
					01877   
					AT&T   
					BT Vision   
					Cisco   
					00858   
					01877, 01982   
					01376   
					02294   
					01376, 00858, 01562,   
					01982, 01998, 02378   
					01582   
					00858, 02345, 02378   
					01385   
					Verizon   
					Videotron   
					Virgin Media   
					02378   
					Suddenlink   
					Thomson   
					01376, 01877   
					01582   
					Kreatel   
					Motorola   
					Moxi   
					NEC   
					02187   
					01496   
					01877   
					00858, 02378   
					01068, 01060   
					6 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					IPTV/PVR Combination   
					CD   
					CD   
					MD   
					Neuf TV   
					Philips   
					03107   
					Harman/Kardon   
					Hitachi   
					Integra   
					JVC   
					70157   
					Rotel   
					70157   
					Onkyo   
					Sony   
					70868   
					02294   
					00858   
					03107   
					02378   
					70032   
					SAE   
					70157   
					70490, 70000   
					72977   
					Scientific Atlanta   
					SFR   
					71817, 70101   
					70072   
					Sansui   
					70157   
					TEAC   
					Yamaha   
					SAST   
					70157   
					70490   
					Verizon   
					Kenwood   
					Krell   
					70626, 70157, 70036   
					70157   
					Siemens   
					Silsonic   
					Simaudio   
					Sonic Frontiers   
					Sony   
					70157   
					Cassette Deck   
					Aiwa   
					70036   
					CD/Cassette Dock   
					40029   
					40076   
					40029   
					40029   
					40076   
					40029   
					40029   
					40070   
					40244   
					40070   
					40029   
					40029   
					40029   
					42157   
					40027   
					40029   
					40027   
					40029   
					40029   
					40027   
					40029   
					40029   
					40243   
					40029   
					40244   
					40027, 40029   
					40097   
					Linn   
					70157   
					70157   
					TASCAM   
					73095   
					Arcam   
					Loewe   
					Magnavox   
					Marantz   
					Matsui   
					MCS   
					70157   
					70157   
					Audiolab   
					Carver   
					70157   
					70490, 70000   
					70157   
					CD   
					70626, 70029, 70157   
					70157   
					Sylvania   
					TAG McLaren   
					Tandy   
					Advantage   
					AH!   
					70032   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					Denon   
					70157   
					Grundig   
					Harman/Kardon   
					Inkel   
					70029   
					70032   
					Aiwa   
					Memorex   
					Meridian   
					Micromega   
					Miro   
					70032   
					TASCAM   
					TEAC   
					73533, 73095   
					73531, 73551, 73532   
					70029, 70303   
					70157   
					Arcam   
					70157   
					Atoll Electronique   
					Audio Research   
					Audiolab   
					Audiomeca   
					Audioton   
					AVI   
					JVC   
					70157   
					Technics   
					Thorens   
					Thule Audio   
					Traxdata   
					Universum   
					Victor   
					Kenwood   
					Magnavox   
					Marantz   
					Myryad   
					Onkyo   
					70000   
					Mission   
					Myryad   
					NAD   
					70157   
					70157   
					70157   
					70626   
					70000, 70721   
					70157   
					70157   
					Naim   
					70072   
					Balanced Audio   
					Technology   
					Optimus   
					Philips   
					NSM   
					70157   
					Wards   
					70000, 70032, 70157   
					70490, 70032, 70036   
					70157   
					Onkyo   
					Optimus   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					Pioneer   
					Polk Audio   
					Primare   
					Proton   
					71817   
					Yamaha   
					Zonda   
					Cairn   
					70157   
					Pioneer   
					Polk Audio   
					Radiola   
					RCA   
					70000, 70032   
					70029, 70303   
					70626, 70157   
					70032, 70101   
					70157   
					California Audio Labs 70029, 70303   
					Cambridge   
					Cambridge Audio   
					Carver   
					70157   
					CD-R   
					70157   
					Denon   
					JVC   
					70626, 70766   
					70072   
					70157   
					Revox   
					CCE   
					70157   
					Kenwood   
					Marantz   
					Onkyo   
					Philips   
					Sony   
					70626   
					Sansui   
					70157   
					Cyrus   
					70157   
					70626   
					Sony   
					70157   
					Denon   
					70626, 70766   
					70000   
					71323   
					Thorens   
					Victor   
					QED   
					70157   
					DKK   
					70626   
					Quad   
					70157   
					DMX Electronics   
					Dynaco   
					70157   
					70000   
					Wards   
					Quasar   
					Radiola   
					RCA   
					70029   
					70157   
					TASCAM   
					71830, 72304   
					Yamaha   
					70157   
					Genexxa   
					Goldmund   
					Grundig   
					70000, 70032   
					70157   
					70032   
					CD-R/MD   
					Accessory   
					Restek   
					Revox   
					70157   
					70157   
					TASCAM   
					73511   
					Apple   
					81115   
					70157   
					7 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Accessory   
					Jamo   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					82228   
					Alba   
					01284   
					Centrex   
					CGV   
					01457   
					Durabrand   
					Echostar   
					01284   
					Logitech   
					Onkyo   
					82182   
					Allvision   
					Amstrad   
					01334   
					01413, 01567   
					01334, 01626   
					01176   
					00775, 00853, 01323,   
					01409, 02527   
					82990, 81993, 82351   
					82228   
					00847, 01175, 01662,   
					01693   
					Chess   
					Eco-Star   
					Edision   
					01413   
					Polk Audio   
					CityCom   
					Clatronic   
					Clayton   
					Com Hem   
					Comag   
					Comsat   
					Coship   
					Crown   
					Ansonic   
					Arnion   
					02418   
					01631   
					01413   
					01300   
					Elap   
					01413, 01567   
					02418   
					Video - Accessory   
					ADB   
					01626   
					ASCI   
					01334   
					Elbe   
					02254, 02769   
					02769   
					01176, 01915   
					01413   
					AssCom   
					Astro   
					00853   
					Energy Sistem   
					Engel   
					01631, 02418   
					01251   
					Aon   
					00173, 01100   
					02418   
					Apple   
					02615   
					01413   
					Atlanta   
					Atsat   
					EuroLine   
					Europhon   
					Europsat   
					Expressvu   
					Fagor   
					01251   
					AT&T   
					00858   
					01457   
					01300   
					01334   
					BT Vision   
					Canal+   
					02294   
					01284   
					AtSky   
					01334   
					01413, 01611   
					00775   
					02657   
					CS   
					01631   
					Audiola   
					Aurora   
					02418   
					Cisco   
					00858, 02345, 02378   
					01385   
					Cyfra+   
					Cyfrowy Polsat   
					D-box   
					01409   
					00879, 00642, 01433   
					00879, 00642, 01259   
					01631   
					01611   
					Kreatel   
					00853, 02527   
					00723, 01114   
					01626   
					Austar   
					Ferguson   
					Finlux   
					01291   
					mio TV   
					Motorola   
					02802   
					Avanit   
					01626   
					01376, 00858, 01998,   
					02378   
					Dantax   
					Denver   
					Dgtec   
					Awa   
					02418   
					Fly Com   
					FMD   
					01457   
					02418   
					Neuf TV   
					Pace   
					03107   
					Axil   
					01413, 01457, 02418   
					01626   
					01413, 01457   
					00879, 01176, 01356   
					02408   
					01631, 02418   
					02418   
					02657   
					Axitronic   
					Balmet   
					Bell ExpressVu   
					Belson   
					Foxtel   
					Dick Smith   
					Electronics   
					Philips   
					02294   
					01457   
					Freesat   
					Scientific Atlanta   
					SFR   
					00858, 02345   
					03107   
					00775   
					Digi Raum Electronics 01176   
					Fuba   
					00173, 01251   
					00853, 00879   
					01176   
					02418   
					Digiality   
					Digihome   
					DigiLogic   
					DigiQuest   
					Digisky   
					01334   
					Galaxis   
					SingTel   
					TeliaSonera   
					Telus   
					01998, 02802   
					01385   
					Big Sat   
					Black Diamond   
					Blaupunkt   
					Boshmann   
					Boston   
					01457   
					01284   
					General Satellite   
					Globo   
					01284   
					01284   
					01251, 01334, 01626   
					00775   
					02345   
					00173   
					01300, 01457, 01631   
					01457   
					GOI   
					Thomson   
					Verizon   
					02769   
					01413, 01631   
					01251   
					Gold Box   
					Gold Vision   
					GoldMaster   
					Goodmans   
					Gradiente   
					Grandin   
					Grocos   
					00853   
					02378   
					DigitalBox   
					Digiwave   
					DirecTV   
					Dish Network   
					Dishpro   
					01100, 01631   
					01631   
					01631   
					Boxer   
					01458   
					01334   
					Receiver   
					British Sky   
					00847, 01175, 01662   
					01377, 00099   
					00775   
					01284, 01291   
					00099, 00887   
					01626   
					Onkyo   
					52503   
					Broadcasting   
					BskyB   
					00847, 01175, 01662   
					01284, 01291, 01626   
					00853, 01334   
					00775   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Bush   
					DishTV   
					01300   
					01409, 01457   
					@sat   
					01300   
					Canal Digital   
					Canal Satellite   
					Canal+   
					DRE   
					01176   
					Grundig   
					00847, 00853, 00173,   
					00879, 01284, 01291   
					@Sky   
					01334   
					00853, 02657   
					Dream Multimedia   
					DSE   
					01237   
					Acoustic Solutions   
					ADB   
					01284   
					00853, 02657   
					Haier   
					Hallo   
					02418   
					01626   
					02280, 02418   
					00879, 00642, 01433   
					00642, 00887, 01259   
					01626   
					CanalSat   
					00853, 02657   
					DSTV   
					Akura   
					8 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Hama   
					01567   
					Leiko   
					01626   
					Pace   
					00847, 00853, 00887,   
					01175, 01323, 01356,   
					01423, 01662, 01693,   
					01850, 02059, 02060,   
					02211, 02657   
					Sat Industrie   
					SAT+   
					01611   
					Hanseatic   
					Hirschmann   
					Hitachi   
					Hornet   
					01100   
					00173   
					01284   
					01300   
					00775   
					Lemon   
					01334   
					01409   
					Lenoxx   
					Linsar   
					01611   
					Satplus   
					01100   
					01284   
					SatyCon   
					01631   
					Listo   
					01626   
					Schaub Lorenz   
					Schneider   
					Schwaiger   
					Sedea Electronique   
					SEG   
					02418   
					Pacific   
					01284   
					HTS   
					Lodos   
					01284   
					01206, 01251   
					01334, 01457, 01631   
					01206, 01626   
					01251, 01284, 01626   
					01611   
					Palcom   
					Panasat   
					Panasonic   
					01409, 01611   
					00879, 01433   
					Humax   
					01377, 01176, 01427,   
					01675, 01808, 01882,   
					01915, 02144, 02408,   
					02616   
					Logik   
					01284   
					Macab   
					00853   
					00847, 01304, 01404,   
					03099   
					Manhattan   
					Maspro   
					Matsui   
					01300   
					Panda   
					Pass   
					00173   
					00173   
					Servimat   
					ServiSat   
					ID Digital   
					ID Sat   
					01176   
					01567   
					00173, 01284, 01626   
					01334   
					01251   
					01334   
					peeKTon   
					Philips   
					01457, 02418   
					Maximum   
					Mediabox   
					Mediacom   
					MediaSat   
					Medion   
					MegaSat   
					Metronic   
					Shark   
					01631   
					ILLUSION sat   
					Imperial   
					Indovision   
					iNETBOX   
					Inno Hit   
					Innova   
					01631   
					00099, 00853, 00173,   
					01114, 00887, 00133,   
					02211   
					00853   
					Sherwood   
					Siemens   
					01409   
					01195, 01334   
					00887   
					01206   
					00173, 01334, 01626,   
					02418   
					00853   
					01237   
					Phoenix   
					Pino   
					02418   
					Sigmatek   
					SKY   
					02418   
					01334, 01626   
					01631   
					01626   
					01334   
					00099, 00847, 00887,   
					01175, 01662, 01693,   
					01850, 02754   
					00099   
					Pioneer   
					PMB   
					00853, 01308   
					01611   
					01334, 01413, 01631,   
					02418   
					inVion   
					02418   
					iotronic   
					01413   
					SKY Brazil   
					SKY Deutschland   
					SKY Italia   
					00887   
					Premiere   
					Pro Basic   
					Proline   
					QNS   
					00723   
					Metz   
					00173   
					ISkyB   
					00887   
					02754   
					00853   
					Moserbaer   
					Movistar   
					Multichoice   
					01251   
					ITT   
					02418   
					00853, 01693, 01850   
					02211   
					01284   
					02527, 02761   
					ITT Nokia   
					Jadeworld   
					Jaeger   
					00723   
					SKY New Zealand   
					SKY PerfecTV!   
					Sky XL   
					01404   
					00879, 00642, 01433,   
					02059, 02060   
					00642   
					02299, 02616, 03099   
					01251   
					RCA   
					01291   
					01334   
					Regal   
					01251   
					MySky   
					NEOTION   
					Netsat   
					01356, 01693, 01850   
					01334   
					JVC   
					00775   
					Sky+   
					01175, 01662   
					Roadstar   
					Rollmaster   
					Rownsonic   
					SAB   
					00853   
					KabelBW   
					Kaon   
					01195, 01882, 01915   
					01300   
					Skymaster   
					01334, 01409, 01567,   
					01611   
					01413   
					00099, 00887   
					00723   
					01567   
					Nikko   
					Skymax   
					Skyplus   
					01413   
					Kathrein   
					Kenwood   
					Koenig   
					00173, 01561, 01567   
					00853   
					01251, 01300, 01631   
					01114   
					Nokia   
					00853, 00723, 01223   
					01611   
					01175, 01334   
					01100   
					Sagem   
					Saivod   
					Samsung   
					Nordmende   
					NPG   
					SkySat   
					01631   
					02418   
					01631   
					Skyvision   
					SM Electronic   
					Smart   
					01334   
					Kreiling   
					Kreiselmeyer   
					L&S Electronic   
					LaSAT   
					01626   
					01377, 00853, 01175,   
					01206, 01458, 01662,   
					02986   
					Onn   
					01284   
					01409   
					00173   
					Optex   
					01413, 01611, 01626   
					00879, 01356   
					01334   
					01404, 01413, 01631   
					01457   
					01334   
					Optus   
					Sansui   
					01251   
					01626   
					01300   
					SmartVision   
					Sony   
					00173   
					Orbis   
					Sanyo   
					00847, 00853, 01558,   
					02299   
					Lava   
					01631   
					Orbitech   
					01100, 01195   
					Sat Control   
					9 
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					Satellite Set Top Box   
					SAT/PVR Combination   
					SAT/PVR Combination   
					Star   
					00887   
					UBC   
					00642   
					Canal+   
					02657   
					SKY Deutschland   
					SKY Italia   
					SKY New Zealand   
					SKY PerfecTV!   
					Sky+   
					02754   
					Stream System   
					Strong   
					01300   
					UEC   
					00879, 01356   
					01251, 01626, 02418   
					01882   
					CanalSat   
					02657   
					01693, 01850   
					02211   
					00853, 00879, 01284,   
					01300, 01409, 01626,   
					02418   
					United   
					Cyfrowy Polsat   
					DigiQuest   
					DirecTV   
					02527   
					Unitymedia   
					Universum   
					Variosat   
					VEA   
					01300   
					02299, 03099   
					01662   
					00173, 01251   
					00173   
					01377, 00099, 20739   
					00775   
					Sunny   
					01300   
					Dish Network   
					Dishpro   
					Skyplus   
					01175, 01334   
					01631   
					Sunstar   
					00642   
					02418   
					00775   
					Smart   
					Supernova   
					Supratech   
					Systec   
					00887   
					Vestel   
					01251, 01284   
					01195   
					Dream Multimedia   
					Echostar   
					01237   
					Sony   
					02299   
					01413   
					Viasat   
					00775, 02527   
					01631   
					Stream System   
					Strong   
					01300   
					01334   
					Vision   
					01626   
					Edision   
					01300   
					Sytech   
					02418   
					Visiosat   
					Vitecom   
					Vivax   
					01413, 01457   
					01413   
					Expressvu   
					Foxtel   
					00775   
					Sunny   
					01300   
					TBoston   
					TEAC   
					01251, 02418   
					01251   
					01356   
					TechniSat   
					Technosat   
					Telefonica   
					Telestar   
					01195   
					02418   
					Humax   
					
					01808   
					01206   
					Technical   
					Technika   
					TechniSat   
					Technosat   
					Techwood   
					TELE System   
					Telefonica   
					Telestar   
					01626   
					Volcasat   
					Wavelength   
					Wharfedale   
					Wisi   
					02418   
					02527   
					01284   
					ID Sat   
					01334   
					01413   
					01195   
					01100, 01195   
					01206   
					iNETBOX   
					Kaon   
					01237   
					01284   
					Thomson   
					Topfield   
					01175, 01662   
					01206   
					01300   
					00173   
					01251, 01284, 01626   
					01251, 01409, 01611   
					02527, 02761   
					Kathrein   
					Maximum   
					Mediacom   
					MegaSat   
					Movistar   
					Multichoice   
					MySky   
					01561   
					Worldsat   
					Woxter   
					Xsat   
					01251   
					Viasat   
					01195   
					01334   
					02418   
					Xtreme   
					01300   
					01206   
					00847, 01323   
					01300   
					01100, 01195, 01251,   
					01334, 01626   
					01631   
					Television   
					A.R. Systems   
					Accent   
					Xtreme   
					Yakumo   
					Yes   
					02527   
					10556, 10037   
					10037   
					01413   
					Televes   
					Televisa   
					Tevion   
					01300, 01334   
					00887   
					02059, 02060   
					01356, 01693, 01850   
					01334   
					00887   
					Acer   
					11339   
					Zehnder   
					01251, 01334, 01413,   
					01631   
					01409   
					NEOTION   
					Pace   
					Acoustic Solutions   
					Action   
					11037, 11667   
					10650   
					Thomson   
					00847, 00853, 01175,   
					01046, 01291, 01662   
					Zinwell   
					02280, 02761   
					01175, 01356, 01423,   
					01662, 01693, 01850,   
					02059, 02060, 02211,   
					02657   
					Addison   
					AEG   
					10653   
					Tonna   
					Topfield   
					Toshiba   
					Trevi   
					01611   
					01206   
					01284   
					01251   
					SAT/PVR Combination   
					11037, 11324   
					12719   
					@sat   
					01300   
					Agfaphoto   
					Aiko   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					01304, 03099   
					00099   
					Amstrad   
					Atsat   
					01175, 01662, 01693   
					01300   
					10037   
					Aim   
					10037, 10499   
					Triax   
					00853, 01251, 01291,   
					01413, 01611, 01626,   
					01631   
					Samsung   
					01175, 01206, 01662   
					01300   
					Bell ExpressVu   
					00775   
					Akai   
					10178, 10556, 10037,   
					10714, 10715, 10208,   
					11675   
					Sat Control   
					Schneider   
					Sedea Electronique   
					SKY   
					British Sky   
					Broadcasting   
					01175, 01662   
					01206   
					Tricolor TV   
					True Visions   
					Twinner   
					01176   
					02408   
					01611   
					01206   
					BskyB   
					01175, 01662   
					02657   
					Akiba   
					Akito   
					10037   
					10037   
					01175, 01662, 01693,   
					01850, 02754   
					Canal Satellite   
					10   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Television   
					Television   
					Belstar   
					Television   
					Classic   
					Television   
					DMTech   
					Domeos   
					Drean   
					Akura   
					10171, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 11363,   
					11585, 11667, 11709   
					11037   
					10499   
					12001   
					10668   
					10037   
					10698   
					Beon   
					10037   
					Clatronic   
					Clayton   
					Condor   
					10037, 10714, 11324   
					11037   
					Berthen   
					10556, 10668   
					10037   
					Alba   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11037, 11585   
					Bestar   
					10037   
					DSE   
					Bexa   
					12493   
					Conrowa   
					Contec   
					10698   
					Dual   
					10037, 11037, 11585,   
					11667   
					Alien   
					11037   
					Black Diamond   
					Blaupunkt   
					Blue Sky   
					11037   
					10037   
					Allstar   
					10037   
					Durabrand   
					10178, 10171, 10714,   
					11037, 11652   
					10195   
					Cosmel   
					CPTEC   
					Crown   
					10037   
					Amstrad   
					Anam   
					10171, 10037, 11037   
					10037   
					10556, 10037, 10625,   
					10714, 10668, 11037,   
					10715, 10499, 11324,   
					11363, 11652, 11709   
					10625, 11363   
					Dux   
					10037   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11037, 10715, 10208,   
					11652   
					Anam National   
					Andersson   
					Anitech   
					Ansonic   
					AOC   
					10037, 10650   
					11585   
					DX Antenna   
					Dynatron   
					Dynex   
					11817, 13817   
					10037   
					10037   
					Boca   
					11652   
					Cyberpix   
					D-Vision   
					Daewoo   
					11667   
					12049   
					10037, 10668   
					10178, 10625, 11365   
					10037, 10714   
					10037   
					Boman   
					Bork   
					11324   
					10556, 10037   
					e-motion   
					E:max   
					11709   
					11363   
					10178, 10556, 10037,   
					10634, 10499, 12098   
					11324   
					Ardem   
					BPL   
					10037, 10208   
					10625, 10714, 10560   
					11709   
					Easy Living   
					ECE   
					11666, 11709   
					10037   
					Arena   
					Brandt   
					Brimax   
					Brinkmann   
					Brionvega   
					Bush   
					Dansai   
					Dantax   
					10037, 10208   
					Aristona   
					ART   
					10556, 10037   
					11037   
					10714, 11037, 10715,   
					11652   
					Elbe   
					10556, 10037   
					11755   
					10037, 10668   
					10037   
					Electrograph   
					Element   
					Elfunk   
					Datsura   
					Dawa   
					10208   
					Art Mito   
					Asberg   
					Astra   
					11585   
					11886   
					10037   
					10037   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 10698,   
					10208, 11585, 11652,   
					11667, 12719   
					11037   
					Daytron   
					De Graaf   
					DEC   
					10037   
					10037   
					ELG   
					10037   
					10208   
					ATD   
					10698   
					Elin   
					10037   
					11709   
					Atlantic   
					Audiosonic   
					Audioworld   
					Aventura   
					Axxon   
					10037   
					Elite   
					10037   
					Byd:sign   
					Camper   
					Carad   
					12140, 12209   
					10037   
					Decca   
					10037   
					10037, 10714, 10715   
					10698   
					Emerson   
					10178, 10171, 10037,   
					10714, 10668, 11394,   
					11864, 11886   
					Denver   
					Desmet   
					Diamant   
					Diamond   
					10037, 11709   
					10037   
					10668, 11037   
					10037   
					10171   
					Carena   
					10037   
					Envision   
					Epson   
					11365, 11506   
					11379   
					10714   
					Carrefour   
					Cascade   
					Casio   
					10037   
					10698   
					Baird   
					10208   
					10037   
					Dick Smith   
					Electronics   
					10698   
					Erres   
					10037   
					Barco   
					10556   
					10037   
					ESA   
					10171   
					Basic Line   
					10556, 10037, 10668,   
					11037   
					Cathay   
					10037   
					Digatron   
					Digihome   
					Digiline   
					Digitek   
					Digitor   
					Dixi   
					10037   
					ESC   
					10037   
					CCE   
					10037   
					11667   
					Baur   
					10037, 10195, 10512   
					10178   
					Euroman   
					Europa   
					Europhon   
					Evesham   
					Excello   
					Exquisit   
					10037   
					Centrum   
					Centurion   
					Changhong   
					Chimei   
					Clarivox   
					11037   
					10037, 10668   
					11709   
					Beaumark   
					Beijing   
					Beko   
					10037   
					10037   
					10208   
					10037   
					10508   
					10037, 10698   
					10037   
					10037, 10714, 10715,   
					11652   
					11248, 11667   
					11037   
					11666   
					10037   
					Belson   
					10698   
					DL   
					11363   
					10037   
					11   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Television   
					Television   
					Television   
					Hoeher   
					Television   
					Karcher   
					Kathrein   
					Kendo   
					Ferguson   
					10037, 10625, 10560,   
					10195, 11037, 11585   
					Goodmans   
					10556, 10037, 10625,   
					10714, 10560, 10668,   
					10634, 11037, 10499,   
					11585, 11667   
					10714   
					10037   
					11666   
					11295   
					10714, 11324   
					10556   
					Hornyphon   
					Hugoson   
					Humax   
					Fidelity   
					Finlandia   
					Finlux   
					10171, 10037, 10512   
					10208   
					10037, 11037, 11585   
					11037   
					Kennex   
					Kioto   
					Gorenje   
					Gradiente   
					Graetz   
					11585   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10715, 11248, 11667   
					Hypson   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 10715   
					10556   
					10037   
					Kiton   
					10037, 10668   
					10037   
					10714   
					Firstline   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 10208,   
					11363   
					Hyundai   
					Iberia   
					11037, 10698   
					10037   
					KLL   
					Granada   
					Grandin   
					10037, 10560, 10208   
					Kneissel   
					Koenig   
					Kolin   
					10556, 10037, 10499   
					10037   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 10715,   
					11652   
					ICE   
					10037   
					Fisher   
					10208   
					iLo   
					11394   
					10150, 10037, 11610,   
					11755   
					Flint   
					10037   
					Imperial   
					Indiana   
					Ingelen   
					Inno Hit   
					Innova   
					Insignia   
					Integra   
					Interbuy   
					Interfunk   
					Internal   
					Intervision   
					Irradio   
					IRT   
					10037   
					Grundig   
					10556, 10037, 10195,   
					11223, 11667, 12625   
					Formenti   
					Fraba   
					10037   
					10037   
					Kolster   
					Konka   
					Korpel   
					Kosmos   
					Kunlun   
					L&S Electronic   
					Lavic   
					10037   
					10037   
					GVA   
					11363, 12098   
					12001   
					10714   
					10037, 10714   
					10037   
					Friac   
					10037, 10499   
					11709   
					H & B   
					11037, 11585   
					10037   
					Fujicom   
					Fujitsu   
					Fujitsu Siemens   
					Funai   
					Haier   
					10037, 10698, 10508   
					10178   
					10037   
					10809   
					Hallmark   
					Hankook   
					Hanseatic   
					10171, 11423, 12049   
					11807, 13100, 13500   
					10037   
					10208   
					10809, 11248, 11666   
					10178   
					10714   
					10171, 10714, 10668,   
					11037, 11394, 11666,   
					11817, 13817   
					10556, 10037, 10625,   
					10714, 10634, 10499,   
					12001   
					11363   
					10037, 10512   
					10556   
					Lavis   
					11037   
					G-Hanz   
					Gaba   
					11363   
					11037   
					10037   
					10037   
					11755   
					Lecson   
					Lenco   
					10037   
					Hantarex   
					Hantor   
					10037   
					10037   
					10037, 11037   
					10037   
					10037   
					Galaxi   
					Galaxis   
					Gateway   
					GE   
					10037   
					Leyco   
					Harwood   
					Hauppauge   
					HB   
					10037   
					10698   
					LG   
					10178, 10556, 10037,   
					10714, 10715, 10698,   
					11423, 11768, 11840,   
					12182, 12358, 12424,   
					12834   
					10037   
					Isukai   
					ITS   
					10037   
					11324   
					10178, 11454, 10625,   
					10560   
					10037   
					HCM   
					10037   
					ITT   
					10208   
					Highline   
					Hinari   
					10037   
					GEC   
					10037   
					ITT Nokia   
					ITV   
					10208   
					Liesenkoetter   
					Lifetec   
					10037   
					10037, 10208   
					10714   
					Genesis   
					Genexxa   
					GFM   
					10037   
					10037   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11037, 12001   
					Hisawa   
					Hisense   
					10037   
					JGC   
					11709   
					10556, 10508, 10208,   
					11363, 12098   
					10171, 11864, 11886   
					11585   
					Linsar   
					11585   
					Jinfeng   
					Jinxing   
					JMB   
					10208   
					Godrej   
					Goldfunk   
					GoldStar   
					Local India TV   
					Local Malaysia TV   
					Lodos   
					10208   
					10556, 10037, 10698   
					10556, 10634, 10499   
					10556   
					Hitachi   
					10150, 10178, 10037,   
					10634, 11037, 10508,   
					10499, 10578, 11576,   
					11585, 11643, 11667,   
					11691, 12433   
					10668   
					10698   
					10178, 10037, 10714,   
					10715   
					11037   
					Jubilee   
					JVC   
					Loewe   
					10037, 10512, 11884   
					11037, 10698   
					10668   
					10650, 10653, 10508,   
					11428, 11601, 12271   
					Logik   
					Hitachi Fujian   
					Hitec   
					10150   
					10698   
					Kaisui   
					10037   
					Logix   
					12   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Television   
					Luma   
					Television   
					Metronic   
					Metz   
					Television   
					NetTV   
					Television   
					Orline   
					11037   
					10625   
					11755   
					10037   
					Lumatron   
					Lumenio   
					Lux May   
					Luxor   
					10037, 10668   
					10037   
					10037, 10668, 10195,   
					11037   
					Neufunk   
					New Tech   
					Newave   
					Nikkai   
					10556, 10037, 10714   
					10556, 10037   
					10178   
					Ormond   
					Osaki   
					10668, 11037   
					10556, 10037   
					10037   
					MGA   
					10150, 10178   
					10037   
					Osio   
					Micromaxx   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11037, 11324, 12001   
					11037, 10208   
					10178   
					10037   
					Osume   
					10037   
					LXI   
					Nikkei   
					10714   
					Otto Versand   
					10556, 10037, 10195,   
					10512   
					Microspot   
					Mikomi   
					11614   
					M Electronic   
					10037, 10714, 10634,   
					10195, 10512, 11652   
					Nikko   
					10178   
					11037, 11585   
					10037   
					Pacific   
					10556, 10714, 11037,   
					11324   
					Nokia   
					10208   
					Minato   
					Madison   
					10037   
					Norcent   
					Nordmende   
					11365   
					Minerva   
					10195, 11248   
					11667   
					Palladium   
					Palsonic   
					Panama   
					10556, 10037, 10714   
					10037, 10698   
					10037   
					Magnavox   
					10171, 11454, 11365,   
					11506, 11755, 11867,   
					12372   
					10037, 10714, 10560,   
					10195, 11585, 11667,   
					12001   
					Ministry Of Sound   
					Minoka   
					10037   
					Magnum   
					Manesth   
					Manhattan   
					Marantz   
					Mark   
					10037, 10714, 10715   
					10037   
					Mirai   
					11666   
					Normerel   
					Nortek   
					Novatronic   
					Novita   
					Nu-Tec   
					O.K.Line   
					Oceanic   
					Odys   
					10037   
					Panasonic   
					11480, 10037, 10650,   
					10508, 10208, 11636,   
					12170   
					Mitsubishi   
					10150, 11250, 10178,   
					10556, 10037, 11037,   
					10512, 11171   
					10668   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					11454, 10556, 10037   
					10037, 10714, 10715   
					10499   
					10037   
					Panavision   
					Panda   
					10037   
					11585   
					Mivar   
					10609   
					10698, 10508, 10208   
					11636   
					10698   
					Moree   
					10037   
					Pansonic   
					Penney   
					Perdio   
					Master's   
					Mastro   
					11037, 11324   
					10208   
					Morgan's   
					Moserbaer   
					MTC   
					10037   
					10178   
					10698   
					11585   
					10037   
					Masuda   
					Matsui   
					10037   
					12719   
					10512   
					Perfekt   
					Petters   
					10037   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10195, 11037, 10208,   
					11666, 11667   
					Okano   
					OKI   
					10037   
					MTlogic   
					Mudan   
					Multitec   
					Multitech   
					Myrica   
					Myryad   
					NAD   
					10714   
					10037   
					11585, 11667   
					11610, 12124   
					10698   
					10208   
					Philco   
					10178, 10171, 10037,   
					11394   
					Olevia   
					Omni   
					Matsushita   
					Maxent   
					Maxess   
					Meck   
					10650   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					10037   
					11755   
					Philips   
					10178, 10171, 11454,   
					10556, 10037, 10512,   
					10605, 10690, 11394,   
					11506, 11867, 12372   
					Onei   
					11667   
					12493   
					11666   
					Onida   
					10653   
					10698   
					10556   
					Onimax   
					Onix   
					10714   
					Mediator   
					Medion   
					10556, 10037   
					10178, 10037   
					10037   
					Phocus   
					Phoenix   
					Phonola   
					Pioneer   
					10714, 11652   
					10037   
					10698   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 10698,   
					10512, 11248, 11585,   
					11667, 12001, 12719   
					Naiko   
					Onkyo   
					Onn   
					11807, 13100, 13500   
					11667, 11709   
					11709   
					Nakimura   
					National   
					NEC   
					10037   
					10556, 10037   
					10508, 10208   
					10037, 10698, 10512,   
					11457, 11636, 12171   
					Onyx   
					10178, 10653, 10508,   
					10499   
					Megatron   
					MEI   
					10178   
					Opera   
					10037, 10714   
					10650   
					Plantron   
					10037   
					11037   
					Optimus   
					Orbit   
					Neckermann   
					NEI   
					10556, 10037   
					10037, 11037   
					11324   
					Playsonic   
					10037, 10714, 10715,   
					11652   
					Memorex   
					Mercury   
					Mermaid   
					10150, 10178, 11037   
					10037   
					10037   
					Orion   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					11037, 12001   
					Powerpoint   
					Prinston   
					10037, 10698   
					11037, 10715   
					NEO   
					10037   
					Netsat   
					10037   
					13   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Television   
					Profitronic   
					Proline   
					Television   
					Rowa   
					Television   
					Siera   
					Television   
					Svasa   
					10037   
					10037, 10698   
					10556, 10037   
					10037   
					10208   
					10037, 10625, 10634,   
					11037   
					Saba   
					10625, 10714, 10560   
					10618   
					Silva   
					Swisstec   
					Sylvania   
					11614, 11775   
					Sagem   
					Saivod   
					Salora   
					Silva Schneider   
					Silver   
					10037   
					10171, 11394, 11864,   
					11886   
					Prosonic   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11324, 11585, 11667,   
					11709, 12001   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					10208, 12001   
					10715   
					Symphonic   
					Synco   
					10171, 11394   
					10178, 11755   
					11610   
					SilverCrest   
					Sinudyne   
					SKY   
					11037   
					Sampo   
					10178, 10171, 10650,   
					11755   
					10037   
					Protech   
					Proton   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					10178   
					Syntax   
					Sysline   
					Tacico   
					Talent   
					
					10037, 10698   
					11324   
					Samsung   
					10178, 10556, 10037,   
					10618, 10650, 10208,   
					12051   
					10037   
					Skyworth   
					Sliding   
					ProVision   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					11324   
					10178   
					10178   
					SLX   
					10668   
					Pvision   
					Pye   
					12001   
					Sansui   
					Sanyo   
					10171, 10037, 10714,   
					11248, 12001   
					Tashiko   
					Tatung   
					TCL   
					10650   
					Solavox   
					Soniko   
					10037   
					10556, 10037   
					10208   
					10037, 11248, 11324   
					10037   
					Qingdao   
					Quasar   
					Quelle   
					11037, 10508, 10208,   
					11142, 11365, 11585,   
					11667, 11974   
					10698, 12403, 12434,   
					13183   
					Soniq   
					12493   
					10650   
					Sonitron   
					Sonneclair   
					Sonoko   
					Sonolor   
					Sontec   
					10208   
					10037, 10668, 10195,   
					11037, 10512   
					TCM   
					10714, 12001   
					SBR   
					10556, 10037   
					10037   
					TEAC   
					10178, 10171, 10037,   
					10714, 10668, 11037,   
					10698, 10512, 11248,   
					11363, 11709, 11755   
					Schaub Lorenz   
					10714, 11324, 11363,   
					11667, 12001   
					R-Line   
					10037   
					10037   
					Radiola   
					10556, 10037   
					10037   
					10208   
					Schneider   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037   
					Radiomarelli   
					RadioShack   
					Radiotone   
					RCA   
					10037   
					10178, 10037   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					Tec   
					10037   
					Sony   
					10810, 11505, 11167,   
					11651, 11825   
					Schoentech   
					Scotch   
					Scott   
					11037   
					Tech Line   
					Technica   
					Technics   
					Technika   
					TechniSat   
					Technisson   
					Techno   
					10037, 10668   
					11037   
					10178   
					Soundesign   
					Soundwave   
					Sowa   
					10178   
					10178, 11454, 10625,   
					10560, 10618, 11781,   
					12247, 12403, 12434,   
					12746, 12932   
					10178   
					10037, 11037, 10715   
					10178   
					10556, 10650   
					11667   
					Sears   
					10178, 10171   
					10634   
					Seaway   
					Seelver   
					SEG   
					Squareview   
					Standard   
					Starlite   
					10171   
					10556   
					Realistic   
					Recor   
					10178   
					11037   
					10037, 11037, 11709   
					10037   
					10714, 11652   
					11585   
					10037   
					10037, 10668, 11037,   
					12719   
					Rectiligne   
					Redstar   
					Reflex   
					10037   
					Strato   
					10037   
					Technosonic   
					10556, 10625, 10499,   
					11324   
					SEI   
					10037   
					10037   
					10178   
					10208   
					10037   
					SunBriteTV   
					Sungoo   
					11610   
					Sei-Sinudyne   
					Serie Dorada   
					Shanghai   
					Sharp   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					11585   
					Techvision   
					Techwood   
					Tecnimagen   
					Teco   
					11709   
					11248   
					Relisys   
					Remotec   
					Reoc   
					11037, 11667   
					10556   
					Sunny   
					10037   
					10171, 10037   
					10714   
					Sunstar   
					10037   
					10650, 10818, 11165,   
					11423, 11659   
					10178, 10653   
					10208, 11709   
					10150   
					Sunstech   
					Sunwood   
					Supersonic   
					SuperTech   
					Supra   
					12001   
					Revox   
					10037   
					Tedelex   
					10037   
					Shintoshi   
					Shivaki   
					Siam   
					10037   
					RFT   
					10037   
					Teknika   
					10208   
					10178, 10037   
					10037   
					Roadstar   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11037, 10715   
					TELE System   
					Telecor   
					11585   
					10556, 10037   
					10178   
					10037   
					Siemens   
					10037, 10195   
					Rolson   
					12001, 12098   
					14   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					Television   
					Television   
					Ultravox   
					UMC   
					Television   
					PVR   
					Telefunken   
					10037, 10625, 10714,   
					10560, 10698, 11585,   
					11667   
					10037   
					Wharfedale   
					10556, 10037, 11324,   
					11667   
					ReplayTV   
					Sonic Blue   
					TiVo   
					20616   
					20616   
					20739   
					11614, 11775   
					10037   
					White Westinghouse 10037   
					Unic Line   
					Uniden   
					Telefusion   
					Telegazi   
					Telemeister   
					Telesonic   
					Telestar   
					10037   
					Wilson   
					10556   
					12122   
					10037   
					Windsor   
					Windy Sam   
					Wintel   
					10668, 11037   
					10556   
					TV/VCR Combination   
					United   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					11037, 10715, 11652   
					10037   
					Amstrad   
					Ferguson   
					Fidelity   
					GoldStar   
					Grundig   
					LG   
					10171   
					10037   
					Unitek   
					11709   
					10714   
					10625   
					10556, 10037   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					10037   
					Universal   
					Universum   
					10037, 10714   
					World-of-Vision   
					Wyse   
					12001   
					10171   
					Teletech   
					Teleview   
					Tennessee   
					Tensai   
					10037, 10668, 10195,   
					11037, 10618, 10512   
					11365   
					10037   
					Xenius   
					10634   
					10556, 10037, 10195   
					10178   
					10037   
					Univox   
					10037   
					Xiahua   
					10698   
					10037, 11037, 10715   
					V7 Videoseven   
					Vestel   
					11666, 11755   
					XLogic   
					10698   
					Mitsubishi   
					Philips   
					Radiola   
					Saba   
					10556   
					Tesla   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					11037, 11652   
					10037, 10668, 11037,   
					11585, 11667   
					Xrypton   
					Yamaha   
					Yamishi   
					Yokan   
					10037   
					10556, 10037   
					10556   
					10650, 11576   
					10037   
					Tevion   
					10556, 10037, 10714,   
					10668, 11037, 11248,   
					11585, 11667   
					Vexa   
					10037   
					10625   
					Victor   
					10650, 10653, 11428   
					10037, 10508   
					10037   
					10037   
					Sanyo   
					11974   
					Videocon   
					VideoSystem   
					Vidtech   
					Viewsonic   
					Vision   
					Yoko   
					10037   
					Schneider   
					Sharp   
					10556, 10037   
					10818   
					Thomson   
					Thorn   
					10037, 10625, 10560   
					10037, 10499, 10512   
					10499   
					YU-MA-TU   
					Zenith   
					10037   
					10178   
					10178, 10037, 11365,   
					11423, 12358   
					Siemens   
					Sony   
					10037   
					Thorn-Ferguson   
					TMK   
					11365, 11755, 12049   
					10037   
					11505   
					10178   
					Zepto   
					Zonda   
					11585   
					10698   
					TEAC   
					10178, 10171   
					10556   
					Tokai   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					11037   
					Vistron   
					Vivax   
					11363   
					Technics   
					Thomson   
					Tokaido   
					Topline   
					Toshiba   
					11709   
					10625   
					10668, 11037   
					Vizio   
					11758, 12209   
					10037   
					VCR   
					10195, 11037, 10618,   
					10650, 10508, 11169,   
					11508, 11524, 11652,   
					12203   
					Vortec   
					DirecTV   
					Humax   
					20739   
					20739   
					20616   
					20739   
					20616   
					20616   
					20739   
					DVD   
					Voxson   
					VU   
					10178, 10037   
					11365, 12098   
					11667   
					3D LAB   
					Accurian   
					Acoustic Solutions   
					AEG   
					30539   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					30675   
					Toyoda   
					11709   
					Walker   
					Waltham   
					Wansa   
					30713   
					TRANS-continents   
					10556, 10037, 10668,   
					11037   
					10037, 10668, 11037   
					12098   
					ReplayTV   
					Sonic Blue   
					TiVo   
					30675   
					AFK   
					31152   
					Transonic   
					10037, 10698, 10512,   
					11363   
					Wards   
					10178   
					Aiwa   
					30533   
					Watson   
					10037, 10714, 10668,   
					11037   
					Akai   
					30675   
					Triad   
					10556   
					PVR   
					Alba   
					30539, 30713   
					33052   
					Trio   
					11248   
					Wega   
					10037   
					DirecTV   
					Humax   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					20739   
					20739   
					20616   
					20739   
					Ambiance   
					Amstrad   
					Anthem   
					Triumph   
					TVTEXT 95   
					Uher   
					10556, 10037   
					10556   
					Welltech   
					Weltstar   
					10714, 11652   
					11037   
					30713   
					32820   
					10037   
					Westinghouse   
					11755   
					15   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					DVD   
					DVD   
					DVD   
					DVD   
					Aristona   
					ASDA   
					30539, 30646   
					32213   
					30713   
					30713   
					32587   
					30713   
					31571   
					30713   
					30571   
					30713   
					30503   
					30713   
					31152   
					Elfunk   
					30713   
					Kennex   
					Kenwood   
					Lenco   
					Lexicon   
					LG   
					30713   
					Orion   
					30713   
					30713   
					30713   
					30713   
					Elite   
					31152   
					30490, 30534   
					30713, 33052   
					32545   
					Ormond   
					Pacific   
					Audix   
					Emerson   
					EuroLine   
					Ferguson   
					Finlux   
					30675, 32213   
					30675   
					Autovox   
					Awa   
					Palladium   
					Panasonic   
					30713   
					30741, 31602   
					33052   
					30503, 30490, 31579,   
					31641, 32523, 32710,   
					32859   
					Basic Line   
					Bel Canto Design   
					Black Diamond   
					Blue Parade   
					Blue Sky   
					Brandt   
					30741   
					Limit   
					Firstline   
					Foehn & Hirsch   
					Funai   
					30713   
					Lodos   
					Loewe   
					30713   
					Pelican Accessories   
					Philco   
					30533   
					30675   
					33052   
					30539, 30741, 32474,   
					32783   
					30675   
					Philips   
					30503, 30539, 30646,   
					30675, 30713, 31340,   
					31354, 32056, 32084,   
					32434, 32689   
					Logik   
					30713   
					GE   
					30522   
					Lumatron   
					Lunatron   
					Luxman   
					Luxor   
					30741, 30713   
					30741   
					GFM   
					30675   
					Bush   
					Global Sphere   
					Go Video   
					GoldStar   
					Goodmans   
					GPX   
					31152   
					30573   
					Pioneer   
					30571, 30142, 30631,   
					31571, 32442, 32860   
					C-Tech   
					30741   
					30713   
					California Audio Labs 30490   
					30741   
					Polk Audio   
					Presidian   
					ProAudio   
					Proscan   
					Proson   
					30539   
					Magnavox   
					30503, 30539, 30646,   
					30675, 30713, 31354   
					Cambridge Audio   
					Centrum   
					Changhong   
					Cinetec   
					32808   
					30713, 31152   
					30741   
					30675   
					30675, 30713   
					30627   
					Manhattan   
					Marantz   
					30713   
					31394   
					Grandin   
					Grundig   
					H & B   
					30713   
					30539, 32414, 32432,   
					33444   
					30522   
					30713   
					30539, 30713   
					30713   
					30713   
					Clatronic   
					Clayton   
					30675   
					Mark   
					30713   
					Pye   
					30539, 30646   
					30741   
					30713   
					Haaz   
					31152   
					Matsui   
					30713   
					Radionette   
					Radiotone   
					RCA   
					Crown   
					30713   
					Hanseatic   
					Harman/Kardon   
					Henss   
					30741   
					Maxim   
					MDS   
					30713   
					30713   
					Dantax   
					30539, 30713   
					30582, 31229, 33228   
					30713   
					30713   
					30522, 30571, 32213,   
					32587   
					Denon   
					30490, 30634, 31634,   
					32258, 32748   
					Medion   
					Memorex   
					Metz   
					30630, 30741   
					32213   
					Hitachi   
					30573, 30713, 31664   
					30713   
					REC   
					30490   
					32213   
					31394   
					30713   
					30623   
					30741   
					Dick Smith   
					Electronics   
					31152   
					Hoeher   
					30571, 30713   
					30503, 30539   
					30539   
					Red   
					HotMedia   
					Humax   
					31152   
					Micromedia   
					Micromega   
					Microsoft   
					Minax   
					Redstar   
					Roadstar   
					Rotel   
					Digihome   
					DigiLogic   
					Digix Media   
					Disney   
					30713   
					30646   
					30713   
					Inno Hit   
					Insignia   
					30713   
					30522, 32083   
					30713   
					31394   
					30741, 30675, 32428,   
					32596   
					Salora   
					Samsung   
					30675   
					Mitsubishi   
					Momitsu   
					NAD   
					30713   
					30490, 30573, 30199,   
					30820, 31635, 32069,   
					32329, 32489, 33195   
					DSE   
					30675, 31152   
					30713   
					Integra   
					30503, 30571, 30627,   
					31612, 31634, 32147   
					33052   
					Dual   
					30741   
					Durabrand   
					Dynex   
					30675, 30713   
					32596   
					Irradio   
					JVC   
					30646   
					Sanyo   
					30713   
					NEC   
					30741, 31602   
					30503, 30539, 30623,   
					30867, 31597, 31602,   
					32855   
					Schneider   
					Schoentech   
					Scott   
					30539, 30646, 30713   
					30713   
					Onkyo   
					30503, 30627, 31612,   
					32147, 30571, 31634   
					Dyon   
					33052   
					eBench   
					31152   
					31394   
					Kendo   
					30713   
					Oppo   
					30575, 32545   
					16   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					DVD   
					SEG   
					DVD   
					Blu-ray Disc   
					JVC   
					DVD-R   
					Irradio   
					JVC   
					30713   
					30503   
					Toshiba   
					30503, 31639, 32277,   
					32551, 32705, 33157   
					32855   
					30646   
					Semp   
					Sharp   
					Lenco   
					33052   
					31597   
					Transonic   
					TVE   
					31394   
					30630, 30675, 30713,   
					32250, 32474, 32652,   
					32869   
					Lexicon   
					LG   
					32545   
					LG   
					30741   
					30713   
					30741, 31602   
					33052   
					Loewe   
					Magnavox   
					Medion   
					Panasonic   
					30741   
					United   
					30675, 30713, 31152   
					30741, 30713   
					30503   
					Limit   
					30646, 30675   
					30741   
					Sherwood   
					Shinsonic   
					Silva Schneider   
					SilverCrest   
					Skantic   
					30741, 33052   
					30533   
					Universum   
					Urban Concepts   
					Vestel   
					Loewe   
					32474, 32783   
					30675   
					Magnavox   
					Marantz   
					Momitsu   
					Onkyo   
					30490, 31579, 32523,   
					32710, 32859   
					30741   
					30713   
					32414, 32432, 33444   
					33052   
					31152   
					Victor   
					31597   
					Philips   
					Pioneer   
					Pye   
					30646, 31340   
					30631, 32860   
					30646   
					30539, 30713   
					31152   
					Vizio   
					32563   
					32147, 32900, 32910,   
					33100, 33101, 33500,   
					33501   
					SM Electronic   
					Smart   
					Vtrek   
					32587   
					30713   
					Waltham   
					Wellington   
					Weltstar   
					Wharfedale   
					Windsor   
					Windy Sam   
					Xbox   
					30713   
					RCA   
					30522   
					Sony   
					30533, 30864, 31033,   
					31070, 31431, 31516,   
					31633, 32180   
					Oppo   
					32545   
					30713   
					Samsung   
					Schneider   
					Sharp   
					30490, 31635   
					30646   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					31641, 32523, 32859   
					32084, 32434, 32689   
					30142, 32442   
					30199, 33195   
					32250, 32474, 32652   
					33052   
					30713   
					30713   
					30630, 30675, 32869   
					Soundwave   
					Star Clusters   
					Strato   
					30713   
					31152   
					31152   
					30713   
					31152   
					30630, 30675   
					30675   
					31394   
					30713   
					30741   
					30741   
					32587   
					30741   
					Pioneer   
					Samsung   
					Sharp   
					30713   
					Sony   
					31033, 31070, 31431,   
					31516, 31633, 32180   
					30573   
					Sylvania   
					Targa   
					30675   
					30522, 32083   
					31152   
					Strong   
					Sherwood   
					Sony   
					30741   
					XLogic   
					Supervision   
					Sylvania   
					Symphonic   
					Tamashi   
					Tandberg   
					Targa   
					31516, 32180   
					30675   
					Toshiba   
					Victor   
					31639, 32277, 32551   
					31597   
					Yamaha   
					30490, 30539, 30646,   
					30817, 31354, 32298,   
					32299   
					Sylvania   
					TASCAM   
					Toshiba   
					Vizio   
					34004   
					Yamaha   
					Zenith   
					30646   
					Zenith   
					30503, 30741   
					32551, 32705, 33157   
					32563   
					30741   
					Blu-ray Disc   
					Ambiance   
					Anthem   
					HD-DVD   
					Integra   
					LG   
					Yamaha   
					32298, 32299   
					Tchibo   
					33052   
					32901, 33104, 33504   
					30741   
					TCL   
					32820   
					DVD-R   
					Accurian   
					Aristona   
					Denon   
					TCM   
					Cambridge Audio   
					Denon   
					32808   
					30675   
					30646   
					30490   
					30675   
					30675   
					30741   
					30741   
					31664   
					30646   
					Microsoft   
					Onkyo   
					Xbox   
					32083   
					TEAC   
					34004, 30571, 30741,   
					30675, 31394   
					32258, 32748   
					33052   
					32901, 33104 33504   
					32083   
					Dyon   
					Technica   
					Technics   
					30713   
					30490   
					30713   
					30713   
					30571   
					30522   
					Foehn & Hirsch   
					Funai   
					33052   
					Emerson   
					Funai   
					30675   
					TV/DVD Combination   
					Techwood   
					Teletech   
					Harman/Kardon   
					Insignia   
					33228   
					Akai   
					11675   
					Go Video   
					GPX   
					30675, 32428, 32596   
					Black Diamond   
					Blue Sky   
					Bush   
					11037, 30713   
					11037, 30713   
					Theta Digital   
					Thomson   
					Integra   
					32147, 32900, 32910,   
					33100, 33101, 33500,   
					33501   
					Hitachi   
					Humax   
					11037, 10698, 12719,   
					30713   
					17   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				Remote Control Codes   
					TV/DVD Combination   
					TV/DVD Combination   
					Centrum   
					Crown   
					DMTech   
					Dual   
					11037, 30713   
					Sunstech   
					Sylvania   
					12001   
					11037, 30713   
					12001   
					10171, 11394, 11864,   
					11886, 30630, 30675   
					TEAC   
					10698   
					11037, 30713   
					12049   
					Technica   
					Telefunken   
					Teletech   
					Thomson   
					Toshiba   
					United   
					11037, 30713   
					10698   
					Dynex   
					Elfunk   
					Emerson   
					11037, 30713   
					11037, 30713   
					10625   
					11394, 11864, 11886,   
					30675   
					Ferguson   
					Goodmans   
					Grandin   
					Grundig   
					H & B   
					11037, 30713   
					11037, 30713   
					30713   
					11524   
					11037, 30713   
					30713   
					Universum   
					Vestel   
					30539   
					11037   
					12001   
					Viewsonic   
					Weltstar   
					12049   
					Hanseatic   
					Hitachi   
					Insignia   
					JVC   
					12001   
					11037, 30713   
					11037, 11667, 30713   
					12049   
					12271   
					LG   
					11423   
					Logik   
					11037, 30713   
					11037, 30713   
					12372   
					Luxor   
					Magnavox   
					Matsui   
					11037, 30713   
					12719   
					Medion   
					Nordmende   
					Odys   
					12001   
					12719   
					Panasonic   
					Philips   
					12170   
					11454, 10556, 11394,   
					30539   
					Powerpoint   
					Prosonic   
					Pvision   
					RCA   
					10698   
					12001   
					12001   
					12746, 12932   
					12001   
					Schaub Lorenz   
					SEG   
					11037, 12719, 30713   
					10818   
					Sharp   
					Soniq   
					12493   
					18   
					Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.   
					 
				 |